2023 - Year From Hell

Updated
Another March 2020 flash crash likely coming in 2023. Either Q2 or Q4, but I’m leaning towards Q2. The percentage decline from the dead cat wave #b high is posited to be much worse ~90% (at least if not hodling legacy protocol Bitcoin) versus ~62% in 2020.

Note the meticulously diagrammed patterns. It’s as if the decline and rally of 2018 and 2019 as applied to the ATHs in 2021, subsequent decline and posited diagrammed future, is being combined with the structure that started from the 13.8k peak in summer 2019 to the March 2020 crash. This is what I have referred to as constructive fractal wave interference. But you can also see it makes sense from traditional wave analysis as well.

June could have been the bottom, else my maximum plausible decline (before rallying back up significantly as diagrammed) is to ~15k. OPTICALARTdotCOM speculates that dotted, tan-colored lines will meet the bottom, but that isn’t supported in 2018 as shown and such an egregious decline would deviate from the trend of diminishing volatility both to the upside and downside. Major corrections have been -94%, -86% and -84% in chronological order. After the first was an interim -82% in 2013 and after the last an interim -71% (for the March 2020 flash crash). The current ~74% correction is roughly akin to {-84, -71, -74) as is {-94, -82, -86}. A decline to ~15k would be -78%. A decline to 12K or 8k would be -83% or -89%. Yet one may wonder if I have diagrammed a flash crash in 2023 to 6k (and ditto the moon to 1M price by 2026) wouldn’t that violate the diminishing volatility thesis? The previously posited ANYONECANSPEND Nash Equilibrium restoration “attack” could explain that catapult to the upside by 2026, as well the legacy Bitcoin may have forked off by the flash crash and only decline to ~12.5k which is -82%. The comparable total decline from the 2017 peak to the March 2020 bottom was -81%.

If the ANYONECANSPEND occurs on this posited incoming, egregious flash crash, it’s also not clear if the current impostor Bitcoin (aka BTC which everyone thinks is the official Bitcoin) goes immediately to $0 and dies, or if it bounces for a couple of years to form a right shoulder on that potentially massive H&S pattern starting from 2018 which projects to below $0.

snapshot
Note
Note it is assumed the reader understands that the ANYONECANSPEND will coincide with a hard fork off of the impostor BTC and the legacy protocol (no ticker symbol yet, not the sh8tcoins BCH nor BSV) will proceed up, up and away as a separate block chain from the BTC clusterf*ck.
Note
Added another cyan-colored, parallel line which aligns with the June bottom. Might imply a thrust down to ~17.8k by Sept 20.

snapshot
Note
S&P concurs? Can you say “stolen election” again?

snapshot

snapshot
Note
The timing for massive spike up break out on the VIX also agrees with this flash crash timing. Note I didn’t diagram the expected spike up break on the following chart, but you can conjure it.

I annotated this VIX chart in the summer of 2021 and published it.

The VIX chart narrative. The bull-market, declining channel from 2010 to 2018, which turned into a bullish (for VIX bearish for stocks) ascending triangle or wedge from 2018 to 2020. Then the massive spike bull move corresponding to the corona, pLandemic flash crash. Then the bull-market, declining channel from Q2 2020 to Q4 2021, with the market-bearish, bullish VIX breakout peaking to the projected measured move.

VIX has essentially repeated December 2018 to February 2019 already; and now appears poised to repeat pattern from week of February 19. VIX appears to be in another bullish (for VIX bearish for stocks) wedge with a massive spike (market flash crash) breakout to follow in Q3 or Q4 2023. Initial, spike up breakout (i.e. markets correction) may be in Q2 2023 then calm down again for several months.

All proceeding exactly as the chart projected! If we would just stop ignoring this chart structure, we would be very wealthy from speculative investments.

Notice the bull-market, declining channels are becoming shorter in duration and steeper; thus the next one from 2024 may be only 6 months in duration and near vertical — can readers repeat after me, “ANYONECANSPEND Bitcoin attack followed by vertical, catapult of legacy Bitcoin”! The monetary, economic and political system is self-immolating. Nuclear WW3 (against China-Russia-N.Korea-Iran) surely on tap for ~2025 with Russia-NATO conflict as early as H2 2023.

snapshot
Note
Changed the dates of interest on my VIX chart and diagrammed the egregious flash crash posited to be incoming Q1–Q2 2023. A flash crash on the S&P is a spike upwards on the VIX.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Zooming in on the daily VIX chart the dates of interest from the market bottom (and VIX peak) on Dec 24, 2018 to the start of the choppiness and slowdown of the S&P’s rally in March 2019, as compared to (the posited to be a repeating fractal at) the start of choppiness in August 2022 after the rally from the June 13 low. Note March 2019 was the final dip for ETH and BTC after their second thrust rally coming off the Dec 24, 2018 bottom. On Apr 2, 2019, ETH broke through the key overhead resistance (c.f. my ETH chart to follow) thus triggering BTC to launch in earnest its parabolic rally to 13.9k by June after loitering in the toilet before that coming off the bottom, which BTC has been repeating since the June 13, 2022 bottom.

Thus I think the mega rally is about to ensue soon, no later than October if not surprising everyone in September. Remember Martin Armstrong’s Socrates A.I. system has a Panic Cycle for September on the monthly Forecast Array for DJIA following the Panic Cycle for the week of Aug 22 which played out to the downside. Could the September Panic Cycle play out to the upside? Often Panic Cycles can begin with a fake out move in the opposite direction to the larger move that completes it. So a move to the downside initially in September could be a fake out. Also there is another Panic Cycle for the week of Oct 17, which could either be a further (or initial if September is a crash) thrust leg upwards or a scary bear trap pullback before the mega rally continues.

The VIX has two drives of bearish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly chart (not shown) but has a structure (last drive up had the RSI make a higher to the prior drive but not to the initial drive) that suggests maybe one more drive is incoming (i.e. VIX up one more time with RSI not making a higher high). Also the daily chart shared below suggests for one more drive up to enable hidden, bearish RSI divergence to form with the RSI higher high than the June 13 peak, but the VIX level not higher than that June 13 peak. Currently the daily RSI is not yet above the June 13 peak.

Thus I conclude likely one more, minor leg down for the markets before the mega rally continues. Expecting that to scare the weak hands into thinking a lower low is incoming. Again I expect the posited rally to peak by Q1 2023 and become a bull trap that precedes an egregious flash crash in the markets no later than May 2023. Socrates has a Panic Cycle for the month of May 2023.

snapshot
Note
OTOH, there’s already bearish RSI divergence on the daily VIX if compared to the June 16 peak. So it’s not assured there must be another leg higher.

Some have been waiting for a lower low on BTC because the spot price lacked bullish RSI divergence on the daily for the June low. But note CME did print that bullish RSI divergence in June. Ditto ETH spot price never printed said bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart in June. Both printed bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly in June.

Both ETH and BTC have slightly bearish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly but this offset by needing a significant bounce to form it on the daily. Whereas both already have multiple drives of bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly and at least one drive of hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily. Both could add another drive of hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily if they move lower but not lower than 1K and 19k. Or potentially bullish RSI divergence for BTC could form on the weekly (!); and separately also on daily with a move below 19k if the RSI does not come down too much.

There is already hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily SPX.

ETH appears to have a bearish, short-term technical formation but it could rally back up to the wedge it fell out of.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
A potential bullish Butterfly harmonic pattern (c.f. also, also) forming on BTC on the 4 hourly chart only, with required (else pattern isn’t formed) downside and upside to ~$18.9 – 19.3k and ~$20.1 – 20.7k respectively. Note there’s no particular target date, except that for a 4 hourly chart it shouldn’t stretch out too long. The pattern would be invalid if price drops below stated downside or exceeds 20.5k before downside target.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
I bet going to down a bit more.

snapshot
Note
OPTICALARTdotCOM intending to put in a massive long if drop to his major Fib ring ~18.6k. Remember I was pointing out that ring to him in comments a couple of weeks ago before he pointed it out.

youtu.be/KU6gBf6bw3Y?t=527
(Bitcoin Drop on This Exact Day! My next Heavy Long & Short entries.)
Note
Kdub (aka the Crypto Zombie) points out that the Market Cipher indicator has flashed a yellow ‘X’ for possible manipulation.

youtu.be/3gtYgm02ERg?t=434
(click to see chart)

Also very likely markets about to rally same like 2019 as the dollar doesn’t crash but enters choppiness:

youtu.be/3gtYgm02ERg?t=634
(click to see chart)
Note
youtu.be/bfRhs62FK7c
(Retail CRYPTO BANS Are Here! What It Could Mean For YOU!)

This is well worth expending a few minutes listening on double-speed.

As was the case for the stock market crash of the Great Depression, the LUNA crash of the crypto markets is the pretext for coming crackdowns (possibly in September in the U.S.) against trading (and especially leveraged trading) of cryptocurrency and especially the highly volatile, small cap altcoins. The commercial banks were jealous seeing money flow out to Coinbase.

Thus you can imagine the bans on crypto coming after my posited egregious wipeout, flash crash next year.
Note
Tying this posited fractal correspondence into my analysis of ETH. It really appears that ETH has only completed wave 1 of its rally and wave 2 is completing already or soon. Tangentially note this bounce might be wave B of an A-B-C correction making wave 2, thus more downside could be incoming.

Thus this changes the bullishness of ETH considerably compared to the H1 2019 rally. Notice wave 1 only retraced the 0.382 Fib level in H1 2019, but currently retraced the 0.5 level and back up to the near horizontal purplish line.

Since wave 3 is typically the longest of the 5 Elliot waves unless they’re highly overlapping is a terminal diagonal pattern, the only pattern I can find which would make sense would be a rally back up to the reddish trend line as was the case in H2 2019 (which I have posited corresponds to this current rally due to the constructive interference of the combination two prior fractals in 2019 as I posit the smaller one expands on this cycle to be part of the larger one).

snapshot

Previously I recently posited that ETH:BTC would be bearish as soon as ETH:USD crossed up over its yellow downtrend line, as was the case in 2019. I marked the Feb 18, 2019 date on the ETH:BTC to demarcate the top which I also labeled on the ETH:USD chart. But note the said yellow downtrend line is currently at a much higher level ~$2500. Thus I think ETH:BTC will at least remain to the upside until ETH exceeds $2500. This makes sense because we can clearly see on the weekly ETH:BTC chart that the RSI is not in the bearish control zone below 40 as it was on Feb 18, 2019. And the ETH:BTC chart has a bullish structure up to at least 0.1. Whereas from 2018 into 2019 the chart was in a declining wedge pattern making lower highs and lower lows.

snapshot
Note
My model is supporting this also:

Arthur Hayes Expects $5,000 Ethereum by March 2023

His prediction is based on two criteria: a central bank pivot, and a successful Ethereum Merge.

Pivot could meaning merely pausing rate hikes by then.
Note
He has a range from $3,562 (if no Fed pivot) to $5000+.

Hayes is smart:

entrepreneurshandbook.co/max-bidding-7a1c56c1cd07

Let’s run through my hypothesis once more before we move on.

1. I am confident the merge will happen by the end of the year due to the increased noise made by Ethereum miners, who will likely lose a significant chunk — if not all — of their income in a PoS world.
2. The recent market rout broke the souls of the “Zhu-percycle” bulls who were big on Ethereum and DeFi this cycle, turning them into a horde of indiscriminate sellers.
3. The “buy the rumour, sell the news” phenomenon post-merge will not occur. Anyone who might sell has likely already sold due to the intense downward price movement over the past month.
4. The merge means that Ether becomes a deflationary currency, and usage is forecasted to continue growing as DeFi gains popularity– increasing the rate of deflation.
5. Although there are other Layer-1 smart contract network competitors, many of them already feature some version of a PoS consensus algorithm. Ether is the only major cryptocurrency currently transitioning from PoW to a PoS.

The last point is extremely important. This change is a one-time event. There will never be another investing setup like what we’re seeing today. That is why my shot shall ring true, powered by Ether.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=hLYt22ckzZE&lc=Ugz-iFm1HNdyGMY-Wz54AaABAg
(My 2022 Bitcoin Price Prediction - Long Term & Short Term | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

There are numerous errors in your macro analysis. The 10 year chart does not indicate the top was already in. It indicates that the 10Y has been coming down while the S&P topped prematurely when it should have still been rising — thus a reversion to correct this discrepancy is incoming now. This is one of several indicators that the stock market will make new ATHs no later than Q1 2023. Then the peak will be in and a mega crash ahead later in 2023. Also your Fib ring comparing 2019 to 2020/21 is misleading you. That smaller fractal pattern in 2019 is expanding to become much larger which is why the bottom level you expected has not come sooner. Arthur Hayes recently blogged explaining all the Fed's QT has been sanitized and actually the aggregate measures of money supplied has still been increasing but this has been done surreptitiously so most people are entirely fooled right now, and that unfortunately includes you.
Note
ADD: I should add that earnings are not going to crash now. The relevant metrics will surprisingly improve as the 2Y peaks and comes down over the next months. The earnings and labor recession is coming later in 2023. The expectation of an earnings crash is already priced in and is wrong.
Note
GoT continues to provide excellent analysis:

youtu.be/yFcMYPNXNDc
(THIS is Going to Cause HAVOC on the SP500 as Investors Capitulate Back into a Historical Run)
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=KTYNp4SuHHQ&lc=UgzBPcMwzk2XdVVDxv14AaABAg
(Bitcoin Macro Cycle Bottom - Best Case For Price)

Hedging your reputation bets now after being so cocky about a lower low still incoming. Also your snickering in the prior video about the misinterpretations that some people have about your use of the term ‘trap’ is extremely off putting. I told you when you first called for your 2D stochastic signal to drive BTC to a lower low that it would not and would bottom and then turn for a move to the upside, which is precisely what has happened.
Note
Monthly MACD has printed the reversal signal.

youtu.be/Al1-pgTs3NI?t=123
(BIGGEST TIME SENSITIVE BITCOIN SIGNAL OF 2022!!!!!)
Note
Wary about being long right now. S&P has already completed its back test:

snapshot
Note
Watch on 1.5X playback speed. Some salient bullish points. Note any significant pullback today or tomorrow should probably be bought:

youtu.be/bu97xW4gIJ8
(Is Crypto About To Do The Unthinkable? (Massive Bitcoin Move Incoming))
Note
I am betting the move will be the upside.

twitter.com/theirish_man/status/1569202187133227009
(click for chart of price moves following CPI releases)
Note
Get ready for the mental shift to bullish:

youtu.be/pb_z5YObHLo
(Time Has Run Out! (Will Crypto Pump OR Dump Today?))
Note
I am reloading some BTC, ETH, ADA now. Looks to me that BTC wants to head up to 23.3k at the 200 DMA which is also the major downtrend line going back to the Nov 2021 peak if drawn on the non-log-scaled chart.

Also I visualize on ETH and ADA some hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly after retracing a bit. And all 3 are still shy of hidden, bearish divergence on the daily. This bullish move appears to still have a bit more legs to the upside yet. Perhaps ETH to $1820+, ADA to 0.52+ and SPX even looks like it might rally all the way up to the posited prior H&S neckline at ~4140.

I could be wrong and further retracement before the next leg up. In that case I will buy more on the way down.
Note
There is your pullback. Buy it.

The hidden, bullish RSI divergences are not yet 100% assured to have reached their maximum downside targets on ETH and BTC. ADA has hit them on all time frames going back as far as the Aug 28 low. So just in case we might get a bounce here I bought all the ADA I want on this pullback. I am waiting a bit to reload ETH and BTC. Again I maintain that the low was in June. The volatility now is to shake the trees of weak hands before heading up in earnest. The VIX is much too high right now for them to break to lower lows unless the VIX is going to have a breakout from its major overhead support, which I highly doubt (anything is possible but I know the correct probabilistic action is to buy when my fear of unlikely outcomes is maximized).
Note
I know you guys don’t have enough free time to watch this video, so I will just say I agree with Meet Kevin’s conclusion that CPI would need to spike to new ATHs to send the markets to lower lows. And that is not going to be happening. This CPI report was a bit worse than expected but I know retail used car prices are starting to decline again in September after wholesale used car prices had a huge drop in August. The CPI is measured in a whacko way, but the fact is that inflation sentiment indicates the next report next month will surprise in a good way. I really think Armstrong’s Panic Cycle for the week of Oct 17 will be a massive surge to the upside.

youtu.be/F9eK0Pu1kQc
(Critical Inflation Report - COMPLETE DISASTER | Meet Kevin)
Note
Bearish RSI divergences for the DXY on all time frames. May get one more rally up to 111. Remember guys that when fearful that is the time act opposite to your fears. Let data guide your decisions. The DXY and U.S. Treasuries have divergences. We are being given a second change to buy the June bottom. Don’t miss it twice because of fear.

snapshot
Note
Confluence for the top on the DXY is ~111 with the major monthly overhead resistance:

snapshot
Note
After further review given that U.S. Treasuries and DXY although both developing bearish RSI divergences, have some more upside over the next week or two. Thus regardless of any bounce in risk-on markets, likely have another move down possibly to test the early Sept low. S&P may eventually test 3800 and break down from its critical uptrend line support, scaring the fck out of everyone. May get an interim bounce from 19.6k for BTC if not at current level.

Further pain ahead guys. Get defensive until later in September or October.
Note
Treasuries are suggesting another test of the June lows for risk-on markets. Be wary. I will step aside from the markets for a while and let them settle down a bit. VIX might shoot up to 32 before this completed.

youtu.be/van3_X5fslQ?t=168
(For the 4th Time in 2022 the SP500 is Rejected After Being WRONG About Inflation. | Game of Trades)
Note
Steve @ Crypto Crew University has recognized what I noticed also that ADA will rocket soon, perhaps by October. Look to accumulate this one near the lows this month! Headed to $2 at least.

Steve said based on the facts in this chart, the bottom is in. ADA could be the canary in the coal mine. It may be telling us the bottom is in for crypto.

I am tired of trading this bottom. I want to buy and hodl. I am looking to buy on the incoming lows in September and then ignore the markets for a couple of months or so.

youtu.be/cXpvCgPy95E
(ATTENTION: This Altcoin Could EXPLODE | Crypto Crew University)
Note
I THINK BTC WILL CATAPULT TO 28 — 34k DURING THE WEEK OF OCT 17. This is based on Armstrong’s Panic Cycle for the DJIA (which I think will be to the upside as inflation reports finally turn down) and also the timing relative to the 50 cross below the 100 DMA and catapult in 2019 at this posited corresponding juncture to the 50 DMA.

Risk-on markets are reeling again because the U.S. CPI report was worse than expected, but leading indicators say the next report in Oct will shock to the downside. Massive bearish divergences on the dollar and Treasury bonds with perhaps one final hanging man wick up then timberrrr!

Although it was quite a MAJOR bullish development recently for BTC to print on the daily chart both — bullish RSI divergence (comparing Aug 28 and Sep 6 lows) — and hidden, bullish RSI divergence (comparing July 1 and Sep 6 lows); but expectations were premature hence formed MINOR hidden, bearish RSI divergence comparing the Aug 13 and Sep 13 highs.

Ditto on the weekly chart, there was MAJOR hidden, bullish RSI divergence (comparing the March 2020 and June 2022 lows), but hence formed MINOR hidden, bearish RSI divergence comparing the Aug 8 and Sep 5 highs.

Thus I conclude a high likelihood of a decline below the 18.7k Sep 6 low to form probably (non-hidden and hidden) bullish RSI divergence on both the weekly and daily (respectively), thus completing and reversing the recent turn to MINOR bearish conditions. The S&P is also threatening to break down to ~3800 at the 0.786 Fib from its uptrend line off the June lows, where it would also form hidden, bullish RSI divergence with the Sep 6 low which was at the 0.618 Fib level after forming hidden, bearish RSI divergence comparing the Aug 25 and Sep 13 highs (both on the daily chart).

Not clear if there will be a bounce to a level between 20.8 – 21.8k first. There was a bullish, RSI divergence on the 2 hourly chart earlier today but then bounced and quickly formed hidden, bearish RSI divergence. These lower time frames may provide no directional information unless there can form another bullish RSI divergence with a much greater range of the RSI to provide more room to run up. Otherwise the 4 hourly and daily are still bearishly postured but could allow for a bounce. Possibly a drop to the low 19k range might form hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly in which case I would expect the bounce. OPTICALARTdotCOM has the $19150 level as support.
Note
Steve has published another video:

youtu.be/6vB_op7h-yg
(Warning: Everyone is WRONG About Bitcoin Crash In October – This Will Happen Instead)

I commented:

The October CPI report will shock in a good way and then markets will boom. There are massive bearish RSI divergences on the dollar and Treasuries. Get ready. The bottom was in June.
Note
For all you who are new to the crypto market. Maybe this only your first or second bear market.

Realize that all the gyrations we have been through over the past months is what is required to carve out a bottom. It is at the point like this where we are exasperated that finally the market bottoms and turns up.

Realize this entire crash has been about inflation and rising interest rates. All leading indicators (e.g. inflation expectations) have been trending down since May. That indicator normally has a 3 to 4 month lead time on actual movement of the CPI. The CPI lags because of the way it is calculated (e.g. owner equivalent rents) and other factors. Also rents tend to go up for 6 months while housing prices are dropping because the high interest rates force more people to rent that would instead normally buy. Thus the Fed tends to look at the PPI (producer's price inflation) as a more accurate indication of current inflation than CPI.

Also the doom has been priced in. Nothing is going to get worse than already expected until later in 2023. Inflation is coming down already and that will accelerate. Also the repricing of the Euro for the incoming winter doom is already done for the time being. The dollar and Treasuries have bearish divergence and will stop rising for some months hence, which always correlates with the risk markets going up.

Also the actual recessionary crash never occurs until the unemployment is rising and the Fed starts easing. We are currently in the part of the cycle where there will be one final move back up before the egregious recessionary crash.
Note
I commented again on Steve’s latest video…

Steve although I agree with everything you said in this video, Bitcoin will go below 10k in late 2023 or 2024 when the 2008 like 63% crash comes to the S&P. Mark my words. Bitcoin will rally now, but that March 2020 flash crash is going to repeat when Russia starts WW3. Remember I told you.

> I wonder how come you have only 275k subscribers! Your videos and analysis are awesome!

Because many people are offended by his self-aggrandizing style. I am not. I recognize his skills. I am interested in substance and his style is not that bad.

Another reason might be that some people are put off by his use of charts that are very simple. And that he explains in a very simple way. Also many people do not like being told they are wrong. The herd goes the opposite and Steve does not tell them what their emotions want to hear.
Note
Very important news. This averted one threat that could have changed my thesis about inflation falling over the next months in the USA:

Railroad strike averted after marathon talks reach tentative deal
Note
K-dub made some good points about this being a great time to buy Bitcoin.

youtu.be/o59JeIMS3tc
(BITCOIN!!!!!!! THIS IS F*#%ING INSANE!!!!!! ABSOLUTELY LIFE CHANGING!!!!!!!!!!!!!!🚨| Crypto Zombie)
Note
Meet Kevin points out that Core inflation was still increasing at a month-over-month annualized rate of 7.2%. I rebuked his narrative:

youtube.com/watch?v=6i9JXrT-9ak&lc=UgxnJvmOigxfrpf8S5x4AaABAg
(Forget Recession | The Fed will Crush us into Depression.)

Was that CPI report skewed by back-to-school demand? If Treasuries and DXY top (both of which have massive bearish RSI divergence on both weekly and daily charts) then the stock markets run up. An elevated CPI may have nothing to do with it. When the narrative shifts that CPI is not the correct metric to be looking at and that the future Fed hikes are already priced in, then stock markets will run.
Note
Most people think the Fed is doing QT:

PRIVATE BLOG – Fed Stops MBS Purchases for Now | Martin Armstrong

But in fact they are deceiving us. Even Armstrong is deceived. They are actually still flooding the economy with money while making us think they are tightening. The markets are going rocket.

Teach Me Daddy | Arthur Hayes
Note
Looking past the USD bull market | Sept 12

“Those who have been reading my stuff for a while know I’ve been bearish equities, bullish yields, and bullish USD for a while. Today I am flipping that view and reorienting my portfolio towards long commodities (both long term and short term), long crypto, short USD, and neutral yields.”
Note
I am buying crypto now. We have the hidden bullish RSI divergences I was expecting to form. Might edge a bit lower.
Note
If I annotate the non-log-scaled DXY (aka USD) monthly chart with this interpretation of the channel, then the dollar topped already with bearish RSI divergence (i.e. higher highs on price with only lower respective RSI highs) on the monthly and 3 drives of it on the weekly and daily charts.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Finally registered the bearish RSI divergence on the 10Y U.S. Treasuries chart as well. So bottom is in. We’re primed to rockets up in October.
Note
Note we have intensive bullish RSI divergences on all time frames but S&P, BTC and ETH have a hidden bearish RSI divergence on the 4-hourly chart. Also the V-shared BTC bounce is probably too fast. S&P is at overhead resistance of the major support trend line which it broke down from. Probable that the markets trade down one more time to test these Sep lows. Maybe on the Fed meeting on Sept 21. I purchased 18.4k so I am taking some short-term profits so I can buy the last retest. Wisest may be to just buy and hodl but I will try to squeeze a bit more juice out of that orange. ETH didn’t form bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly in the way BTC did but it bounced off its key 200 DMA and at a key level for daily bullish RSI divergence. Yet it might be in the cards for ETH to wick down to ~1250 to provide bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly and elect a more long-term RSI divergence on the daily. Or I could be wrong and nothing will be back tested.
Note
An absolute MUST WATCH video from Steve which makes it absolutely certain that June was the Bitcoin bottom and gives us the exact price for incoming top. Also my comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=at8sIAvJ0x4&lc=UgwSI1bsFLJST8XYm8F4AaABAg.9g5EnuAk5FG9gAf6ufpnC7
(The UGLY REALITY of Bitcoin Next Bull Run TOP | Crypto Crew University)

crypto Crew University the ~70k top will be in 2023. I have explained why on my trading (view). Also I noticed this pattern of repeating 5.3 last summer. Nice to see someone popularize it.
Note
Follow-up:

youtube.com/watch?v=at8sIAvJ0x4&lc=UgwSI1bsFLJST8XYm8F4AaABAg.9g5EnuAk5FG9gAgXqCmoEU

crypto Crew University you have almost unlocked the entire Pandora’s box. The anomaly that is coming has been known by Satoshi since 2010 when he wrote about turning corrupted gold (i.e. the 2017 soft fork) back to gold again. Your remaining myopia in terms of understanding how this diminishing returns 90k top could co-exist with a million lambos top is that Bitcoin will bifurcate with the incoming Anyone Can Spend Nash equilibrium restoration. I have been trying to get you to pay attention but you and other vloggers ostensibly refuse to read the inarguable game theory I have published. This also ties into the constructive interference of fractal waves which will cause the ~90k top to be in 2023 as an extensive wave as was the case in the 2013 bull cycle. If you want to understand why Bitcoin has fallen out of your log-regression fit then you need to understand properly the Anyone Can Spend technological facet and game theory.

> “crypto Crew University wolves of crypto posted a vid to "debunk" this vid. Not sure if you want to respond to it.”

@Carlo.mb25 my replies here to Steve explain the anomaly and thus debunk Wolves of Crypto. I also commented on his video to inform him. Find the relevant nugget in my replies in the comment section on the page found if you search verbatim for: trading view "2023 - Year From Hell"

The soft forked variant of Bitcoin will go to zero. Make sure you read what I told Wolves of Crypto to read and that you are hodling in addresses that begin with 1, not 3 nor bc1.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=g8NYXQtuO4c&lc=Ugzxzzk77CVFpIBK7r54AaABAg.9g8cdh246Kz9gAsdp74jWh

> > “I did this same math. Could btc actually go to zero like they said? Will ETH after merge show king of all alts and decouple? Btc could go mainstream and become more affordable while the other projects we’ve invested gain dominance. We may have to go through the growing pains as a whole that btc is not practical for dailyt ransactions ”
>
> Whale Talk I don't think Bitcoin needs to be seen as something used for daily transactions to retain its no.1 spot. Bitcoin's goal is to be a universal store of value away from centralised systems and an easier, cheaper and faster way to conduct border-less transactions. I think there is plenty of use in what I just described for it to retain its position and grow massively, probably more use than a daily cryptocurrency.


wolves of Crypto correct Bitcoin was always intended to be the next world reserve currency, not some irrelevant toy for purchasing coffee at Starbucks. Now when you understand that Bitcoin is the 1989 Economist Magazine’s cover story Phoenix and that its design was even leaked in an anonymous 1998 user group post, then you are getting closer to opening Pandora’s box and piecing together the diabolical plan as I have already done. You ignore the technological and game theory facts I know at your peril.

Find the relevant nugget in my replies in the comment section on the page found if you search verbatim for: trading view "2023 - Year From Hell"

The soft forked variant of Bitcoin will go to zero. Make sure you read what I told Wolves of Crypto to read and that you are hodling in addresses that begin with 1, not 3 nor bc1.

wolves of Crypto The anomaly that is coming has been known by Satoshi since 2010 when he wrote about turning corrupted gold (i.e. the 2017 soft fork) back to gold again. Steve has almost unlocked the entire Pandora’s box. His remaining myopia in terms of understanding how this diminishing returns 90k top could co-exist with a million lambos top is that Bitcoin will bifurcate with the incoming Anyone Can Spend Nash equilibrium restoration. I have been trying to get him to pay attention but he and other vloggers ostensibly refuse to read the inarguable game theory I have published. This also ties into the constructive interference of fractal waves which will cause the ~90k top to be in 2023 as an extensive wave as was the case in the 2013 bull cycle. If you want to understand why Bitcoin has fallen out of his log-regression fit then he needs to understand properly the Anyone Can Spend technological facet and game theory.

> “I would also like to add that anyone who thinks the bottom in this bear market will be lower than 15k AND believes in Crypto Crew's analysis is, by default, claiming that Bitcoin will never see an ATH again.”

wolves of Crypto trust me, you're ignorant of what I know. You would be wise to schedule a phone call with me so I can enlighten you.

> “I wonder if this is an indication that Bitcoin will be running its course, and 90K is the most the world can sustain for environmentally-unsustainable proof-of-work? Perhaps this is an indication that ETH, ADA, and others will take over in this and following cycles…
>
> I would love to see your 4-year-cycle analysis consider crypto market cap instead of BTC market cap.”


scott W environmentally sustained, lol. You and 70% of my other fellow Westerners are gripped with the junk science religion that Carl Sagan warned us would come.

> “S. Moore I’m an engineer. I worked for a few years in the oil industry. Now I teach math and science. I know the science, and Carl Sagan also knew the science.”

scott W Carl Sagan has been entirely debunked for example about the prospects for a nuclear winter. And anthropogenic climate change is if anything highly beneficial although the sun spot cycle dominates any effect humans have. Partake of for example 180 IQ Freeman Dyson's interview on the topic before he passed on in 2020 sadly.

20 year old, 160 IQ Naomi Seibt has done an admirable job of explaining the junk science of the CPCC.

As I am sure you know that environment is not at all the same as climate. And the two are not even loosely linked. And you did write environment, not climate. The Carbon cycle is the life cycle of our planet. Environmental concentration maybe behooves us to use EVs in crowded cities but this isn’t applicable on the aggregate such as climate. Base load can’t be provided by solar and wind. Bitcoin’s electrical security cost is declining as a percentage of market cap with the 4 year halving cycle.
Note
Fed’s Summary of Economic Projections to be released on Wednesday morning might be the catalyst for one final thrust to test lows. But nobody knows. Could surprise in a way that causes the markets to rocket. I keep my eye on Martin Armstrong’s Socrates Forecast Array for DJIA that has a Panic Cycle for the week of October 17. I expect that to be a massive rocket to the upside. So I am think it is a bit premature to get all excited about the bottom being in.

youtu.be/4uFCDI74LvE
(*Critical* Fed Docs | Know THIS. | Meet Kevin)
Note
The bearish RSI divergences on all time frames up to monthly on the DXY, 2Y and 10Y Treasuries all point to the bottom was June and the last pullback is this week. Liftoff in October. Arthur Hayes pointed out in his blog Teach Me Daddy that the Fed is fooling us because all the QT has been sanitized and actually the money spigot has been turned back on surreptitiously via reverse repos and Treasury spending.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=B-8eSEwnMLM&lc=UgwnR2DQ2H7TUonBfK54AaABAg.9gAI6qfdmBv9gBE1tq8C6L
(Don’t Fight the Fed: Why SP500 Investors are About to Get CRUSHED By This Common Saying. | Game of Trades)

> “Our 6-12 month target on the SP500 is 5200 points. Disinflation is happening and earnings are going to hold up, that will provide fuel for a rapid recovery.”

Game of Trades I think the October 13 CPI report will surprise to the downside as consumers probably spent their wad in August for back-to-school and now have every reason to wait until Xmas given prices are finally starting to come down. Everyone seems worried about earnings but those are already priced in by the pessimistic forward guidance last month.

Game of Trades another factor is the $4 trillion savings glut accumulated during the pLandemic. This would normally go significantly into housing but with high interest rates housing is declining. Initially as interest rates start rising people rush to buy thinking rates will continue higher. But as rates plateau everyone is in a wait and see mode waiting for the bottom in the housing market. Thus $4 trillion has no where to go but back into the stock market, because it is not going to sit in the sidelines (while inflation erodes their cash value) or in crowded risk-off trades that have massive bearish RSI divergences on all chart time frames.
Note
im skeptical of the 10k and lower price calls myself but im not very confident. my best guess is not lower than 15k. its starting to feel like when we were in 2018 at around 3K when everyone was calling for 1k

For 15k Bitcoin then S&P would decline too far and lose its bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart. It’s not clear if it could form a new bullish RSI divergence on the weekly — it would be splitting hairs. It just doesn’t make sense for the S&P to put in a lower low. There’s no catalyst for it to. The CPI is coming down. Everyone is worried about earnings but they have been worried about that since August. Everyone is so bearish and that is the best time to buy.
Note
Rip your face off rally ahead! He is pointing out what I did.

youtu.be/wSf27BoONSo
(We could be lining up for a 'face-ripper' rally here, says Ritholtz's Josh Brown)
Note
$18–19k or $15–16k. Does it really matter? Don't stare a gift horse in the mouth. The market could run away from us while we are waiting on the sidelines for a measly 2k additional “crash“. I am not going to fail to buy this second chance to buy the bottom.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=gXZWgjDxb00&lc=UgwLHlHnjOtmzzmVR8R4AaABAg
(Bitcoin Price Is Getting Worse)

Your 2-day and 5-day Stoch pivots are coming down. Two day at 19.7k and will be lower 2 days from now. Ditto the 5-day pivot at 20.1k and coming down. There is no way they can sustain to the downside. The 5-day signal will complete and reset. The 2-day is going to trigger to the upside. The bottom was June. Your prior video was more balanced and you entertained what I am writing here. Suddenly with Bitcoin making a bear trap wick, you leap to your long-standing, wrong-headed hopium that Bitcoin will print a lower low. Massive bullish RSI divergences in play and I bought that 18.4k wick aggressively (which has turned into a bullish hammer as I was expecting it even before it wicked down).
Note
youtu.be/aDAmwBtdZBw?t=361
(Bitcoin past the point of no return! Crash to 7k now Inevitable! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

youtube.com/watch?v=aDAmwBtdZBw&lc=UgxR5_GARMcorglCoZZ4AaABAg.9g9x-Hj6f4I9gBYrVHXrgS

@OPTICALARTdotCOM the major Fib circle has not yet been broken with a close below. It was just a wick below. If you notice there is a very distinct difference between the prior occurrence when Bitcoin bounced off both the upper Fib circle and the major Fib diagonal. Whereas the Fib circle was very far from the level where Bitcoin bounced in June. I bet your so-called ‘God line’ will be broken to the upside and then you will have to entirely change your stance about heading down to 7k. There are massive bearish RSI divergences on the DXY and Treasury interest rates on all time frames from daily through the monthly charts. Bad earnings were already priced in by the pessimistic forward guidance in August. Everyone is bearish right now. You are in the crowded trade amigo. You are not the contrarian now as you were months ago.
Note
@OPTICALARTdotCOM why do you ignore that there was a higher high in November? Thus your red line should be positioned higher where Bitcoin bottomed in June. That is not rocket science. You mislabeled your own chart.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=aDAmwBtdZBw&lc=UgzVVhkuVE8OCR-2-hV4AaABAg.9gAD931L2fR9gBbXapm0Ci

> > “Hey Steve wish I could show you something that goes to show that even 7k or even 3k might not be the actual bottom I’ve noticed people haven’t brought this up but I’ll mention it, if you look at the weekly and monthly and go log chart. You will see a bearish gartley that makes the the range of 3050 all the way to 19k we have left arm of the divergence of 2014/15 low to the right arm that goes to 69k it drops after the bullish divergence ends which is why we rolled over and are dropping keep an eye on price if it goes below 3050 the harmonic triggers and we will have a 2008 crash scenario a good example is look at the gbpusd chart from 2008 and compare to btc you will see how we have similar price action we also have a sma bear cross on the weekly where dxy has a bullish cross so if you analyse this it’s gonna be a long bear market because dxy is hell bent and is being manipulated to push a global crash”
>
> Michael Collins I am sure there are other indicators to show confluence. I trust the p1 chart for bottom. That line is at a downward sloping angle so we can go much lower. However i will buy on contact.


@OPTICALARTdotCOM indeed eventually it comes back down to that thick red line you annotated on your p1 chart. Yet you ignore that November 2021 was a higher high and thus there is another higher, parallel red line in play which is very thinly annotated on your chart which exactly corresponded to the June bottom. It is very likely that we will see a significant rally off that line before we see a crash to your lower thick red line. And we have other evidence that my stance is the more likely one than going immediately to 7k now. That includes for example the massive bearish RSI divergences on all chart time frames for the dollar (DXY) and the interest rates for 2Y and 10Y treasury bonds. Also the bad earnings reports coming were already priced in with the pessimistic forward guidance from many companies in August. Additionally Arthur Hayes has pointed out in his blog Teach Me Daddy that actually the Fed has been sanitizing all the QT and actually expanding the money spigot by increasing liquidity via the repo market and Treasury fund being drawn down and spent into the economy. There are many other reasons I have enumerated at my trading view.

Michael Collins To understand why that will happen, search for this verbatim on the Internet (not on YT): trading view "2023 - Year From Hell"
Note
Michael Collins I’m unable to visualize the Gartley pattern with your incoherent description. I do see a bearish Deep Crab harmonic pattern from the 2018 high to the 30k level in Jan 2021. Then a bullish Butterfly harmonic pattern formed projecting to the June bottom.

snapshot
Note
Ritholtz’s Josh Brown followed up and I commented:

youtube.com/watch?v=WcuSJhN0R1U&lc=Ugy4OC1XnCUsiZKbazt4AaABAg
(26% of stocks are in an uptrend, says Ritholtz CEO Josh Brown)

Ignore the blonde. She doesn’t seem to comprehend that the 2Y Treasury is forward looking out 6 months which is the minimum delay for Fed rate hikes to take effect. The rest of 2022 the Fed will merely be catching up with the 4% the 2Y already priced in. The only possible scare tomorrow at 2pm EST is if the Survey of Economic Projections has a terminal rate much higher than 4%.

> “Josh predicted what happened in June after two 75bps will happen again, except it won't! Everyone was expecting more sell-off but was caught off guard, and now everyone is anticipating how bad could earnings get! It's no longer about the fed, but it's about earnings. Wait till probably the first 2 weeks of earnings season in October.”

Harly Slamm The earnings pessimism and the 4% terminal rate are already priced in by the market. Up we go.

> “Most stocks are either in a down trend or in a sideways trend. Maybe 2% of stocks are in an up trend. We are in a bear market and the market goes down till Fed is done raising rates. So maybe mid 2023”

Albert Insinger Not as defined by Josh as being still above their 200 DMA.

> “Josh is not a clairvoyant. Don't listen to his stock market direction calls. He is a good yapper but it is ridiculous to rely on his market calls. If you followed his advice yesterday, you got burned because the market is down 2% since. Stick to his individual calls and then do your own due diligence.”

Donnie Moder Not if you bought the panic wick down before his call was published and sold the bounce as I did. Now I am reaccumulating but with a cautious eye towards a possible final wick down tomorrow. He is correct that the 2Y already priced in the future Fed rate hikes. And the earnings pessimism was priced in by August’s decline. We are primed to rockets in mid-October when the CPI comes in lower.

> “So if everyone is expecting as face ripping rally where can the market go to provide maximum pain?”

dptdgclick5132 Nobody is expecting that. Just read the comments here. The bearish case is as crowded as a fraternity hazing in a telephone booth.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=WcuSJhN0R1U&lc=UgzY_yX85_fM-te3Srt4AaABAg.9gChAcFegE89gDmlrTwDIp

> “Investors knows the effect of rate hikes is a cumulative of nature and takes times to impact earnings fully. Only new debts will be financed at higher rates, and it takes a while for the ratio of new debts to old debts "financed at low rates" to creep higher. Having said that, earnings will grind lower slowly before they turn negative. You will hear the narrative that earnings "is not as bad as we thought" for a while to talk the market higher. But investors are not to be fooled this time as understand the nature of the lag.”

HARF Wajna3 You almost got that right except 2Y will be coming down as the Fed is hiking. Thus earnings outlook will improve after the extreme pessimism of August. And the consumer will be fighting slightly less inflation. The single largest factor though is that markets overshoot on momentum so once they get moving to the upside with the tailwind of peak DXY peak 2Y behind us until 2023, then can you say new ATH? I know you can.

youtube.com/watch?v=WcuSJhN0R1U&lc=UgwWMqreNhr1J0CyVOl4AaABAg.9gCuxvGY4bB9gDn0gryuTp

> “S. Moore YouTube comments are filled with broke bears they don't represent reality. Investors keep buying the dips”

dptdgclick5132 strong hands are buying the dips. The max pain is felt when the weak hands buy the new ATH.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=B-8eSEwnMLM&lc=Ugy9efeF1iBCNTKopRR4AaABAg.9gAdGCDfwFW9gDwXWfoHZ3

> “S. Moore Read that article a while ago. Arthur's a great writer & agree w him on the importance of liq. But- TGA is on its way back up & RRP has been at the same level for a few months now. Fed holdings are down as of Q2 ( can't find newer data on that), so there has been a bit of tightening. Supposedly they are selling 50B of treasuries as we speak. Not saying we wont get another rally in october but don't see breaking ATH anytime soon.”

@blottolotto thanks for the update. TGA up might be reloading their gun to ease again before the election? The case for new ATHs is more about the 2Y and DXY dropping or at least topped for now.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=WcuSJhN0R1U&lc=UgzepfffGEjZLDEBWfx4AaABAg.9gCieOeAL9u9gEBy5ipg7R

> “S. Moore Yea if these stocks going sideways now fall below their 200 day MA then a lot of selling will take place. You have herd “ Don t fight the Fed” Josh is basically trying to fight the Fed. Not wise. It is better to be in cash on the sidelines till the Fed is done raising rates. No one knows when inflation will come down. Biden keeps printing money. So Fed rate could well go above 6-7%. That would mean the S&P 500 could go below 3000. When things go down. Usually everything goes down.”

Albert Insinger if the bearish RSI divergences on the DXY (dollar) and 2Y treasuries are correct that they have topped, then the stock market is going up. 2Y can fall while Fed is hiking. The 2Y is what the economy actually pays, the Fed funds only applies to overnight loans between banks.The moving parts in this equation are more complex than your simpleton conceptualization.

Albert Insinger you need to understand that different variables are moving out-of-phase with each other. So timing is critical. Typically the stock market makes a new ATH after the Fed starts hiking and does not crash until the Fed starts easing when unemployment starts rising. Good luck buying the top.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=WcuSJhN0R1U&lc=UgzepfffGEjZLDEBWfx4AaABAg.9gCieOeAL9u9gFFSSzD7s6

> “S. Moore If you look at past bear markets. They usually end with a crash. But I doubt we are there yet. Lots of these financial guys are still saying “buy here”. Once a recession hits then the E in P/E (for earnings) gets hit. So what looks cheap now starts looking expensive and that usually causes the crash. Then after the crash P/E s look cheap again. Look at Shiller P/E index.”

Albert Insinger yes they do but we are not in a bear market yet. That is the entire point of the 26% of stocks still being above their 200 DMA and the point that I told you that bear markets historically do not start until the Fed starts reducing rates. I already explained the mechanism — the Fed is behind the curve as 2Y already hit the 4% terminal rate thus 2Y will be falling while the Fed is raising. Thus earnings and the damage to the economy will be slowing down or abating somewhat while the Fed is raising. Later though that damage will in the aggregate cause the economy to rollover with unemployment rising at which point the Fed will start to ease and the bear market will begin after we make new ATHs. This is counterintuitive for most people which is why they are so bearish. Note if the Survey of Economic Reports comes out today with a terminal rate above 4% then there could be more downside. If after some months the terminal rate is raised because CPI does not start coming down, then there could be more downside.
Note
Fed’s expectations of the terminal rate came in hot 4.6% so the 2Y has moved above 4% and the DXY hit 111. The VIX also spiked. But I still think this is the Fed shooting out max pain and the bottom was June. Bitcoin has not tanked. But the S&P is moving lower. Maybe BTC will make one more move lower? Yet BTC has been not making lower lows past days as the S&P has been. BTC is the canary in the coal mine that the bottom is in?

snapshot
Note
Fed pointed out something very important and different from prior recessions. The labor market is incredibly supply side limited in the USA with two job offerings for every willing applicant. Thus a wage price spiral of inflation could be sustained until the Fed breaks the economy. This is imbalance is what happens when the government is handing out money like fruit cakes to everyone with a pulse. Thus the Bolsheviks running the USA have made it impossible to contain inflation.
Note
Remember I had written I expected one more wick down and that ETH would come below 1250.

It’s not entirely bullish nor entirely bearish short-term. S&P has lost its bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart so needs to drop slightly further (but not lower than June) to form hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily. I can’t rule out a lower low to form another bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart (there was one back in June) but that will correspond with a loss of any hidden bullish RSI divergence that had formed on the daily chart.

BTC had formed hidden bearish RSI divergence with that spike up pre-Fed and now bullish RSI divergence since on the 4 hourly chart. There is plenty of room to the downside and said bullish divergence would not be lost. Looks like it is trying to bounce from current levels as I am writing this. Has not lost the bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart from Aug 29 and Sep 6 but could decline below the 17.6k June low (but not too far below) and still retain bullish RSI divergence. Ditto for the bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart. So in a nutshell based on RSI divergences alone, Bitcoin could bottom any where between current price and ~16k. No way Bitcoin is going to 13k. And 7k is nonsensical.

The Fed fired its final shots today hoping the bond market will go higher, but it’s likely the bond market has rejected the Fed and shown they are not going to raise rates much higher than 4% before they create a recession that causes them to pause and/or ease.

Ditto ETH as BTC on the 4 hourly and the weekly. ETH has breached below its 200 DMA which stands at ~1280. May bounce to at least there. ETH already has hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily but this will not be lost until below the ~900 June low. ETH appears to have an A-B-C correction underway from the August rally top. C is often longer than A so that could indicate more downside.

Eric Krown Crypto’s 2-day statistical signal just triggered to the downside. The two standard deviation event least decline from ~20.3k would be ~16%, thus 17k. The one standard deviation event least decline would be ~24% thus 15.4k. This should resolve within the next 2 – 3 weeks maximum.

There is a chance his indicator could flip bullish in the next 2 days.

Markets often rally after a Fed meeting, but that was not the case after Powell talked tough at Jackson Hole in August. Also I think the market will start to realize that the Fed is saying inflation may not decline for as long as Brandon keeps handing out stimi checks so that people do not have to work. This sort of implies we are screwed and that inflation may be sticky. So then the market has to decide what level of sticky that is and what level interest rates need to rise to. My bet based on the bearish RSI divergences on the 2Y, 10Y and DXY is that the bond market has already sniffed this out.

So I am only at most looking for one final capitulation to FUD because there are still weak hands who probably think the sky is falling because they do not reason it out that even if employment remains unbalanced and inflation is sticky, that sticky is at some terminal interest rate which could be achieved well before the economy rolls over and unemployment increases.
Note
Remember I had written I expected one more wick down and that ETH would come below 1250.

It’s not entirely bullish nor entirely bearish short-term. S&P has lost its bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart so needs to drop slightly further (but not lower than June) to form hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily. I can’t rule out a lower low to form another bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart (there was one back in June) but that will correspond with a loss of any hidden bullish RSI divergence that had formed on the daily chart.

BTC had formed hidden bearish RSI divergence with that spike up pre-Fed and now bullish RSI divergence since on the 4 hourly chart. There is plenty of room to the downside and said bullish divergence would not be lost. Looks like it is trying to bounce from current levels as I am writing this. Has not lost the bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart from Aug 29 and Sep 6 but could decline below the 17.6k June low (but not too far below) and still retain bullish RSI divergence. Ditto for the bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart. So in a nutshell based on RSI divergences alone, Bitcoin could bottom any where between current price and ~16k. No way Bitcoin is going to 13k. And 7k is nonsensical.

The Fed fired its final shots today hoping the bond market will go higher, but it’s likely the bond market has rejected the Fed and shown they are not going to raise rates much higher than 4% before they create a recession that causes them to pause and/or ease.

Ditto ETH as BTC on the 4 hourly and the weekly. ETH has breached below its 200 DMA which stands at ~1280. May bounce to at least there. ETH already has hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily but this will not be lost until below the ~900 June low. ETH appears to have an A-B-C correction underway from the August rally top. C is often longer than A so that could indicate more downside.

Eric Krown Crypto’s 2-day statistical signal just triggered to the downside. The two standard deviation event least decline from ~20.3k would be ~16%, thus 17k. The one standard deviation event least decline would be ~24% thus 15.4k. This should resolve within the next 2 – 3 weeks maximum.

There is a chance his indicator could flip bullish in the next 2 days.

Markets often rally after a Fed meeting, but that was not the case after Powell talked tough at Jackson Hole in August. Also I think the market will start to realize that the Fed is saying inflation may not decline for as long as Brandon keeps handing out stimi checks so that people do not have to work. This sort of implies we are screwed and that inflation may be sticky. So then the market has to decide what level of sticky that is and what level interest rates need to rise to. My bet based on the bearish RSI divergences on the 2Y, 10Y and DXY is that the bond market has already sniffed this out.

So I am only at most looking for one final capitulation to FUD because there are still weak hands who probably think the sky is falling because they do not reason it out that even if employment remains unbalanced and inflation is sticky, that sticky is at some terminal interest rate which could be achieved well before the economy rolls over and unemployment increases.
Note
My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=VkeB3NzYUI4&lc=UgzcYXagbZ8hDlq_eux4AaABAg
(The Fed JUST Began the GREAT RESET | NEW DANGERS. | Meet Kevin)

The Fed does not set the market rates. The bond market does. Jerome can threaten to keep raising rates until unemployment comes into balance, but the 2Y treasury is calling his bluff and saying he will never get there. I trust the market more than I trust the Fed. As Ross Gerber told you today that he is buying treasuries today. The market is voting and saying the Fed can’t go much higher than 4% over the next 6 months. There is massive bearish RSI divergence on the DXY, 2Y and 10Y.
Note
Futures markets expectations shifted upward ~0.25% on the Fed today. The 2Y was up only ~0.2% so far. The final capitulation is in its final throes.

cmegroup.com/trading/interest-rates/countdown-to-fomc.html
Note
youtu.be/Urn3Ipvukbo
(Johnson: The charts look pretty ugly right now, but they're starting to go sideways | NBC Television)

“Most investors don’t want to see it, don’t want to hear it.” 🙈🙉

“Would need a larger catalyst for markets to plunge.”
Note
Powell can not get employment back into balance except by crashing the economy. That is why the bond market is saying, “no you won’t” to the Fed’s 4.6% terminal rate target for 2023. Essentially his best hope is to keep rates elevated and wait for inflation to come down over a longer period of time. Powell said he is afraid of inflation expectations being sticky thus Powell is effectively telling the market he wants to crash the economy. Thus the market is buying bonds at 4% because they figure rates will plummet in 2023 or 2024 thus being a very profitable investment (bonds increase in value when interest rates drop and vice versa). Locking in 4% now for 2 years is the best investors think they can get. Thus the 2Y has topped according to the bearish RSI divergence signals.

youtu.be/1MGfGTGEp5o
(I just don't think the economy can take a 4.25 to 4.5% rate, says JPM's David Kelly)
Note
Exactly my thought before I watched the video:

“Everyone who was going to sell has already sold”

youtu.be/48qIRmAL3M4
(Why the Stock Market is About to Go Absolutely Crazy | Investors are NOT Ready. | Game of Trades)
Note
Finally filled that CME gap from 2021 which wasn’t quite filled in June. That had been one of my reasons for thinking Bitcoin would come back down. Have multiple drives of bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart. And both a hidden and non-hidden bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart. Dollar cost averaging in now can not go wrong!!!

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Correction: S&P already has hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily. It could add drives of it by coming lower but isn’t strictly required. Bottom could be in already for this Fed FUD.
Note
I am itching to load my crypto bags now!

The only factor holding me back is Eric Krown Crypto’s 2-day statistical indicator. But that could change direction in 2 days from now. I will look at that now with a fine tooth comb.
Note
I’m calling a bottom.

youtube.com/watch?v=STK44RYSORE&lc=Ugwu7Czuv61IbrarpkJ4AaABAg
(E.K.C.’s update)

The 5-day signal from Aug 4 has probably completed at -28% over 48 days which is at the maximum duration that signal has ever seen. Expecting that signal to continue (to October) as the new 2-day plays out doesn’t seem likely. The pivot for the 2-day continues to come down. It was 20.3k and now 19.8k. After two more days it can be even lower. It is quite clear that Bitcoin is coiling for a massive move to the upside. The 2-day volatility indicator will not decisively cross over until the pivot is to the upside. I am loading my crypto bags June was the bottom. We have bullish RSI divergences on all time frames from the 4-hourly up to the monthly. And bearish RSI divergences on all time frames for the DXY, 2Y and 10Y. “Wake me up when September ends.” You know that song.
Note
I forgot to add that the 2-day has in the past played out over as long as 34 days. So this well encompasses the Panic Cycle Martin Armstrong’s Socrates A.I. system has for the week of Oct 17. Again I expect that to be a Panic Cycle to the upside. We are headed up to fill that CME gap at 29k.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=Ipzt-VtaBEY&lc=UgxddhhbDgZqDevOA2B4AaABAg.9gHiou1oeEi9gHnxhOvbQY
(The Fed's U-turn is a COMPLETE Disaster | Worsening Reset. | Meet Kevin)

meet Kevin Men lie, women lie, but the charts do not lie! The bearish RSI divergences on the DXY, 2Y and 10Y coupled with bullish RSI divergences on BTC, ETH and S&P say the bottom for risk-on assets was June. The labor market imbalance is irrelevant in the sense that the bond market sets interest rates not the Fed. And the bond market has already voted and said that the Fed can’t get to 4.6% without crashing the economy — which they will do. But in the meantime market rates have likely peaked which means risk-on for some months until the economy rolls over. Simpleton investors do not realize that there are multiple moving parts moving out-of-phase with each other. Typically all unemployment recessions and market crashes begin when the Fed starts easing not during the rate hiking phase, given the mechanism I just outlined. Stock markets are headed back up to a new ATH by Q1 2023 before the actual unemployment recession.
Note
There is a 12 to 18 month lag before the rising interest rates cause an earnings and employment recession. In the meantime rates will have peaked, thus risk-on markets will go up.

youtu.be/vPBUuiq7lMQ
(This Will Cause a Major SP500 Earnings Collapse Worse Than 2008 By the End of 2023. | Game of Trades)
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=d9VCCNB6Oh8&lc=Ugw4UHQxNMrSHe3NWnZ4AaABAg.9gFTx0YdbAU9gIGOyd1wd6

@OPTICALARTdotCOM Steve (you) will continue to ignore his upper parallel line which met the bottom in June. Meaning he is ignoring that the second peak in 2021 was higher then the first. Steve's 7k is coming later in 2023.

The bond market sets the market interest rates not the Fed. The Fed only controls the overnight Fed funds rate between banks. The divergences on the 2Y and 10Y indicate that the bond market has decided rates have already topped.
Note
Amazing! The S&P is probably going for a lower low than June and if so will have lost all hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart! It will still have a second drive of bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart compared to the June low.

The VIX has spiked to the very extreme of the symmetrical triangle I have had it contained in. I was wary of an inverse H&S I had identified on it projecting up to 32.75 – 34. Note you do not sell the S&P with the VIX at 33. You buy. Duh.

snapshot

More troubling is the USD on the DXY chart has rocketed to 113.1 and is in danger of losing its bearish RSI divergence on the daily chart (although it might not) but will not lose the bearish RSI divergence on the weekly nor month charts with a projected move to 113.7 as the final capitulation top:

snapshot

snapshot

Ditto the U.S. Treasure 2Y has lost its bearish RSI divergence on the daily chart but is impossible to lose it on the weekly chart. Might lose it on the monthly also if does not close back down for the end of September. Has hit 4.25% already thus affirming some of the increase in the Fed’s desired terminal rate of 4.6%, although most analysts says 4 – 4.5%. In any case my point remains valid (as long as bearish RSI divergences persist) that market rates will have peaked on this capitulation and FUD repricing. We are at (i.e. within hours or days of) maximum pain in terms of market expectations and fear.

And amazingly crypto is having no part in a lower low so far. Bitcoin seems to be saying that it knows what I have written that the interest rates have peaked. I think Bitcoin is not sensitive to the earnings fears for stocks which are apparently being priced in right now!

I had reaccumulated a bit but sold a bit of that on the small bounce off of 18.6k. Am waiting to see if crypto will capitulate once the S&P breaks the June low.

It is absolutely amazing how much fear there is out there in the general public.

I am absolutely convinced this is a bottom now with all this extreme capitulation. Crypto will probably not move lower than 18.1k again if that.

For those who are short risk-on and long the dollar this is your last chance to close your trade in a profit. Don’t look a gift horse in the mouth. Take the gift.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=uqdFGCaJ3QA&lc=UgzMq49HXFuebRp9lvB4AaABAg.9fnVtPewNm09gKbL1HO4qS
(Is the Fed Fighting Against The Global Elite | Mark Moss)

Mark Moss you have an error in your thesis. The market sets interest rates not the Fed. The bearish RSI divergences on the 2Y and DXY say that the market believes the interest rates can not go higher than 4 – 4.5% without crashing the U.S. economy. Meaning that even if the Fed could raise market interest rates (which they can’t) that the crashing economy would bring them right back down. Or understand it as market participants believe that they will profit at 4.25% when the economy crashes and bonds increase in value as the Fed is forced to Brrrr again and interest rates plummet as investors stampede back into the safety of bonds when the S&P plummets -63% from the new ATH incoming before that.
Note
Bitcoin is sniffing this. That is why it did not moon after the June low because it knew that rates and the dollar would increase. And that is ostensibly why it is not making a lower low while the S&P heads for a lower low, because Bitcoin is ostensibly sniffing out that rates and the dollar will have peaked this month.

Bitcoin is becoming the monetary reserve unit-of-account of the world. And now it is starting to clearly play a monetary role, correctly interpreting the movement of interest rates and the dollar.

Bitcoin has become the canary in the coal mine, so to speak.
Note
> > “You have one last chance to exit at a profit instead of waiting for confirmation and exiting at a loss”

> “i closed everything and will wait to short the markets again...this is far from over”


Why do you think far from over? What will change to cause the Fed to increase its 4.6% terminal Fed funds rate?

Everything doom is already priced in.

The entire market is on the bearish side. It is way too crowded. Everyone will shift to the other side of the ship. There is no where to go on the bearish side.

Even you are so fearful, probably because you are in Europe. Maximum fear means bottom.

Fight your emotions. Be objective.

They even trying to foment more fear by saying that a tropical depression developing off the coast of Venezuela could become a powerful hurricane in the Gulf of Mexico and wipe out the U.S. oil production.
Note
I am starting to DCA now. I will not sell any more. Bitcoin bottom was June.

My time is too valuable to day trade. I need to move on to other activities.
Note
Bitcoin bottom is in!!

youtu.be/MmjxKubcWVQ
(Warning: This Could CRASH BITCOIN – A Serious Update | Crypto Crew University)
Note
Watch:

youtu.be/RiyZQTbLQ-g
(This Momentum Shift on Ethereum and Bitcoin Could Change the Game | Steve Courtney of Crypto Crew)
Note
youtu.be/h4SQeqj6WPw?t=304 ← click to see Fib rings confluence chart for October
(Next major drop for bitcoin on this exact day! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

The next major move will be to the upside. The S&P might make a lower low but Bitcoin will not. I am a crypto investor. The market sets interest rates not the Fed. The bearish RSI divergences on the 2Y and DXY say that the market believes the interest rates can not go higher than 4 – 4.5% without crashing the U.S. economy. Meaning that even if the Fed could raise market interest rates (which they can’t) that the crashing economy would bring them right back down. Or understand it as market participants believe that they will profit at 4.25% when the economy crashes and bonds increase in value as the Fed is forced to Brrrr again and interest rates plummet as investors stampede back into the safety of bonds when the S&P plummets -63% from the new ATH incoming before that.

Bitcoin is ostensibly sniffing this. That is why it did not moon after the June low because it knew that rates and the dollar would increase. And that is ostensibly why it is not making a lower low while the S&P heads for a lower low, because Bitcoin is ostensibly sniffing out that rates and the dollar will have peaked this month.

Bitcoin is becoming the monetary reserve unit-of-account of the world. And now it is starting to clearly play a monetary role, correctly interpreting the movement of interest rates and the dollar.

Bitcoin has become the canary in the coal mine, so to speak.

I think it is key that Bitcoin is not sensitive to the earnings fears for stocks which are apparently being priced in right now! It is absolutely amazing how much fear there is out there in the general public.

I am absolutely convinced this is a bottom now with all this extreme capitulation. Crypto will probably not move lower than 18.1k again if that.

For those who are short risk-on and long the dollar this is your last chance to close your trade in a profit. Don’t look a gift horse in the mouth. Take the gift.
Note
I loaded my bags with 150,000 DOGE for ~9k which may top out at ~110k profit. Hidden, bullish RSI divergence on weekly charts for both DOGE/BTC and DOGE/USD with two drives of it on the latter.

No guarantee from the weekly charts that June was the bottom but note the posited breakout on the daily chart. And I do think June was the bottom in the crypto markets.

This is projecting to 0.000015 and $0.80 with BTC ~53k. So ~4.5× gain relative to Bitcoin. And ~12.5× price gain versus ~2.8× for Bitcoin.

Doge! Doge! time to move?


snapshot

snapshot
Note
Cardanao’s ADA:BTC chart has an imminent pattern breakout projecting to at least 1.5× leverage over Bitcoin. If ADA:BTC proceeds to prior ATH then that’ll be 2.5×. There’s bullish RSI divergence on the May bottom and again on the August pullback on the daily chart. And hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart going back to the December 2020 lows. Hidden, bullish RSI divergence for the Aug and May lows on the daily and weekly charts respectively for ADA:USDT. Seems ADA goes to $2 – 3.50 with BTC $50+k. DOGE may outperform ADA (but maybe delayed, surging near the end).

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
youtu.be/D8k0gi8OZao?t=182 ← click for the chart
(40 Years Of Stock Market Data & We Have Never Seen This... {SP500, QQQ, TSLA, Bitcoin})

youtube.com/watch?v=D8k0gi8OZao&lc=UgwU3s7ge4uAiBzSroJ4AaABAg

That steep inversion means the 2Y is way too high and will crater the economy. So if the 2Y has peaked and will be coming down, that means stocks will moon. It was highly inverted in 2007 also before another leg up in the stock markets. Everyone is so bearish — my analogy is a fraternity hazing to see how many boys they can fit inside a telephone booth. Everyone is on the wrong side of the crowded trade.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=Ipzt-VtaBEY&lc=UgyiT3KXqTgmIczPCQR4AaABAg.9gHiaoPxQEX9gOWeO_VQTw

> “S. Moore you are probably right with crypto I have no idea to be honest as I have $0 in crypto and never invested in it. I can't invest in something which doesn't provide a 10-k report annually as a minimum.
So yeah I'm not commenting on crypto.
But the S&P, the Nasdaq, the DOW, the FTSE. Yeah they can't raise rates without it crashing but that's what will happen anyway.
The s&p will drop to 3200 and probably lower if we get a nice big crash.
And do you know what it will be really healthy because a) it will weed out the 'to the moon stonk investors' and b) things will be at reasonable prices and p/e ratios relative to long term history.
Money is made in market crashes. My cash is waiting”


Simon I keep searching for evidence that I’m wrong and that lower lows are coming in the markets. But the AAII survey from Tuesday found 61% are bearish, one of the five highest readings since the survey’s inception in 1987. How can this go lower when everyone is positioned already bearish meaning they already sold? Also the DXY, 6 month treasury, 2Y treasury and VIX all have bearish RSI divergences on at least the weekly chart. The beauty of investing in Bitcoin is that it’s entirely a monetary asset (has no earnings) imputed value by its Nash equilibrium and unforgeable costliness (the cost of mining new tokens). DOGE token is poised for 12 times gain by Q1 2023. I like taking a little rider on a 12 times gain, so I put 9k into 150,000 DOGE.
Note
The Japanese Central Bank has been intervening to defend the Yen by selling U.S. Treasury bonds which is what helped drive this latest spike in bonds. Ah so that adds fuel to my conviction that this last spike up was not based on market expectations of the terminal rate and bonds are highly oversold. A lot of investors apparently think so as they have been gobbling them up seeing 3.925% on a 6 month bond as a gift.
Note
ETH also has the bullish RSI divergences and I see it performing as well as the lower estimate for ADA. Essentially ~4.2× price with Bitcoin in the $50+k range. Outperforming BTC by ~1.5×. If so, ADA is likely to hit the higher side of my esimates nearly competing with DOGE. Anyway it is good to have a mix of BTC, ETH, ADA and DOGE because the latter two move erratically in sudden surges.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
DXY has hit the first 0.79 Dragon Tail target of ~112. Note measure from the second leg. Next target 122 and above that 136.

futuresmag.com/2016/12/29/how-trade-your-dragon

snapshot
Note
The DXY has precisely hit the top of the parallel channel:

snapshot
Note
You may want to click this to read all my comments in that thread and also watch the video on double-speed to see what I am talking about. Note Steve @ Crypto Crew University already pointed out that Bitcoin needs to get back over 19.6k before the end of September. And the bearish engulfing candle has had an outlier on Bitcoin where a bullish engulfing candle failed to be bullish.

youtube.com/watch?v=k2ZB5_ko4ik&lc=Ugz1ghgGT5SnQtMNCvh4AaABAg.9gNI9bO51rb9gP30Z7oZSH

altcoin Daily a possible reason that crypto is outperforming the stock market (i.e. crypto market cap not threatening new lows and looking bullish) is because crypto has no earnings. There is a lot of worry about upcoming earnings reports.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=k2ZB5_ko4ik&lc=Ugz1ghgGT5SnQtMNCvh4AaABAg.9gNI9bO51rb9gPvphXBbgv

altcoin Daily a few more points. The leverage in crypto has already been bled out. Whereas stocks are still facing an earnings fear headwinds. Tom Crown’s thesis that interest rates can’t decline when the economy crashes because he thinks inflation will still be too high, may not be valid if the demand destruction causes prices to fall. Price inflation doesn’t need to decline to 2% because bond markets set interest rates, not the Fed. The SPX flash crashes have been increasing by a factor of ~1.75, so the next one would be projected ~63% which also intersects two significant trend lines. Yet the U.S. banking system is not in horrible shape as was the case that caused the 2008 great financial crisis so great crashes need to be manufactured. The Bolsheviks running the West ostensibly want the governments to socialize all hardship (e.g. energy cost subsidies in the U.K. and E.U. and stimi/unemployment checks in the USSA) and simultaneously shutdown production (e.g. pLandemic, pushed Putin to the brink of war, pushing China to the brink with Pelosi's visit to Taiwan, etc). So expect the next flash crash to be some intentionally created event, perhaps a cyber attack on bank accounts blamed on Russia so they can push us towards centrally managed, 666, central bank digital currencies. The future is UBI doled out via CBDCs, enforced rationing and complete enslavement. Welcome to the NWO.

snapshot
Note
I think likely a bounce to close September with Bitcoin above the key monthly close level of 19.9k. Then I think very likely the SPX declines again to test the 200 WMA in early Oct at 3600 to create another drive of bullish RSI divergence on the weekly, and BTC could make a wick low lower than 17.6k to form another drive of bullish RSI divergence on the weekly. Then a face ripping rally in the week of Oct 17. The SPX formed a bullish RSI divergence on the weekly back in June, but currently only has hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily assuming does not make a lower low. But the DJIA already made a lower low and the DXY and 2Y treasury both invalidated their bearish RSI divergence on the daily and only kept it on the weekly. So I think SPX is likely to do so also. But looks like there will be rally into the end of September first. Bitcoin absolutely has to close Sept above 19.9k to remain in a bullish posture.

So it is possible the EKC’s bearish 2-day signal might play out to the downside, but I highly doubt to 16k.

Note a possibility of revisiting the bottom one last time. Not sure it will, but it might. Again if my thesis is entirely wrong and the 60% who are bearish are right and everything collapses then I will be REKTD. But the time to buy is when the markets are maximally fearful, which is right now. Thus we should get a rally now and maybe come back down one last time to shake the trees to see if any more weak hands want to panic sell. Then Oct 17 is rockets up baby!
Note
youtu.be/KG_OWsiGPAg?t=1076 ← click for the chart

Note the difference in the structure of the 200 WMA (the black line) compared to 2001 and 2008. Very likely the SPX bottoms on or near the 200 WMA.
Note
This is excellent. I suggest watching at least the first 13 minutes at double-speed. Very likely to get a rally in the markets this week. But then we have to observe carefully and probably sell the rally for another trip towards the lows in October. The bottoming process probably not complete quite yet but will likely complete in October.

youtu.be/DyMJw8j6m3I
(Bitcoin (BTC) May Rally To 23K Only To Form A Right Shoulder In A Bearish Head & Shoulder Pattern | The Crypto Trader)
Note
For the bullish 9-count to continue, then every daily bar has to close above the close of the daily bar 4 days prior. Thus tomorrow’s (Monday’s) close must be above 19.3k for the bullish 9-count to continue. If so then bar 1 would be on Monday and bar 9 potentially completing the count would be on October 4. I am betting on a rally until Oct 4.

snapshot
Note
U.K. pound plummeted because investors expected interest rates to drastically increase. Well the market front run the increase and repriced interest rates, so the effect is done. Now the dollar should decline against the pound as investors come back in to partake of the juicy yields on bonds.

cnbc.com/2022/09/23/british-pound-plunges-to-fresh-37-year-low-of-1point10-.html
Note
That Sterling wick down today to 1.04, caused a wick up in the DXY above the overhead resistance. Yikes. But it came back down immediately.

snapshot
Note
Shelby Moore, {9/26/22 4:18 PM}
{In reply to anonymous}
Don’t you dare sell. I have been guiding you all along to way when to take profits and when to reacquire. I have been increasing my wealth these past weeks.

Shelby Moore, {9/26/22 4:19 PM}
Do not sell the bottom and capitulate.

Shelby Moore, {9/26/22 4:19 PM}
If something changes in my understanding of the macro economics then I will inform the group pronto. I continue to dig for information or theories I might not be aware of.

Shelby Moore, {/26/22 4:20 PM}
I thought about what if the U.S. economy is so strong that it requires a 6% terminal rate to crash it. If I see signs of this, I will issue a sell call immediately.

What I see is housing is plummeting and repos of cars is up 33%.

Shelby Moore, {9/26/22 4:21 PM}
The UK just cut taxes which immediately up their bonds rates. So now the Sterling should stop declining against the dollar.

Shelby Moore, {9/26/22 4:21 PM}
The actual intent of the tax cuts was to arrest the slide in the Sterling.

Shelby Moore, {9/26/22 4:22 PM}
By borrowing more to offset the tax cuts, this drives the bond rates up which makes the Sterling more attractive.
Note
About the fear & greed index only being at 21:

My concern is that the algorithm has changed over time. Also I mean the lowness of the signal does not seem to correspond with the back test low. Compare first week of Feb 2019 (which was the back test low) to now. Actually you can see that the current ~20 level was the low before the June low. Ditto in 2018/19 that the back test low ~15 was the low before the December bottom. As I said we could have one more attempt at a low. I am still expecting a bounce this week though first. If we do not get a bounce this week, then I will start to wonder if I should be more bearish.

alternative.me/crypto/fear-and-greed-index/
Note
Our last hope is to draw this channel on the log-scaled chart and hope that DXY does not exceed 116. Note though at that level it would be dangerously close to losing the bearish RSI divergence on the weekly and monthly chart. We are right at the breaking point. As I said if Bitcoin does not close September above 19.9k, I may reevaluate whether I believe June was the bottom.

I will be advising to sell any BTC bounce to $20 – 21k. I am quite concerned. Although as I said the blood bath in the Sterling could have been due to a one-time increase in bond rates (sell-off) which should now defend the Sterling. And Japan’s central bank was defending the Yen by selling U.S. Treasuries which drove the U.S. interest rates higher which has the effect of making the dollar more sought by investors, i.e. having the counter effect to UK tax cut induced repricing of their bonds. U.S. rates and dollar higher means risk-on assets lower. But note that Bitcoin has been defying any attempt to make a lower low, so maybe it is signaling that the U.S. interest rate and dollar rises are done. But again we are right at the breaking point.

The 1985 level of $1.03 for the Sterling should hopefully hold for now but ultimately going to $0.72 per Armstrong’s Socrates: armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/foreign-exchange/the-british-pound-the-fx-crisis/

snapshot
Note
An interesting insight is that central banks around the world can not defend their currencies by selling U.S. Treasury bonds (as the Japanese Central Bank recently did) because this drives interest rates up in the U.S.A. which strengthens the dollar, thus sanitizing their selling of dollars generated by the said liquidation of Treasury bonds.

Thus interest rates must go much higher outside the USA thus creating a global Great Depression, or the dollar must continue rising. We are heading into a monetary reset and the WW3 that accompanies the Thucydides Trap as the U.S.A. loses its superpower status.

The UK ostensibly decided to raise interest rates by enacting tax cuts without cutting government spending which will force the UK government to issue more bonds than before.
Note
BTC 19,242 with 24 minutes to go until daily UTC close. Come on we need 19300 in the next 24 minutes.
Note
Ron Walker thinks a relief rally imminent and then coming back down to new lows in October:

youtu.be/sPlSvbsoPUU
(Stock Market CRASH: A Big Move Will Likely Start Within 48 Hours Here's Why!- Investing SPX QQQ IWM)
Note
youtu.be/0v_6cIVodlo?t=387 ← click the see chart of divergence between oil and U.S. interest rates
(A Major Capitulation Event is Occurring on the Stock Market | This is What Could Trigger a Reversal)

My comment:

Bond markets set interest rates, not the Fed. Rates diverged up as oil declined because the stronger U.S. economy requires a higher level of rates (than abroad) to crush demand, which increases dollar demand. Central banks defending their currencies by selling U.S. bonds, cause U.S. rates to increase nullifying their defense. UK just cut taxes to increase bond issuance to force UK interest rates higher. Thus global demand will collapse and oil will move lower. Too much stimulus checks so U.S. labor has no incentive to work. This severe global recession is eventually likely to lead to war cutting off supply of oil sending it skyrocketing. Meantime EU and UK will increase govt spending on energy subsidies and if this includes increased borrowing, their interest rates should rise providing some defense against the dollar as U.S. rates top out.

This is a vicious cycle leading to economic scorched earth with a soaring dollar and a cratered global economy. Their weakening currencies abroad will exacerbate their domestic inflation thus also help to force their interest rates higher, thus helping to arrest the dollar’s rise for awhile. The UK pound sterling is likely to defend its 1985 1.03 level while the U.S. starts its cycle of peak rates (probably now or in October) and ensuing employment recession by Q1 2023. But the dollar is headed much higher later in 2023+ as economies abroad implode abroad from the egregious stagflation (high interest rates and inflation) although the EU/UK subsidies may kick-the-can for awhile on their ultimately unavoidable, abject collapse into the abyss — thus why our Western leaders need and instigated the WW3 scapegoat. Sterling will later plummet to 89 and then ultimately perhaps 72 by 2026 or 2027.

In summary we have maybe one more respite of risk-on markets from October. But later in 2023 until at least 2026 appears to be an incoming, utter hell. Appears inflation will be sustained as long as possible with WW3 and subsidies to prevent deflation. In which case the vicious cycle of the soaring dollar will persist. Until everything is reduced to ashes and there’s no demand regardless of supply. We are staring down the barrel of Hades.
Note
youtu.be/44nlJ29kaco?t=330 ← click to see chart
(Peak Capitulation and Fear | Stock Market Crash | Meet Kevin)

Very close to a bottom but probably one more capitulation (and probably a lower-low at least for stock markets) because retail has been buying this dip (in stocks at least) but are now approaching their pain threshold.

Again I think we have a bounce first ongoing this week, which appears to already be underway with Bitcoin hitting 19.8k already today.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=5VTbuQaUNAQ&lc=Ugw2Hlu0YoYRoNdH_nV4AaABAg
(The Collapse of Britain's Pound | A DANGER for America)

Meet Kevin, you will continue to not understand for as long as you refuse to understand that the bond market sets interest rates, not the central bank. The UK actions sent their bonds skyrocketing because of the expected flood of bond issuance that will be required. The market prices the future issuance in immediately. Thus selling of the pound sterling into every currency that the former bond holder repatriates to. But this new higher level of interest rates has already done the job of raising the rates, not the central bank. Thus the pound should now be defended at the key 1.03 level. Come on Kevin you are smarter than this.
Note
K-dub @ CryptoZombie shows the pattern providing this bounce underway. And argues for a drop to 16.2k.

youtube.com/watch?v=_ibMOnm9mLI&lc=UgzUgRaWBBBDGWhOsmN4AaABAg.9gRz-FnLcb59gTE-_9ipdi
(BITCOIN MEGA ALERT!!!!!!! THIS IS NOT A DRILL!!!!! 🚨 IN LESS THAN 48 HOURS BTC WILL BREAK OUT!!!)

crypto Zombie Quite possibly up to 20.2 to 21.1, then down to 16.2k for the final bottom. It will only be a wick low. In that case I expect to close the wick down candle above the June low. The week of Oct 17 is the target for final capitulation.
Note
He “stole” my InGoldWeTrust which was my website in 2010.

youtu.be/neqgKiC6TSU
(Fed may reach 'tipping point' by November as world 'breaks apart' into two - Ronald-Peter Stoeferle | Kitco NEWS)
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=Ipzt-VtaBEY&lc=UgyiT3KXqTgmIczPCQR4AaABAg.9gHiaoPxQEX9gUwVWiaGSz

> “S. Moore what I mean to say is generally the bottom for risk on assets will become lower in 2022 and the bottom in 2022 was not June. June was just an intermediate low in the grand scheme of things in 2022”

Simon We have bounce underway despite the SPX's fall back to a lower low today. Note the bullish RSI divergences on all time frames. That lower low provided the bullish RSI divergences we need to even possibly have a bottom now if not later in October. This could either be the bottom or after the bounce the could be one final capitulation in October. Then rockets. Study the seasonality during Demonrat mid-term election years. Always double bottoms in October then massive rally into the end of the year. The UK tax cut caused an immediate repricing of their bonds (selloff) which spiked the DXY and U.S. Treasuries, but that will provide the higher UK rates needed to defend the pound sterling against dollar short-term. By 2024 through 2026 the world is going to be in an abyss of epic proportions and nuclear WW3. All assets including bonds and the dollar will eventually collapse into ashes. The West is collapsing for a few hundred years at least.
Note
I wrote this last night as you can tell from the charts I captured…

I actually sold some last night at ~20.2k which remember was my first price target. I should have sold more. I almost sold more but got sleepy and was not thinking clearly.

I repurchased now the small portion I had sold. We have multiple drives of bullish RSI divergence now on the S&P on the 4 hourly chart. And still bullish RSI divergences on BTC.

This is scary. But if BTC does not close September above 19.9k then I will probably move to cash and wait. So for the moment I remain in my holding expecting that BTC must move back up.

It’s almost as if the S&P wants to continue down to the 200 WMA at ~3586 while making more drives of bullish RSI divergence on the way. S&P tagged ~3610 today.

There will very likely be a strong bounce if hits that 200 WMA. Thus my fear about a crash right now is very low.

Look at that textbook multiple drives of divergence on the 4 hourly! That is screaming BUY.

snapshot

Also on the weekly chart. Note lost the bullish RSI divergence on the daily but not entirely if look back far enough.

snapshot
Note
It’s amazing to me that nobody is correctly interpreting what has happened over the past days in the U.K..

The fundamentally stronger U.S. economy (best of the worst) has enabled the market to push interest rates up much higher than abroad. This has caused the dollar to appreciate egregiously. To defend its currency the Japanese central bank sold U.S. Treasury bonds and repatriated the capital back into Yen thus causing the Yen to stop falling against the dollar. But this also caused U.S. bond rates to increase which caused the dollar to further strengthen overall against other currencies. This amplified pressure on the U.K. to the defend its currency, which it had to formulate in a different strategy by enacting tax cuts and spending. Some of that spending is also for price controls (caps) on energy costs. Thus caused fear of increased inflation, thus a selloff of U.K. bonds causing their interest rates to rise precipitously. Yet these sales were repatriated back into the seller’s home currency or dollars, thus causing the dollar to appreciate even more against the pound sterling. These higher U.K. interest rates would help to defend the pound sterling as dollar capital would view the yield on U.K. bonds more favorably with the higher interest rates, yet these interest rates were threatening to unleash a liquidity meltdown (causing yesterday some further stampede into the dollar). The Bank of England initiated emergency Q.E. for long-term U.K. bonds only to restore confidence and to stabilize for example pension funds and the derivatives time bomb thereof.

This sets up the pound sterling to be defended at the 1985 low of $1.03 for the time being. But the U.K. is pouring gasoline on their dumpster fire medium-term as they are stimulating (not just with tax cuts but also) with spending and price controls in an already high inflation environment. Thus U.K. interest rates will remain elevated as U.S. interest rates top out and come down a bit, but this will explode again later into a worst crisis. Armstrong expects the pound sterling to eventually break down to 89 (perhaps next year?) and later to 72 by ~2026/27.

So we are near to the near-term top in the DXY and U.S. Treasury rates (but no where near the final top in the dollar coming over the next few years), which were right at their breaking point for maintaining bullish RSI divergence on the monthly chart so I am expecting reprieve to close the month of September. Thus also near to the bottom of the S&P and other risk-on markets as priced in dollars.

I am sticking with my point that Bitcoin much close September above 19.9k else the monthly Bitcoin chart turns very bearish and dark. And I do not think that 10k and 13K are in the cards right now. So I expect a bounce in the market. I am expecting one final capitulation move in October, but I do not think it will much lower that recent lows.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Zoomed in:

snapshot
Note
Typo: /much close/must close/
Note
SPX has bullish RSI divergence on the weekly, but not on the daily nor monthly. It had it on the 4-hourly and lower time frames but developed hidden (aka “phantom”) bearish RSI divergence on the bounce earlier today on Wednesday. So now the 4-hourly is indicating that price needs to make a lower low before moving higher. It looks like the SPX would need to drop to ~3400 – 3500 for hidden, bullish RSI divergence to form on the monthly (which if so would definitely send Bitcoin to a lower low than June but not 13K). It’s not a given that we need divergence on the monthly to form a bottom here. So weigh all factors not just one.

Also the 4-hourly VIX has reset from bearish to hidden, bullish RSI divergence. The VIX appears it wants to make a higher high than 35. It can go as high as 37 without removing the hidden, bearish divergence on the daily. It needs to down perhaps below 26 before it form bullish divergence again on the daily. It’s not clear to me whether the VIX can convert its current hidden, bearish RSI divergence on the weekly to non-hidden, bearish if it makes a higher high — meaning either that VIX should not make a higher high or that if it does it might mean catastrophe (yet maybe not if forms non-hidden, bearish divergence). Ditto on the monthly but more likely it can create non-hidden, bearish divergence if spikes higher.

Bitcoin has dubious (borderline) continuation of its bullish, RSI divergence on the 4-hourly. Bitcoin has bullish RSI divergence on the daily and weekly, as well hidden, bullish on the monthly. It doesn’t mean Bitcoin could not form another more convincing drive of bullish RSI divergence on the daily and weekly by moving slightly lower than the ~17.5k June low.

ADA needs to decline below 0.425 or even 0.40 to form bullish RSI divergence on the weekly, although it already has hidden, bullish on the weekly. Hidden, bullish does not mean it could not make a lower low. Ditto to be convincing on the daily although there’s some borderline bullish RSI divergence already. ADA has convincing bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly and price may need to move above 0.465 to turn it bearish on that time frame. ADA would need to move quite a significant amount lower to form hidden, bullish on the monthly.

ETH is borderline bullish on the 4-hourly, has hidden bullish on the daily but could drop below $1100 without losing it. Has hidden, bullish on the weekly and monthly and also borderline non-hidden, bullish on the weekly. Hidden, bullish does not mean it could not make a lower low.

DOGE is in a similar situation. Looks like it all set up bullish but its borderline bullish on the daily, so a decline below 0.56 or even 0.50 is possible to form more convincing bullish on the daily. Weekly and monthly are already hidden, bullish but that does not preclude lower lows. Not likely DOGE can decline below 0.45 as it would lose one of its drives of hidden, bullish on the weekly.

I apologize for recommending to buy DOGE and ADA a bit prematurely. We should probably be waiting to see if there will be further capitulation first. Note there could be a rally first or maybe not because the SPX is signaling possibility to head down to a lower low first.

In summary Bitcoin looks stronger than the S&P but the stock market could drag Bitcoin down, but I doubt very much that Bitcoin is going to make some massive capitulation. Bitcoin seems to be signaling that the bottom was June or if not then only slightly lower. I think OPTICALARTdotCOM is crazy calling for Bitcoin to make a massive dump towards 14K or lower within the next 3 to 6 days. I already explained that on his prior Fib ring Bitcoin moved sideways instead of down after moving down on the prior one. So Bitcoin appears to be forming a bottom and will move sideways or up on the ring confluence right now.
Note
DOGE is highly volatile. I think it would be wiser to buy it on breakout of one of the two cyan blue downtrend lines on my chart. Preferably the upper one. If you only have a small amount invested and can stomach a possible 10 – 20% drop before it breaks out to the upside, then just hodl. It might not drop.

snapshot
Note
By ‘breakout’ I mean a weekly close above.
Note
UPDATE: there is some bullish RSI divergence on the 1 hourly and 30 minute charts. So looks like maybe SPX will push back up again and possibly more than once to form multiple drives of bearish divergence on the 4 hourly and 2 hourly. Then we will probably get that move to a lower low. So if you want to sell some, you have another small bounce incoming. Or maybe even Bitcoin can still close the month tomorrow above 19.9k before any retest of the lows.
Note
GBPUSD which comprises ~13% of the DXY has no bullish divergence RSI divergence on daily and lower, and borderline on the weekly. It will come back down to retest $1.03 and possibly hit parity while hopefully maintaining monthly bullish divergence. GBPUSD is very volatile right now. GBPUSD is the main worry in terms of forming a top on the DXY. The U.K. appears to be dying along with its last Queen. It had the chance with the BREXIT to become a capital safe haven but that opportunity is forever lost. It’s time to turn out the lights on Britain.

EURUSD which is ~38% of the DXY is near a breaking point on all time frames from daily up to monthly but has bullish RSI divergence on all those higher time frames. Thus I think it is only likely to at worse retest its low and to be attracted to parity or higher over the new few months.

USDJPY which ~14% of the DXY looks very bearish (i.e. bearish for DXY and bullish for stocks) on all time frames.

The remaining components of the DXY have possible upside bias for the DXY on weekly and lower time frames but bearish RSI divergences on the monthly.

So if we get one more wick up in the DXY to 116 that might be the absolute top near-term and thus the bottom for stocks and crypto, that is if the bottom is not already in. If that 116 (or current top) is not the near-term top in the DXY then all hell will break loose but that would seemingly require some unlikely black swan because the U.K. and Japan have already taken actions to defend their currencies. And the parity level is likely to be a magnet for the Euro and pound Sterling in the short-term.

I think likely the final capitulation for stocks is still to come but should not be egregiously lower unless as I wrote above all hell breaks out on the currencies and parity is lost on both the Euro and GBP.
Note
SPX is coming down as I expected. Look for the SPX to tag the 200 WMA ~3590 then we should have a rally into October before the final capitulation.

I am trying to reload BTC ~18400 and ETH ~1250. Not sure if they make it that far down though.
Note
[In reply to Shelby Moore]
Currently SPX has some very minor bullish divergence on the 2 hour and more solidly on the 1 hour charts, still needs to make a lower low to remove the hidden, bearish on the 4-hour chart. If the SPX comes down and tags the 200 WMA ~3590, it will likely form VERY MINOR bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart and all lower time frame charts.

SPX appears to need to come down to ~3400 to form hidden, bullish on the monthly chart which will not invalidate the current bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart (but will invalidate all bullish divergence on the daily chart and lower time frames thus might be choppy for a while down there to form that bullish on the daily). Thus I am expecting a failure to rally until we tag slightly lower, then a feeble rally in October with a further capitulation crash, perhaps for the week of October 17 which Armstrong’s A.I. Socrates has tagged to be a Panic Cycle week. I was originally thinking that would be to the upside, but based on additional information I have collected, I now think it will be the final capitulation low.

It is possible there will not be any rally interim (after tagging slightly lower low) and directly down towards ~3400. Yet I think the rally scenario is likely. The VIX is postured to make a slightly higher high on the 4-hour time frame. The VIX appears poised in October to form hidden, bullish on the daily then skyrocket to as high as 48 in a final capitulation move. It will lose daily bearish but gain bearish on the monthly and keep it on the weekly charts. So the VIX is postured compatible with my thesis on the SPX (i.e. S&P).

Although I think my thesis that interest rates and the dollar will top out soon is valid, I think there is far too much of Pandora’s box opened and the currency exchange market volatility right now, to transition directly to that pivot here and now. SPX is trying to defend the 200 WMA and likely to get a bounce off it, but that will probably be just a bull trap and need a final capitulation that shakes the trees of weak hands who fear a crash to 3200 and for Bitcoin those who fear a crash to 12k.

Note though that there’s already hidden, bearish on both monthly and weekly already on the VIX, so it is possible that the 200 WMA could be the bottom for the SPX. So that’s why I think we need to buy any slightly lower low incoming at least for the posited rally, because it might be the bottom.
Note
The DXY dropped nicely but has already reset with hidden, bullish on the 4 hour chart and borderline hidden, bullish on the daily. Still needs to come down more for hidden, bullish on the weekly chart. So perhaps a bit of short-term bounce to give us that posited 200 WMA low on the SPX and then down some more for a rally on SPX, before exploding back up under my previously mentioned purple uptrend line towards ~116 to perhaps provide the final capitulation in the markets I am positing for October.

It’s not clear that the GBPUSD has to make a lower low though (bullish on the monthly and borderline bullish on the weekly charts), even though it clearly needs to come back down a bit to retest (bearish on lower time frames such as 4 hour). One would think an intraday wick lower low perhaps to $1.00 parity would be necessary to reestablish bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart. So the scenario for the SPX to tag the 200 WMA is likely but the capitulation to ~3400 isn’t as certain looking at the GBPUSD. Will need to monitor this going forward.

Ditto the EURUSD and even more so because it already has bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart. So although it needs to come back down (bearish on the 4 hour).

So I am not quite clear if the DXY will make it back up to 116 to tag the top of my previously shared “last line of defense against dollar bulls” channel. And thus not clear if SPX is headed to ~3400 (after a posited, interim rally in October) or if the posited incoming tag of the 200WMA will be the bottom.
Note
BTC displays the analogous signals. The daily and 4 hourly indicate a drop is need to below either 18.25k or 18.5k to reset those bullish. The weekly and monthly are already bullish but the monthly indicates nothing about how much lower it can go first. The weekly seems to favor a lower low than June to make a more convincing drive of bullish RSI divergence. My computed estimate is that a decline can be as low as 15k without voiding the bullish RSI divergence on the weekly.

OPTICALARTdotCOM has $17.3 - 17.4k (although rising a bit by mid-October perhaps 17.5k and the DJIA to ~27K) as the first level of support for the drop he is expecting. That would be a perfect level just below the June low ~17.6k. I could envision a drop to ~18.2k followed by a rally (which might be the actual bottom) and then (if was not the bottom) the final capitulation of SPX and BTC to ~3400 and 17.5k or below (but not 12K as OPTICALARTdotCOM is anticipating). If 18k and 17k don’t hold then I have strong support downtrend lines between ~$15 – 16.5k.

I am now leaning towards the possibility of a final capitulation “the sky is falling” move to scare everyone into thinking egregiously lower lows are imminent.

OPTICALARTdotCOM’s thesis for a 12K move can only be correct if somehow the currency exchange markets are totally broken and immediately the DXY rockets towards 120 and above. I just don’t think that is likely at all, but I can not rule it out if monthly and weekly bearish divergences on the U.S. Treasuries, VIX and DXY (bullish on currencies w.r.t. the dollar) are somehow busted (which would then mean there is nothing between the markets and moves to ZERO which seems illogical). Are the markets really heading to ZERO now? I do not think so. Come on. The flash crash is not probable now even though clearly the West blew up Nordstream 2 to try further push Russia towards WW3.

Armstrong also thinks the markets will be going down until January. He sees that Panic Cycle in January for the DJIA and thinks we can not have the seasonal mid-terms rally in October through December. He seems to think the Demonrats want war immediately to stimulate the incumbent victories. But I don’t think Russia will give it to Brandon so soon, because for example the 300,000 new conscripts have to be trained first. I rather expect a rally then a significant pullback in January as the U.S. mid-term election outcome (effected in January) is going to turn both sides more violent no matter which side wins. Then a final rally in March or April, before the next Panic Cycle which should be the U.S. economy rolling over significantly.

Ron Walker believes the usual mid-term seasonal rally will play out. And he thinks the Democrat mid-term seasonal of final low in October after initial low in June will play out.

Again I think OPTICALARTdotCOM is misinterpreting his own model for Bitcoin as I have previously explained. And I think the CPI (in the U.S.), DXY and U.S. Treasuries have peaked or nearly so. I was even expecting that maybe the October 13 CPI comes in much lower which is why I was thinking the Oct 17 Panic Cycle might be to the upside. And I think the EU, UK and Japan have undertaken measures that will put a near-term floor on their currency depreciation. Of course those short-sighted measures are self-immolating heading into 2023 and 2024. Essentially those measures are to spend and borrow more (in the EU and UK, Japan is selling U.S. Treasuries), thus raising their interest rates making their currencies more competitive to the dollar for bond investment.
Note
> “even if we wick further down from 15k we have strong historical support at about 13,700”

Agreed if you want to count that has a worst case but I do not expect it. The currencies and interest rates have nearly reached the end of their runways. I don’t see the impetus in 2022 for that level of further selloff.

You are correct that a wick which does not close the week, could be lower than 15k without voiding the weekly bullish RSI divergence.
Note
Correction, no Panic Cycle for DJIA in January. Only September 2022 (which played out!) and May 2023.

Also a more careful interpretation of Armstrong’s latest private blogs is that he is open to a bounce but wary of January and also further into 2023.
Note
The Volatility and Panic Cycle rows on Armstrong’s Monthly Timing arrays look bullish from October to April. He is so focused on January, but that appears to just be an amplification of some bullish trend perhaps with a pullback in December?

OPTICALARTdotCOM has a ~27.3k support line for the DJIA. Armstrong and I have it ~27.4k. I just can’t envision the DJIA dropping below that, if that. Also DJIA will lose its bullish RSI divergence on the weekly if it drops that far (except if an intra-week wick), but maybe not with a drop to my cyan trend line ~28.3k to back fill that gap on the weekly chart. Yet a drop to 27.5k if the Oct 17 Panic Cycle is to the downside would create hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the monthly chart. So am itching to buy on a moderate pullback for a rally in October, but I will be wary of topping out and a potential capitulation perhaps in the week of Oct 17. But it could also be the case that the Panic Cycle in the week of Oct 17 will be to the upside.

In summary unless the entire world falls into Hades immediately, the pivot is near both in price and time.

snapshot

Monthly:

snapshot
Note
DOGEUSD is bullish on the weekly but the daily is signaling a decline below 0.056, then possibly a bounce, then possibly a decline to ~0.045. Can not decline below 0.042 without losing the hidden, bullish AND non-hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart. If crypto is declining the DOGEBTC should also decline. First line of support 0.0000026 ₿. At 0.045 that equates to 17.3k ₿itcoin.

Thus I really don’t see $15 – 16k as likely I think at worst the wick low should be ~17.4k. This is an imperfect science though. My gut is telling me the ₿itcoin bottom is near if not already in June.
Note
ADAUSD and ADABTC are bullish on weekly, daily, 4 hourly, 2 hourly. And it has a bullish, declining, narrowing wedge. This looks like a buy right now for a bounce to $0.49 (+12%) if not higher. I will keep an eye on it because I am going to buy some now.

snapshot
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


> “Thanks for sharing. I stay bearish now.”

Bitcoin - BTCUSD to mark new lows by the end of Q4 2022


Tradersweekly, c.f. my latest updates on the published idea for in-depth analysis of the RSI divergences, as it looks like the chaos in the currency and bond markets is nearing completion. Why do you interpret the chart you shared as bearish? Is it because you see lower lows and lower highs since the August bear trap peak and approaching the June low? Do you interpret that as a descending triangle? Did you realize that your chart looks like an Adam & Eve Bottom?
Note
This bullish Adam & Eve Bottom pattern is on BTC, ETH, ADA and DOGE at least.

But wait the S&P (SPX) needs to come down first to tag the 200 WMA ~3590 – 3600, which form the bullish divergences needed for the rally.

Target BTC ($18.25 – 18.5k), ETH ($1160 – 1280), ADA ($0.42 – 0.43) and DOGE (~0.056)

It’s not clear if the altcoins will outperform BTC on this posited rally. DOGE still looks weak. ADA has a bullish wedge, but the overhead on the RSI is more challenging than for BTC unless ADA wicks upwards intra-daily.
Note
Watch on double-speed all the way to the end. Concurs with my recent comments. You will be convinced there will be no major crash.

youtu.be/EZe2XHyalUE
(Don't Be Fooled! Is A 2008 Style Stock Market CRASH Now In Progress Or Is It Major Bottom? (SPX QQQ) | Ron Walker)
Note
In the interests of transparency this guy called me out and has even gone back through some of my published history to point out my mistakes. You all may want to read this discussion thread:

Bitcoin - BTCUSD to mark new lows by the end of Q4 2022
Note
And look for my comments above and below the linked discussion.
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


Tradersweekly, In the interests of transparency and to call more attention to your tirade against my person instead of discussing logic. I am calling the readers’ attention to the linked discussion wherein you called me out and traced back through some of my published history to cherry pick some of my mistakes out-of-context of my holistic exploration. Readers may want to read the linked discussion thread, including my comments above and below the linked discussion:

Bitcoin - BTCUSD to mark new lows by the end of Q4 2022
Note
A ~110 IQ test:

Bitcoin - Do not get fooled by "double bottom" forecasts


Tradersweekly, see anything relevant to the chart TradingShot posted?

snapshot

BITCOIN The scariest fractal right now.
Note
The collapse in INVESTMENT-GRADE (i.e. not junk bonds) corporate bonds corresponds to the near to the end of the bear market, not the mid-way point! Drill that in your heads folks. The panic has already occurred. You DCA on the panic, not sit on your hands waiting for massive more downside while the train leaves the station and the market runs away from you. Duh. Note I wrote ‘near to the end’. Historically there’s bit more downside to go after the said bond collapse.

youtu.be/drTw6wwIMZ4?t=224 ← click for the chart
(We Haven't Seen Anything Like This Since 2008. | SP500 is About to Hurt a LOT of Traders. | Game of Trades)
Note
Going back and checking on important things. I realized that 1973 was the prior recession where interest rates were rising into a stock market decline. Thus the lead up to the 2008 recession does not serve as the best comparison to current situation, because prior to 2008 interest rates were rising into the stock market rally.

I remembered this uber important Game of Trades video from June 24, that most people have probably forgotten about by now. You know the soundbite generation can’t hold onto any data in their head longer than a few minutes.

youtu.be/U6QMXRB5SJs
(The 1973 Stock Market CRASH Looks EXACTLY Like the Stock Market in 2022 (With 2 BIG Exceptions) | Game of Trades)

That video made two very crucial points of distinction contrasting 1973 to the current situation at the current juncture in the markets:

1. The 1973 stock market proceeded to crash more because it was correctly pricing in an imminent decline in the economy, which was evident because unemployment was rising and because of #2. Currently unemployment is not rising and shows no signs of rising given there are 2 jobs for every applicant.

2. The supply side inflation driven by the oil shock was unabated (i.e. the oil price didn’t decline during the period of the further crash, which is not the case now), thus the CPI did not peak until 12 months later given the flat to slowly rising oil prices after the initial shock rise (because CPI is an annual rate of change), when comparing to the corresponding juncture as now. The oil price remained high even after the OPEC embargo presumably because the Middle-East had realized it had pricing power thus could profit on its near monopoly; and because the massive Boomer WW2 boom generation was entering the global workforce exacerbating an unrelenting rise in the demand for oil. New oil exploration and conservation requires years to sort out.

Whereas our situation now is that CPI (including food & energy) peaked in June (which was affirmed again today by the BEA’s September 30 report for August PCE) because oil prices have been declining because China locked down significant portions of their economy and the markets are anticipating economic decline due to the rising interest rates — marking another important distinction between now and 1973 as to how much more indebted and thus dependent the global economy is on interest rates. China has also needed to lock down their economy as a forced austerity and repression to deal with their collapsing real estate debt bubble.

However, GoT didn’t discuss in the aforelinked video the strong dollar problem we have now which was not the case in 1973. Given how much weaker the peripheral economies are, the interest rates have risen much faster in the U.S. than in other major economies, which has stimulated more demand for U.S. bonds which thus creates more demand for dollars.

Thus Japan, the U.K. and the E.U. where forced (also by their horrific , stultifying natural gas and electricity energy prices situation) to enact subsidies and other spending plans so their economies can handle higher interest rates without immediately collapsing. Thus as U.S. CPI is declining the CPI shall remain elevated in other major economies, thus perhaps stalling the dollar’s rise for a while. Apparently even the sabotage of the Nordstream 2 pipeline was to prevent a reduction in energy costs in Europe as the people were starting to demand an end to Russian sanctions.

Thus the bearish RSI divergences on the monthly and weekly time frames for the DXY (dollar) and U.S. Treasuries appear to be correct. And if so then the stock market and crypto is near to a bottom for a while.

It won’t be too long from now when the emergency measures undertaken by the distressed major economies will blow up into abject economic collapse and that is when our overlords will need WW3 as the scapegoat for the utter hell coming later in 2023.

I warned everyone to leave those distressed countries. I will not repeat myself again: DRY = don’t repeat yourself (as the midwits either won’t grok it and/or will otherwise conflate their nose with their arsehole possibly dragging the good intentioned into a nonsensical argument).
Note
Follow-up on the GoT video entitled, “We Haven't Seen Anything Like This Since 2008. | SP500 is About to Hurt a LOT of Traders.”

There is an important distinction between why the corporate bonds collapsed in 2008 and 2020 versus 2022. The investment grade corporate bonds sold off in those prior instances because of economic collapse and thus potential insolvency of said corporations. Whereas in 2022 the corporate bonds are collapsing in price so egregiously because they started close to the zero-bound interest rate and thus nominal rises in interest rates comprised an exponentially higher ratio than if the bonds had started from some reasonable non-zero bound. This is important because per GoT’s June 24 video, for the current decline to be only the mid-way point of a much larger crash, then economic collapse would need to imminent — which it is not.

nytimes.com/2022/09/30/business/bonds-market.html

Bonds produce income, but because interest rates were close to zero when the current surge in rates started, those increases in yield caused vertiginous drops in bond values, and there has been almost no income cushion to soften the blow.

A fancier way of putting this is to say that when bond yields dropped close to zero during the coronavirus recession of 2020, their prices became far more sensitive to the interest rate increases that arrived this year.

“We’ve had rates rise sharply before,” Edward McQuarrie, an emeritus professor of business at Santa Clara University, said in an interview. “But what made this year special was that rates rose from such a low level. That’s why bond returns this year have been so negative.”
Note
Black swan?

reuters.com/business/energy/bp-lays-off-most-contractors-ohio-refinery-after-explosion-sources-2022-09-28/

Why is this loss of 0.16M bpd causing gas prices to spike so egregiously in the USA when the total U.S. refinery capacity is 17.9M bpd and only operating at 91% utilization?

What hell is going on?

If CPI starts going back up the entire thesis for a bottom in the markets is out-the-window.
Note
I found the reason. It is the switch from summer to winter fuel:

trafficschoolonline.com/blog/high-gas-prices

Refinery Maintenance Limits Supply

Refineries have to be in compliance with summer regulations by April 1. Switching from winter to summer blends requires significant work and “downtime” at refineries, so companies often schedule other maintenance work for the same period.

Since refineries can’t operate at full capacity during this maintenance “season,” the supply of fuel decreases temporarily, contributing to the rising price.
Low Inventory at Distribution Terminals

It takes several weeks for summer gasoline to travel through pipelines and reach distribution terminals across the country, so terminals have until May 1 to purge their winter fuel. Since failure to comply with the requirements results in a steep penalty, terminals are more willing to risk not having any inventory than being late to comply.

These low inventories at the terminals also contribute to higher prices, especially as demand continues to increase throughout the season.


gasbuddy.com/go/gas-price-disconnect-surges-as-some-states-see-spike-others-continue-falling

GAS PRICE BEHAVIOR SWINGS WILDLY
Refinery snags in some areas of the country are contributing to wild fluctuations as areas of the West Coast, Pacific Northwest, Great Lakes and Plains have seen significant refinery issues leading to supply challenges, causing prices to spike even as oil prices have dropped. However, the Northeast and Gulf Coast continue to see normal activity at refineries and prices there have dropped. The disconnect between regions grows larger and will likely remain abnormal for the next few weeks until refinery issues get under control and rectified.
Note
The dollar was declining the in 1970s, so gold was rising with interest rates. Now we have the opposite situation.

The economic landscape is such that if the Fed is forced to Q.E. (Brrrr) into a price inflationary situation, then interest rates and dollar will continue to rise (after any posited respite near-term due to the repeating, worsening cycle of demand destruction followed by government and central bank Q.E. stimulation). If so then all investments will decline (both during the phases of appreciating dollar and on the overall long-term hodling period) except hodling the dollar. IOW, there is no investment other than dollar one can hodl and come out ahead, except at the end-game of the monetary reset. Even altcoins outperform during the end of rallies, but they proceed to radically underperform over the long-trend, so can’t be hodl assets.

Even commodities may be difficult to invest in that environment because they will be volatile because stimulation of demand leads to rising interest rates which destroys demand. This appears to be the monetary death spiral that Armstrong had been warning about since 2015 at least.

So the problem is if this is the case then we can not be successful hodling anything but the dollar, unless we are hodling until public confidence in the dollar is lost (i.e. the necessity for a global monetary reset) some several years from now, in which case gold and legacy Bitcoin would moon.

We thus have been turned into speculators and speculators lose on average.

If the Fed did not bail out a weakening and eventually imploding economy then all investments except bonds would decline. Except maybe gold and legacy Bitcoin would rise if that collapse was enough to break the confidence in the U.S. dollar but I doubt that. I think there is no way the Fed will not Q.E. if the economy is collapsing. Question is at what level of economic decline will the Fed step in with Q.E. (and/or ending Q.T.)? This will impact timing and performance of various investment classes. The Fed does not set interest rates directly but it can influence the economic environment with Q.E. and Q.T. which thus has a market-based impact on interest rates.

The posited thesis for a rally in risk-on investments is that there’s still $4 trillion in accumulated savings sloshing around from the pLandemic stimulus. And if the rise in U.S. interest rates and the dollar pause, then that savings will be attracted to stocks (and crypto). Stock earnings improve when interest rates decline both because of increased spending in the economy and the NAV computation of earnings increasing due to the discount rate being lower. And the opportunity cost to hodl the dollar increases when it is stagnant or declining. This is the reason we must look at the dollar and U.S. interest rates for our cue is because the dollar is the aforementioned monetary wrecking ball in control of the situation with all investment classes.

I think we are indeed headed for such a posited pause but the problem is exactly when. Because we do not know how far stocks and crypto will be able to run up before the next event that forces the U.S. interest rates and dollar back up again. Thus if we buy too high, we may not capture any gains or insufficient gains for our objectives.

We have been turned into bloody speculators. And speculation is damn difficult to succeed with especially in this chaotic environment. If the governments can blow up natural gas pipelines then we have no way to even fathom the pivot points of volatility other than trying to glean market insight from the patterns in the charts themselves (e.g. RSI divergences). We can not trust the Fed to guide us because they told us inflationary would be transitory. Now they tell us that rates will not decline for a long-time.

One wisdom I can share is if you are successful as a speculator then extract the dollars you need and get out. The likelihood of being successful the next time reduces. Speculation is not a game where we should look at luck as a confirmation bias of expertise.
Note
The Bitcoin CME chart gave us bullish RSI divergences on the June bottom foreshadowing the subsequent rally. And it has bullish RSI divergences again on all time frames from 4 hourly to monthly. The CME chart has a very different structure than spot price on the monthly (looks more bullish with a higher close for month of Sep instead of lower on spot) and on the weekly it has broken the ATH support from 2017 and next support is $16475. These charts tell me that BTC could rally now, or it could decline to 16.5k first (or after a rally). If declines immediately that much then the 4-hourly bullish RSI divergence would be lost. Look carefully at that weekly chart.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
The main difference for Bitcoin spot price charts compared to CME are that the monthly & weekly are much more bearish having already broken down from 2017 support with next level ~14K and 16.1k respectively; and weekly has only dubious, bullish RSI divergence. Although the spot chart didn’t signal that June was the bottom either but CME did. Also the 4 hourly chart has dubious, bearish RSI divergence.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
ADA’s weekly chart could be the canary-in-the-coal-mine because:

1. It didn’t form the terminal Elliot Wave invariant (i.e. wave 2 didn’t retrace more than 61.8% of wave 1) thus didn’t require wave 4 to retrace to top of wave 1. Thus strongly signals that the Nov top was the end of wave 5 and now in an A-B-C correction. This wave B rally is unlikely to make a new ATH unless this is an Expanded Flat correction, which is possible. Then wave C will come back down.

2. The ~$0.40 level is strong support because to crash to the next level ~$0.17, would violate the bullish pattern on the ADABTC chart unless BTC were to crash by 60+% which is highly unlikely. Thus it’s highly improbable BTC will have a further major crash but $16+k isn’t implausible.

Bearish RSI divergence on weekly, thus a decline to or below $0.42 is likely or even wick below $0.40.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
I just purchased 12500 ADA at $0.43 with an intention to purchase at least 12,500 more if it declines to $0.42 or below (or in the future based on new analysis if doesn’t decline before a rally).

The rationale is based on the prior analysis with downside risk maybe only ~$0.39, possibility that daily bullish RSI divergence may take priority over weekly bearish, and given that I think ADA will hit at least $1.40 before all is said and done.

This probably is a hodl position until at least $1.40.

Another thought that comes to mind is that it being very unlikely there will not be another altcoin season before the world implodes in 2023/4, because Cardano has an important upgrade coming out. Look what ETH did in anticipation of its recent major “upgrade” to proof-of-stake(sh8t).
Note
ADAETH on both weekly and daily charts, clearly shows that ADA has 2 – 2.5× leverage on ETH by the end of the posited incoming wave B rally, which seems to imply that ADA probably to go higher than $1.40. But the prior bullish RSI divergence turned to bearish, hidden RSI divergence. So ADA is likely to underperform ETH on any initial rally and ADAETH may come back down to form a bullish RSI divergence.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
ETH is also imparting very bullish information! Other than some noise in the 4 hourly time frame that could possibly allow for a slightly pullback to maybe ~$1280 but this may not be necessary, ETH has a bullish RSI divergence on the weekly (the first other than the hidden, bullish which is also on the monthly!) that would be lost if ETH declined significantly. And the A-B-C wave 2 appears to be complete (A = C percentage length) thus ETH poised to rally back above 2k. ETHBTC has bullish RSI divergences.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
The history of the Accumulation/Distribution indicator on the Bitcoin Index chart clearly points to that the bottom was probably June with possibly only an intra-month wick down to double-bottom. Of course this fourth (or fifth) instance could be an outlier but I can only base probabilities on what the indicator tells me about the history.

Note never has Bitcoin made a lower low this far out from the juncture when the indicator turned red.

The indicator final decreased its downside slope (i.e. started to curl towards up) with the September close.

snapshot
Note
The DOGE:ETH trading pair is painting a very bullish picture for DOGE relative to ETH at least by the end of this, if not imminently. On the weekly chart the leverage on ETH is 2 – 6×. Problem is DOGE tends to move in sudden surges and is very volatile, so don’t buy too much. It’s a bet on a homerun only.

Had two drives of bullish RSI divergence, followed by a bearish, followed one drive of hidden, bullish on the daily chart. Could possibly come down to make another drive of hidden, bullish making ETH stronger initially (or maybe not, ditto for ADA) — ditto on 4-hourly (not shown).

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin is below its Realized Price, i.e. the average price of all Bitcoin transacted.

lookintobitcoin.com/charts/realized-price/
Note
Bitcoin’s Pi Cycle Top indicator (which remember guys I employed this indicator to predict the top in April 2021) has not been more bullish than it is now except for two prior, equivalent instances in Bitcoin’s history.

lookintobitcoin.com/charts/pi-cycle-top-indicator/
Note
The Pi Cycle Bottom indicator already triggered just after the June bottom. Currently resembles 2015 and remember I am expecting another crash to come in 2023.

Miner capitulation hash ribbons green signal has also already triggered.

snapshot
Note
It seems the initial E.U. Crypto legislation will be quite lenient and apparently compatible with another altcoin season:

youtu.be/NdsK8Zhlwqg
(LEAKED EU Crypto Bill! Here's What's Coming To Europe!! | Coin Bureau)
Note
Fed may be about to pivot! Possible gap up in markets on Monday! Fed has called an emergency meeting to discuss the discount window liquidity and collateral ratio for banks. Is the Fed about the follow the actions of the E.U., U.K. and Japan to restart some form of liquidity injections? Ostensibly the banks are reeling from massive used car loan Repos being underwater and housing market is also starting to decline.

Peter Schiff also mentioned this.

youtu.be/DIK_cbvcrYk
(Shocking Truth Revealed! Emergency Fed Meeting Indicates Solvency Crisis Imminent | Steven Van Metre)

We knew the Fed would break something. 🤣

youtu.be/24U73nlCLhk
(Debt Markets Have Faltered Dramatically: Solomon CEO | Bloomberg)
Note
Back-to-back months of the most bearish sentiment since the AAII survey was created in 1987. This has never happened. Nearly everyone is bearish.

youtu.be/W9Ni7QbGY2E?t=108 ← click for the infographic
(Buy Now, Wait or Sell The Stock Market This Week? 3 Times This Has Happened. [Sp500, QQQ, TSLA] | FX Evolution)
Note
Bullish although it can lead to a final capitulation move! Short puts on the market have only been this high two previous times since and including the 2001 dot.com crash.

Watch this entire video. A wealth of data. Is making the case for a bounce in October then a final capitulation.

youtu.be/W9Ni7QbGY2E?t=233 ← click for the infographic
(Buy Now, Wait or Sell The Stock Market This Week? 3 Times This Has Happened. [Sp500, QQQ, TSLA] | FX Evolution)
Note
Ron Walker was/is also thinking a S&P move down to 3550 to 3585 (already hit the latter on Friday), then a bounce into October and final capitulation after that. Values being thrown around are 3200 – 3400.

youtu.be/9GPMMSZzfRo?t=1210 ← click for chart
(Stock Market CRASH Wave 3 May Finish Tomorrow - Big Rally Coming Once It Is Done | Ron Walker)

He also goes into detail that the current Kiss of Death signal requires losing the 50 MMA (in green) before we can conclude it will be a 2008 meltdown instead of a rally back up.

youtu.be/rBCjw_k-h08?t=326 ← click for chart
(Is The Kiss of Death On The S&P500 About To Cause A Stock Market CRASH? PT 2 | Ron Walker)

youtu.be/eL_nXzwwGSw?t=1236 ← click for chart
(Prepare For A Stock Market CRASH: IT'S OVER! The S&P 500 Just Got The Kiss Of Death! PT 1 | Ron Walker)
Note
Biden’s illegal attempt to pump additional stimulus into the U.S. economy by forgiving student debt to further stoke price inflation, might be overruled. This Kansas State attorney general makes several valid points about the unfairness of forgiving student debt given that others made sacrifices and should not have to pay the additional taxes to fund this. For examples those who worked simultaneously (as I did!) to pay their tuition. Or those who signed up for the military which funded their university education.

youtu.be/mx68l0gebYM
(Congress did not give this power to the president: Derek Schmidt | Fox Business)
Note
Dollar likely in a topping process below 116 for now:

Japan ready to take ‘decisive’ steps on yen, says finance minister
Note
Ron Walker continues to present the possibility of either an A-B-C bottom wherein the coming rally would have marked the bottom, or a five wave bottom with the posited incoming rally marking the end of wave 3 and another wave 5 lower after the posited bounce.

Bitcoin coiling (second to last chart). Will be a break up or down?

youtu.be/xy6QwJ1ceSo?t=571 ← click for the chart
(BTC URGENT UPDATE: NASDAQ Just Dropped Below Its June Low - Will Bitcoin Take Out The June Low Too? | The Crypto Trader)
Note
Ron Walker @ The Crypto Trader pointed out that although BTC spot daily chart already has the small bullish RSI divergence (inside the circles on my chart) that it would be more convincing if makes a lower low (as the stock markets have already) to form a more significant bullish divergence.

But I had pointed out that ETH will lose that smallish bullish RSI divergence on the weekly if it declines significantly. ETH would then need to move to a lower low than $879 to regain the bullish divergence on the weekly! Is that likely? That could provide a more convincing longer (rather than equal percentage length) wave C than A in the posited A-B-C decline for posited wave 2. There is a possible hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the daily though at a higher level just above ~$1100. Maybe that is what we get instead of bullish divergence on the weekly? Then if that is not the final bottom, bounce up and then maybe come back down again in October for a lower low than $879 and form bullish divergence on the weekly?

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
There was a lot of worry about Credit Suisse on Sunday. I was thinking about informing you all but I decided to sleep on it. Woke up and see Credit Suisse had attempted to reassure investors. And markets are up slightly. However, on this bounce there are now bearish RSI divergences on the 4 hourly (but not on the daily) so I cashed out what I had purchased last night at a profit, while I survey the landscape some more. The VIX looks like it wants to make one more surge. I am not yet confident the rally will ensue. Might need another thrust down on the markets.

Ostensibly that is also why the Fed had called an emergency meeting for today. Is there some contagion event around the corner or are they preempting it effectively? Will their actions be perceived as a pivot by the markets?

I watched some Chinese chick on Bloomberg explain that she is not as worried about a 2008 Lehman collapse, because she claims this is not a balance sheet recession but rather a credit squeeze due to rising interest rates. That is why they have been buying short-dated (e.g. 3 and 6 months) bonds because there is a real risk of a bear market rally.
Note
Is Martin Armstrong blind? Does he not see that the bond market interest rates have already hit 4.5%? The market appears to be almost done raising for now. The Fed funds rate is not that relevant. The QT is relevant but slowing moving and presumably priced into the market already. And the Fed is holding an emergency meeting today to provide more liquidity to banks because they are already caught in a credit squeeze. Thus this is in some fashion the Fed already pivoting as has the Bank of England. Also the markets and the dollar are contingent on the relative interest rates in the U.S. versus abroad. The fact that other nations’ interest rates are rising more rapidly is bearish short-term for the dollar. Which is bullish for stock markets short-term after this current wave C down completes.

The key differences between the 1970s recessions and today is that the oil price did not subside. And gold was rising with interest rates because the dollar was not so strong as now. And the economy rolled over significantly. Whereas now the economy can not handle the rise in interest rates (e.g. Credit Suisse already failing) and the U.K. and E.U. already enacted stimulus via subsidies. The central banks will have no choice but to turn on the money printing machines into high levels of price inflation. And watch the markets go bonkers when they do. Also if the dollar and U.S. interest rates pause then stock markets (and crypto) will go up.

The Federal Reserve is Raising Rates – Get Used to It

The title speaks for itself. The Fed is going to continue raising rates until inflation shows notable improvement. Some still question whether the Fed will ease on its hawkish policies, but there is absolutely every indication to believe they will continue at full speed. Core PCE rose 4.9% in August from the year prior and increased 0.6% for the month.

{…}

Every month there are reports of the market being “spooked” by rate hikes. People come on TV and act surprised that the Fed has the audacity to raise rates yet again. Why? Powell stated in every possible way that the FOMC will raise rates for “some time.” In Powell language, that means rates will continue to rise for a while. The computer foresees havoc going into 2023. Things must get worse before they become better. Unemployment must rise, rates must go higher, and you must adjust your strategy accordingly.
Note
This doesn’t mean there couldn’t be bounce in October, as China reopens, U.K., E.U. and Japan have undertaken desperate actions recently.

But why would a banking crisis or even an escalation of the Ukraine war cause U.S. interest rates to rise? I could see the dollar strengthening but wouldn’t that cause bonds to increase price due to more international capital stampede demand and thus yields to decline in the U.S.? That could have of course cause interest rates to rise abroad. Which would require emergency liquidity injections abroad and/or capital controls perhaps even as diabolical as posited. There is no Panic Cycle for the Armstrong’s DJIA monthly forecast array until May 2023 after the one in September 2022. That liquidity crisis is likely to spillover into U.S. markets and cause the Fed to also pivot. Fed is already pivoting today offering more liquidity to banks due to stress in the credit system.

Gold was rising with interest rates in the 1970s because the dollar wasn’t strong. Would risk assets rise with the dollar if interest rates are not strong? Normally not because that scenario implies a crash in the economy. But what if the crash is abroad not in the U.S.? 🤔

Armstrong responds immediately to my question about if he is blind.

armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/interest-rates/bond-the-fate-of-the-future/

> “The 30-year bond elected a major long-term Quarter Bearish Reversal on target {…} The Quarterly closing was a confirmation that we are looking at both a liquidity crisis in addition to a banking crisis that is most likely with an epic center in Europe {…} what bottoms or peaks with the ECM major turning points is typically very profound. That has been vindicated once against by the bond market peaking the first quarter of 2020 with the turning point. We have entered the STAGFLATION mode since March 14th as we head into April 2023.”

Realize when the banking and liquidity crisis starts in Europe, the powers-that-be will need a scapegoat to prevent people from accessing their funds. Thus the W.E.F. presaging malfunctions in the network (e.g. cyber attack or electrical power outages) as the excuse for shutting down the banking system.
Note
Would the powers-that-be close the Strait of Hormuz and/or the Suez Canal? Thus sending price inflation skyrocketing so that U.S. interest rates would rise as would the dollar?
Note
You guys who purchased crypto recently. I would suggest exiting at a profit while I try to figure out what is likely to happen and the timing.

Remember OPTICALARTdotCOM has a crash to occur this week. I think he has the wrong interpretation of his own chart. But I do not want to bet against him until I feel confident in my understanding of the likely macro events to come.
Note
I had to catch up on some sleep today so I could think clearly, which is why I was sleeping all day.

My reactions:

armstrongeconomics.com/qa/answering-questions-2/

> “Now insofar as the sovereign debt default, we are looking at governments collapsing which will take down banks that must retain reserves in government bonds.”

Astute! That is a very important observation. The banks can not survive as they are forced to hold as Tier 1 capital by B.I.S. regulations. So unless bond interest rates top out then banks will continue bleeding. Are U.S. interest rates topping out for the meantime given the bearish RSI divergences on the monthly and weekly time frames for yields on the 2Y Treasury bond? Just imagine what happens when the B.I.S. designates legacy protocol Bitcoin as Tier 1 capital after WW3. Then the 1989 Economist Magazine Phoenix will be entirely fulfilled. 😉

> “Schwab’s idea {“you will own nothing and be happy”} will fail because the setup is different this time. Marxism succeeded because in Russia serfdom ended only during the 1860s. Therefore, the common people DID NOT own anything and it made sense to raid the rich. This time, people own houses and cars, and they save with pensions and to help their children. This time the common people would have to surrender all their assets so Schwab’s Marxist theories can be implemented.”

Is Armstrong logical? If the plan is that people do not give up their assets but are instead allowed to use them in return for a percentage of their income being garnished automatically by the CBDC then why would Westerners resist when their alternative is starving in the dark? Armstrong seems to ignore how indebted Westerners are and that they will have no choice but to lose their assets or agree to Schwab’s offer. Florida thought it was going to be independent but look they now have lost all availability of home insurance, because the Federal government was preventing insurers from charging market prices. Florida doesn’t have its own sovereign currency and bond market. Florida will be taken down economically with the Minsky Moment just the same as California and Seattle. The real estate boom in Florida will make the bust all the much worse. It is 1929 all over again.

> “Our computer has NEVER been beaten by anyone, even me. It sees the future because it is monitoring everything. So while people argue over what they “think” will happen, Socrates just plugs away and lacks that human emotion that interferes with objectivity.”

I certainly don’t dispute how prescient it has been. But those are interpretations after the events. How do we know that your interpretations of the Forecast Arrays are correct? Do you have a Forecast Array for U.S. interest rates? Would I be able to access that if I upgrade to the $150 monthly subscription level?
Note
"Official" (impostor) Bitcoin Core to Drop to $0 in 2023?


> “bro i dont't understand your chart trading at 28K?? please post an updated chart, also this is a book to read it's too long KISS Keep It Short and Sweet so we can understand. What do you expect a relief rallye, the bottom , a drop? thanks”

@vriviera, okay mutual respect earns my response, bro. This idea has been superseded by the one below. The one below is currently under reconsideration per its latest updates. The ongoing updates on this published idea (the one you are commenting on) are just reaffirming the crises I foresee and documenting the malevolence causing this global train wreck.

2023 - Year From Hell
Note
Two relevant articles:

Today’s “Emergency” Fed Meeting Isn’t Anything Special
(note it was special in the way I have explained, but not for the expectation the author has)

Stocks Jump 3% on Fed Emergency Meeting
Note
The U.S. 10Y Treasury yield had a massive drop from slightly over 4% peak down to 3.58% today.

There is no bearish RSI divergence on the monthly (!!!), but there is on the weekly. That indicates that U.S. interest rates have topped out for the near-term, but within a month or months, they will surge much higher later.

Yet the daily and below have formed hidden, bullish RSI divergence. Indicating that there will be another relief rally perhaps even slightly higher highs. When they come back down again after that, then they will not form hidden, bullish RSI divergence so readily as the current level will serve as a fence on the charts.

Whereas the 2Y Treasury and DXY (dollar) are bearish on all time frames except the 4 hourly. This seems to indicate that the market thinks the Fed rate hiking cycle is largely completed. And the asymmetry to the 10Y (i.e. the potential unwinding of the inverted yield curve where long-end has been paying less than short-dated bonds) seems to indicate the risk of an imminent economic collapse has been pushed out into the future by the willingness of the U.K. for example to increase fiscal stimulus and Bank of England to do emergency Q.E..

This seems to point to potentially a slightly a lower low for stocks and other risk assets before a significant rally. But that rally to be aborted later when interest rates start surging higher again. The dollar could surge in November if the Euro’s Panic Cycle is to the downside. That could cause U.S. stocks to pullback, but not necessarily crash if U.S. interest rates are not rising again. And then as the dollar exhales again, with U.S. interest rates still not rising then risk-on assets could continue to appreciate into Q1 2023 as I had been anticipating.

I do not understand what could be Armstrong’s basis that U.S. interest rates will continue to rise unabated without pause?

Seems Armstrong is solely focused on his fears about international war black swan events. But his international war forecast array does not spike until 2023 (not in 2022) so could that be pushed off into 2023? Why does the Panic Cycle in the Euro in November have to be price inflationary inside the U.S.? The next monthly Panic Cycle for the DJIA forecast array is not until May 2023.
Note
Let’s more meticulously inspect Armstrong’s [url=armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/interest-rates/bond-the-fate-of-the-future/
]statement:

> “The 30-year bond elected a major long-term Quarter Bearish Reversal on target {…} Our models turned up on this level in March 2021 and the next Sovereign Debt Default on a grand scale is likely to unfold by 2025 {…} The Quarterly closing was a confirmation that we are looking at both a liquidity crisis in addition to a banking crisis that is most likely with an epic center in Europe {…} The peak came precisely during the 1st Quarter of 2020 with the major turning point on the ECM 2020.05 reaching 191.69 on the 30-year bond {…} As I have said many times, what bottoms or peaks with the ECM major turning points is typically very profound. That has been vindicated once against by the bond market peaking the first quarter of 2020 with the turning point. We have entered the STAGFLATION mode since March 14th as we head into April 2023.”

Implication that interest rates rise until May 2024, and STAGFLATION persists until April 2023. But that says nothing about a pause in U.S. interest rates along the way.
Note
Click the link in the prior update to view the ECM chart, which is important for comprehending my statement about the implication.
Note
When war shuts off supply chains (e.g. Strait of Hormuz, the Suez canal and/or SE Asia first island chain blockade), then there will be both price inflation and economic collapse, unless the Fed does Q.E. to finance Congress’ inevitable war machine spending to uphold the economy. Which as in WW2 also involved forced rationing to contain price inflation and conserve resources for the war machine.

Unlike after the speculative bubble ending in 1929 driven by capital flight into the dollar (after WW1) where the Great Depression of the 1930s preceded and precipitated WW2, it appears that WW3 will occur simultaneous to the current capital flight into the dollar. So now for the first time the dollar has been strong simultaneous with rising interest rates. But during WW3 the Fed Q.E. brought interest rates down despite the rising CPI from 1940 to 1942 and high CPI persisting until 1944. The DJIA didn’t start rising (after the decline from the rebound out of the 1929 crash) until CPI had peaked in 1942.

FDR had to untether the dollar from gold domestically to finance WW2 and get the world out of a depression by creating a NWO that persisted until Nixon absolved Breton Woods by defaulting on the dollar-to-gold peg internationally.

The non-NATO world must now untether from the paper dollar to finance WW3 against the dollar peg (i.e. global reserve currency) system. The Fed will have to finance the dollar-peg side of WW3.

There isn’t likely to be a -85% speculative bubble driven market crash now as was the case for the DJIA after 1929. Rather the flash crashes (expecting -63% on the S&P) will be caused by black swan events created by the W.E.F.. The next one is likely to be some forced lockdown of the banking system, perhaps to be blamed on a “Russian” cyber or tactical nuclear attack (e.g. creating cascading disruption of electrical grid). The Fed’s Q.E. will be turned into Schwab’s enslavement system where to receive your rations you must register for the CBDC so you can be dolled out your share of the government’s fiscal stimulus. We are unlikely to even have a 2024 POTUS election, so the Federal government will operating rogue anyway but nobody will be able to do anything about it because we will all (in the U.S.) be bankrupted without the Fed’s handouts.

After the posited incoming final attempt for an ATH in 2023, I think it is time to sell the stock markets and run away for at least a decade. The W.E.F. plan is to strangle the Western consumer economies with forced rationing via CBDCs (e.g. as a first indoctrination step only subsidizing a portion of their egregious electricity bills this winter in Europe) and blame it on WW3. The only speculative future may be legacy protocol Bitcoin (and to a lesser extent gold) as they rise as the alternative to the dying dollar-peg system and the inadequate Russia-Chinese alliance monetary system.

The other investments that may prosper will be anything in demand during war under a rationing regime enforced with draconian centralized central bank digital currency (CBDC) accounts. Even the price of oil fell during WW2 (← chart on the W.E.F. forum) because ostensibly consumer demand was low.

Central Bank QE

Q: Will QE continue if we end up in war? It seems there would be no choice.

A: Yes. The Fed was “directed” by the White House to carry out QE during World War II {…} As the war unfolds in Europe, the capital will flee as usual to the States. But the money supply will have to increase because the dollar will become the only viable currency still standing {…} The Fed has been raising rates to fight inflation that will fail because this has to do with shortages – not speculation {…} That said, the Fed is faced with a triple crisis – liquidity, banking stability, and an inevitable Sovereign Debt Crisis. As interest rates have risen based on domestic inflation rates, simultaneously, the higher rates have undermined both European banks as well as Emerging Markets. The Federal Reserve has become the DEFACTO central bank of the world.
Note
> “The non-NATO world must now untether from the paper {i.e. unanchored, fiat} dollar to finance WW3 against the dollar peg (i.e. global reserve currency) system.”

We are in the Thucydides trap. The powers-that-be are intentionally discrediting the dollar reserve currency system as they will create the conditions that usher in their legacy protocol Bitcoin as Rothschild’s 1989 Economist Magazine Phoenix rising from the ashes as predicted and planned out 33 years ago by our overlords deep behind that curtain that Armstrong can’t even access (no Margaret Thatcher had no access to this deeply hidden cabal).

The entire world will be driven to hate the current dollar-based system. The W.E.F. is being set up as scapegoats in the end, but that will not come soon enough to escape our enslavement in the Great Reset plan.

The world is moving to a new two-tier monetary system (like the one during Breton Woods where gold was not money domestically but was internationally until Nixon abrogated) with legacy protocol Bitcoin as the international tier (per famed mathematician John Nash’s Ideal Money proposal published on JStor) and domestically we will all be banned from transacting in Bitcoin and instead enslaved on fully centralized, draconian 666-like CBDCs. Welcome to the next NWO after Breton Woods.

The World is Pointing Fingers at the US for Attacking Nord Stream

Even Jeffrey David Sachs, an American economist, has come out and said on TV, as the journalists go nuts, that the US destroyed Nord Stream. Everyone I have spoken to from around the world, including high levels, all believes the US did this and I know there is a think tank that has recommended the US now take out the South Stream through Turkey. This was a formal act of war. Russia sees it that way, as does most of the world. This is an attempt to destroy the economy of Russia where energy accounts for 50% of its GDP.
Note
So Armstrong is clarifying in his private blog that there’s also a Panic Cycle in third week of November for NatGas. So presumably this is what leads him to believe that the Panic Cycle in the Euro in the second week of November will be to downside. Presumably those who sniff the posited coming attack on the pipelines in the Black Sea (he points out an intelligence report has recommended blowing these up to cut off Russian NatGas revenue) would dump the Euro in advance.

It makes sense that the Biden administration may want to create a distraction after the mid-term elections on November 8 if they will be significantly rigging the elections (especially for the Senate). One could speculate that they hope to establish some war time executive powers almost like martial law, perhaps to intimidate or imprison those who might be vocal about the election outcome.

Also note that Direction Change on Oct 10. Looks like I am correct about a rally in the stock markets and crypto starting in October.

Okay so there is a panic selloff in the Euro in November and NatGas spikes. But that hardly affects the U.S. price inflation situation. The E.U. would need to stimulate more thus further increasing their price inflation to compensate for the weakening Euro. They will not opt for the central bank monetizing ZIRP because hyperinflationary collapse would be antithetical to Klaus Schwab’s plan to trade debt forgiveness for servitude via CBDC enforcement. Read Think Like a Bankster. Hyperinflation never occurs where the citizens hold many valuable assets and large debts, because it would make it trivial to pay off debts.

So it seems the effect would most economic enslavement of Europe while the Euro would climb back up from 89 and the U.S. stock market rally would continue into Q1 2023 perhaps have a respite.

I still do not know why Armstrong thinks this potential action in November is the end game of WW3. It is only another salvo. The real hostilities will not break out until later in 2023. Russia is still mobilizing and such. And as Armstrong says the pressure on Putin to take the side of the hardliners has to reach the boiling point in Russia. I do not think Putin is so politically weak that they can overthrow him in the instant the Black Sea pipelines are blown up because surely at that point Putin will start to make contingent promises of lines-in-the-sand to the hard liners.
Note
Typo: perhaps AFTER a respite.

Add: The key is to keep the price inflation above the level of bond interest rates to bankrupt everyone.
Note
ADD: another key point is that if these gas pipelines are destroyed anonymously then Russia can not declare war on the U.S.A. directly without being painted by the International Community as the instigators of WW3. I suspect Putin would attempt to take some action in Lithuania and claim he is operating only secure his contracts for free passage there? Or more likely he could escalate in Ukraine (which is not NATO) to attempt to force the West to become entwined such that he able to justify direct nuke retaliation against the West? You see it is really difficult for this to escalate to a direct attack on NATO immediately. So what changes in November for the U.S. interest rates and price inflation? Nothing maybe.
Note
The Bitcoin bottom was June. We could have another intra-month wick down but becoming unlikely to even go below 17k.

youtu.be/ddKaLuee8SQ
(WARNING: BITCOIN JUST FLASHED RED – Do This NOW | Crypto Crew University)
Note
Per Crypto Crew U’s video and the following one, Bitcoin very, very likely heading up to at least its 20 WMA at ~22.6k, although it could face some resistance at the downtrend line ~21k. SPX likely headed up to 3900 – 4000. Then let’s look out for retest down in the week of Oct 17. Possibly we have one more bad CPI report before the CPI starts to fall rapidly in the U.S. (because we had a spike in gas prices last two weeks in September due to refinery maintenance and owner-equivalent-rents are lagging house price declines).

youtu.be/kpujB2b9JgA
(Bitcoin It's Happening Again On Price Today | Eric Krown Crypto)

snapshot

snapshot
Note
youtu.be/hfUc0-zY3VI
(The bond market is sensing an end to the Fed rate hikes, says Anthony Scaramucci | CNBC Television)
Note
I think he could be right that bottomed already, but might have a final capitulation after a bounce. He may change his mind if the SPX makes a 10% move in 2 weeks. He will realize it is too fast.

youtu.be/24QNHGcIygw
(Eric Johnston's about face on the markets | CNBC Television)
Note
Highly recommend watching entire video on double-speed. Ron Walker discusses the possibilities but leans heavily to that we are near to a bottom if not already. He personally believes will come back down to 3200 – 3400 one final time after this bounce.

youtu.be/MaW5zEyqnSI?t=1003
(This Correctly Called The Stock Market Top & Predicted The CRASH Will It Call The Bottom?)
Note
Bullish Harmonic forming


If that’s a Gartley then the D bottom has completed:

snapshot

If it’s a Bat then D anytime in October or November required down to $1000:

snapshot

I suppose this is an inexact art.
Note
My hypothesis (based partly on what Ron Walker said) is that markets may move back up to their 20 WMA on this bounce. BTC and ETH are ~12% below their 20 WMA. DOGE only 5%. And ADA 43%!!!! So we should probably be holding more ADA than DOGE at least.

snapshot
Note
The spiking dollar and interest rates has unleashed massive instability in the banking system, especially in Europe. These central banks will pivot much sooner than the market is currently expecting. Effectively they have already pivoted to some degree, e.g. the Fed emergency meeting.

youtu.be/KagY6ZIlNQk
(Get Your Money Out! Lehman 2.0 Event is About to Crash the Global Banking System | Steven Van Metre)
Note
youtu.be/r0rdi-XP2h8
(This is Exactly What Happened in 2007. | We Are on the VERGE of a Major Market Move | Game of Trades)
Note
Finally OPTICALARTdotCOM turns slightly bullish for the next few days.

youtu.be/99qEFc0yGTc?t=670
Note
youtu.be/eVwuiPsc95Y
(BILLIONAIRE SAYS BITCOIN HAS BOTTOMED (INSANE PREDICTION) | Altcoin Daily)
Note
We gave a gap up on DJIA and S&P today. So I say very likely after this bounce the price will come back down again to fill that gap at least.
Note
Seasonality would indicate a significant pullback in November. So I don’t see any catastrophe on the horizon if the Euro and NatGas have a Panic Cycle in November. Ron Walker is expecting S&P rise to 3852 then dump to 3400 – 3500 for final bottom in October.

youtu.be/I367f1UxFok?t=73 ← click for seasonality chart
(How Low Will The Stock Market CRASH? S&P 500 CRASH WAVE 5 Projections & Price Targets - Elliott Wave | Ron Walker)
Note
twitter.com/gameoftrades_/status/1577342788282089472
(Game of Trades: The number of people sitting on the sidelines is astonishing.)

twitter.com/gameoftrades_/status/1577380535588061184
(Game of Trades: Hedge funds are short at record levels.)
Note
There may not be any more updates from me. Apparently there’s some concerted effort to censor me.

I use Tradingview informally. Have no desire to aid and abet that sort of behavior by playing Whac-A-Mole with the legion of midwit ants.
Note
Will sneak in one more update.

Had a moment to study the study the charts more carefully. BTC is potentially still bullish on the daily and 4-hourly. Might get another bounce this week perhaps up to 3850 S&P and ~21k BTC. Not sure of that, just a possibility. So I repurchased some BTC.

On the weekly and monthly I can’t help but lean towards there could be one more capitulation wick down despite the massive bearish sentiment. But a bull trap this week back to the upside would be a perfect setup for the Panic Cycle predicted for the following week of Oct 17. I can still visualize a bearish triangle formation and a breakdown on the monthly stochastic RSI hinting at a repeat of October 2018. A double-top leads to a double bearish triangle? One final wick down to $15 – 16k would be perfect to form a very strong bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart. A last gasp bear trap rally on the dollar and U.S. interest rates would be fitting. Would get even more retail to capitulate bearish before the whipsaw, slingshot back up. Then another Panic Cycle on the Euro in mid-November.

Nobody knows for sure and 19.4k is not a bad price. I am reasonably confident that BTC will be heading much higher eventually sometime in Q1 2023.

snapshot
Note
???

snapshot
Note
This will probably be censored:

Buy around 209 - big upside


Unless it breaks out above downtrend line, beware of one more drop to 147 after any bounce this week. Else a pullback to said line. Note ADA and DOGE have the similar bullish, declining, narrowing wedge underneath a downtrend line.
Note
Armstrong has that lower 24.2k level on his private blog chart, but I really doubt going that low. Armstrong says watch $25 – 26k, but I think rather $26.5 – 27.5k only is the target for the Oct 17 Panic Cycle week.

snapshot
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=LS1y-ZCKTf8&lc=UgxCxArrijnl8nA6zIN4AaABAg.9grxOAO90B_9gxJ5fdsQUt

> “If “something breaks bad”, a pivot isn’t going to fix it. I wouldn’t be surprised to see a complete breakdown of the USA economy. People who’ve saved $ for 40 years aren’t going to stay “civilized” when their retirement funds disappear. January 6 will look like a cakewalk. It’s already happening in EU. Only a matter of time before civil unrest spreads to the states. 🍿”

@Lysergicaciddiethylamideaddict the U.S. economy can not break down catastrophically for as long as the government cum Fed can print more dollars and the world is willing to eat those dollars. The Thucydides Trap will require a WW3 to hand-off the superpower mantle to China. Until then the dollar rules the roost.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=Ub6zP6q25zk&lc=UgwK0_j9Qj_ylJvynpV4AaABAg.9go-KxatIGi9gxLBsN8bD-

> S. Moore Many of us spoke before Congress with issues such as the Fairness Doctrine along with other important issues. We wrote letters and marched...We spoke at school boards & political meetings. We rallied and gave speeches. We spoke out and called people in government. We promoted talk radio....The problem is an uninformed, uninterested society who cannot care less. The schools indoctrinated along with all media & Hollywood. IMO, most people would not understand this issue, muchless all the other important issues that control our every day lives..

K Foster upvoted. But your mistake was talking and politics. Politics is always failure directed to the least common denominator. Instead we need the opt-in crypto Networked State. I’m building.
Note
May the force be with us.

I remain a founding stock State National American citizen by birth — not a vassal of the United States Incorporated papal legal fiction:

tasa.americanstatenationals.org

annavonreitz.com/

This can never be taken away from me by any impostor government abetted by Abraham Lincoln’s illegal Lieber Code martial law. My lateral ancestor Isaac Shelby was a key Revolutionary War general. And my direct ancestors served in the first Mississippi State militia.
Note
Something like this


Something like this


You been chainsmoking with Coldplay? Armstrong’s Panic Cycle for the week of Oct 17 to the upside and not a final capitulation. Hmm. Everyone is far too bearish. I was also contemplating maybe a bull trap bounce this week and then tease a major crash next week with a bear trap.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=LS1y-ZCKTf8&lc=UgxCxArrijnl8nA6zIN4AaABAg.9grxOAO90B_9gyYPaQvU04

> > The bond market already priced in the future terminal interest rates. Markets are forward looking. The market implosion will not come until later in 2023 when the economy has an employment recession. The markets are highly oversold and much lower than they should be. Everyone is illogically bearish.

> “S. Moore oversold didn't matter in 2008, we will bottom out at 2018 levels”

OH Word? did not have the levels fear at this juncture in 2008. Yes 2018 levels when the unemployment recession finally comes later in 2023. But first back up for very significant rally into Q1 2023, possibly a new ATH. Note probably one more leg of capitulation first. Consume Ron Walker’s and Game of Trades’ channels.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=LS1y-ZCKTf8&lc=UgxCxArrijnl8nA6zIN4AaABAg.9grxOAO90B_9gy_QhegtAb

> “S. Moore we are no where near the same level of fear as 2008, people claim record high puts but forget people are also buying massive calls at the "bottom." Fear is when no one wants to touch a stock again. We need the capitulation part for a temporary bottom that later gets taken out from people having to sell their investments in order to survive. 2018 is a bit more organic levels compared to the stimulus bump from covid in 2020”

OH Word? The AAII survey registered the highest bearish sentiment (60%) in its entire history since 1987. Indeed the capitulation in late 2023 will be as you describe but for now back up we go. You are correct that we might not have enough retail capitulation yet and so maybe one final leg down this month. You be caught chasing it up after that, always selling all the way up buying temp-highs and selling pullbacks thinking it will crash. This how the greater fools end up buying the top when we sell in Q1 2023. There is $4 trillion of accumulated savings from the pLandemic that has no where to go but back into the stock market.
Note
Mid term projection


Mid term projection


Did you invent a yet unnamed harmonic pattern? The only applicable pattern I know is the Shark pattern. Which would project ~4800 – 4920 at any time. Also the bottom would be up to ~30 points lower. I could envision ~4800 by March/April, a summer correction to ~4200 followed by a rally to ~4800 – 4920 the remainder of 2023. Then an egregious -63% flash crash in 2024 mimicking the pLandemic amplified by 1.75×. Martin Armstrong’s Socrates A.I. Yearly Forecast Array for the S&P has a Direction Change in 2024 and again in 2025. He asserts I think correctly that there can’t be a -90% crash as was the case in the Great Depression because that required a multi-year, deflationary shift to Treasury bonds. Whereas at this time with global stagflation there’s been a flight from U.S. Treasury bonds because interest rates have been rising and are projected to rise to ~6+% into 2026/7. Armstrong is ostensibly only focused on the Aggregate row of said Forecast array which only exhibits a decline for 2022. He might be ignoring those Direction Changes and the Monthly Forecast arrays might exhibit some Panic Cycles for the posited -63% crash. Armstrong’s reasoning is correct in that the only way for the powers-that-be to manufacture deep crashes on the S&P is to create some kind of egregious “black swan” (actually false-flags) event which creates a temporary stampede to the safety of bonds. I posit that the launch of a nuclear weapon might do it?

snapshot
Note
The Shark bottom thesis seems quite plausible with the coming rally to 0.885 to 1.13 of the distance back up to the prior ATH. The DJIA overshot its posited Shark bottom slightly though. If this is correct then Armstrong is incorrect about a significantly lower low incoming in October or November.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Armstrong sees his Socrates’ Panic Cycles for the Euro and Natural Gas in November and seems to be convinced that the dollar is going to make its final peak in 2022. He seems convinced that the stock markets will move significantly lower before rallying in 2023. He blogs that everyone will be screaming that it is 1929 again, and that will be a bear trap.

But why would the final peak in the dollar be in 2022? The other major nations are taking actions to reflate. The other nations’ ammunition might not be fully depleted yet, for as long as global trade is still functioning. Why would Putin make a bold move so hastily when his 300,000 troops call up presumably requires training time. Why would he initiate a major offensive during the Fall rains which will make Ukraine too muddy?

The charts seem to be disagreeing with Armstrong’s interpretation of those Panic Cycles. Looks like the Panic Cycle will be in the positive directions, not in the terrorist bombing of more pipelines direction that Armstrong fears for November.

The EURUSD has bullish Gartley reversal pattern and bullish RSI divergence on the weekly and monthly:

snapshot

Natural Gas has a Shark pattern projection to $3:

snapshot
Note
The posited Shark harmonic pattern implies that the S&P will only decline slightly more to 3520 – 3545. There’s already hidden, bullish divergence on the 4 hourly and a drop below 3560 would convert it to regular, bullish divergence, which is already present on the weekly and daily, but would also create another drive of it on the daily as well. I think either Ron Walker’s wave #4 isn’t complete and bounce here, then back down again for Armstrong’s Panic Cycle week of Oct 17 possibly giving us the significantly lower low that is posited for the 5 wave correction. Or that it’s not a 5 wave correction and wave C of A-B-C is completing now with the the Panic Cycle next week to the upside. Either way the bottom is very likely in October or at the latest mid-November. And I very much doubt Bitcoin will drop below 15k (~25 – 40% odds of 15k) and ~17k (~50% odds of 17k). In the worst case would be 13.9k but I put only ~5 – 15% odds on that. The market participants are far too bearish right now. I will follow-up in my next message for more reasons the bottom is near.

snapshot
Note
Jerry Manders (the mathematician) is becoming very bullish:

tradingview.com/u/JerryManders/
Note
youtu.be/xt8se43gN5I ← click to view chart

The 5 year forward inflation expectations chart leads CPI by 3 months and is suggesting that the Oct 13 CPI report will shock to the downside.

But Kevin is attempting to develop a theory that it will be different this time and instead inflation expectations will rise.

He posits that homeowners who are sensitive to rising mortgage rates set those expectations, but renters who are not sensitive keep spending on credit because they expect inflation to come down thus sustaining the inflation.

That’s tortured “logic.”
Note
BoE to end emergency bond buying starting on the week of Oct 17. Could that cause another panic spike up in the dollar?

youtu.be/65lWzTojcnk
(DIRE Warning from Bank of England: "You have 3 Days Left.")

EDIT: This might be FUD. But the stampede was a contagion after the new administration decided to increase spending and cut taxes. The BoE just stepped into normalize interest rates at a higher level they believe is commensurate with the increase inflation that will result from the additional spending of the new UK administration. If the U.S. interest rates have peaked and the UK interest rates are stable and thus competitive then this could be a pivot and the British pound could recover. If the pound will recover then who wants to stampede out to the dollar? Also market participants have had time during the liquidity respite offered by the BoE, to pay for hedging insurance if they’re vulnerable to contagion risk.
Note
armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/stock-indicies/private-blog-the-world-share-markets/

Armstrong still thinks the Panic Cycles in November into the November 8 U.S. midterm election will correspond to a selloff in markets. He is expecting the low to be in November. He also cites the ‘bearish quarterly reversals’, which presumably means in normal terminology a bearish engulfing 3rd quarter compared to the 2nd quarter. We also had bearish engulfing on Bitcoin, but Bitcoin has defied a bullish engulfing in the past and trended the opposite direction. So a bearish engulfing can also mark exhaustion and not necessarily the start of a trend. In fact, if it is the start of a trend then there should be multiple bearish quarters ahead, which seems to make no sense as even Armstrong is ostensibly expecting a rally into Q1 2023.

Armstrong is also citing the potential for a bearish engulfing close to the yearly candle, but 2022 has not ended yet. That is a bit premature of him. There is still the possibility of the usual seasonal midterm election year rally in Q4 which would obviate the bearish engulfing candle on the yearly chart.

Armstrong could possibly be entirely misinterpreting the Panic Cycle in November. If the Republicans take the House then the markets will assume that spending will be controlled and thus demand driven inflation will moderate. This could be a pivot for U.S. Treasuries and the dollar. Thus the Panic Cycle in the Euro could be a massive bounce, not a crash.

Also it sure feels like the Panic Cycle for the week of Oct 17 is going to be the upside, not to the downside. The market participants are far too bearish and there are a massive quantity of puts on the market. There is very likely to be a short squeeze soon. Possibly Oct 17 could be a wick lower then reverse to the upside, or vice versa.

The 5 year inflation expectations chart leads CPI by 3 months and thus the next CPI report should continue the downward trajectory. And the November report should really drop precipitously as declining home and preowned car prices start to really bite. As well the seasonal back-to-school spending spree ended and consumers stop spending to save for Christmas. Also vacation spending should have been winding down. Must of the CPI was in leisure and hospitality. People were enjoying as much as they could given they suffered so much during the pLandemic. But vacationers do get saturated and eventually decide to go back to work and prepare for winter.

Seems Armstrong is expecting Russia to immediately deploy tactical nukes and knock out Europe’s electrical grid this winter. But I highly doubt that. Russia is moving forward methodically. They have only now shifted their war to a counter-terrorism operation in the whole of Ukraine. Russia not going to escalate to an attack on NATO in 2022. What is Armstrong smoking?

Also seems Armstrong is letting fear overcome him. He seems to fear that the Demonrats will take some extreme actions to try to overcome the election process. I do think the Senate elections will be rigged. But it will probably be more difficult to rig all of the House elections because they are much more localized.

Also the harmonic patterns are indicating the the stock markets have already bottomed or nearly do. The harmonic pattern for natural gas indicates it is headed down to $3. I see that Japan for example will plan to go modularized, localized, perfectly safe nuclear power (with a special helium cooled reactor that will supply hydrogen fuel for industry) and completely remove their dependence on natural gas. China is building 170 new nuclear plants.

The best time to buy is at maximum FUD.

Maybe Armstrong is correct. Unfortunately I do not have access to all of his Forecast Arrays. Maybe he has observed some correlation that causes him to take a bearish interpretation of the Panic Cycles.
Note
Armstrong is also writing more long-term about an eventual panic out of bonds entirely because governments will default on their debt. That has no relevance whatsoever heading into 2024. The U.S. is no where near defaulting. The current focus is on price inflation and at what level with the U.S. bonds peak in yield, so that investors will start buying them again. And the current focus is also about the weakness of economies abroad, thus their low interest rates thus the strong dollar. But the UK has stimulated. And China is preparing to stimulate after Xi is reelected at the CCP Congress starting Oct 16.

The U.S. can not default on sovereign bonds until the dollar is no longer the world’s reserve currency. I think Armstrong has entirely the wrong model in his head. The strong dollar is going to wreck the world and usher in WW3. The focus has to be on the timing for WW3.

Armstrong thinks there will not be another flash crash because bonds are also a bad investment when price inflation is rising. But that is not the case in a flash crash scenario such as the pLandemic. There will probably be another flash crash probably in 2024 and it will probably be -63% of the S&P. Even Armstrong has two directional changes in 2024 and 2025 on his Forecast Array and also an increase in Overnight Volatility in 2024.

Also it makes no sense that the markets would moon into stocks and not also into Bitcoin. Yet Steve @ Crypto Crew University has clearly shown there is a 5.3× bullish move off each major low of Bitcoin. So if the low will be significantly lower than the June 17.5k bottom then the top in ~2025 would be lower than the 2021 ATH. A drop to 13K is possible, but 10k is irrational at this juncture. A flash crash to 10k in 2024 is plausible — repeating the pattern from 2019–20.

Also Steve may be forgetting that there was that precipitous rally from $3 to 14K in 2019 before the 2020 flash crash. I am expecting that to repeat with another precipitous rally incoming. Then a horizontal 2023 with a rally into the end of the year then another flash crash in perhaps March 2024.

Remember Craig “Faketoshi” Wright warned that the ANYONECANSPEND attack would correspond with a halving event. The next halving event is projected to be in February 2024.

Liz Truz is under pressure to increase social welfare spending and thus increase inflation in the UK, which will be bullish for UK interest rates and thus also for the British currency:

armstrongeconomics.com/international-news/politics/liz-truss-approval-plummets/
Note
Have you all observed how prescient Jeremy Manders was? And he says the bottom is now.

Establishing a Bottom - 390s next stop
Note
Martin Armstrong almost screwed me up. He was trying to make us bearish and cautious. I am really doubting his comprehension of what is really going on.

The mathematician was also prescient on Bitcoin and is now turning bullish.

Downside toward 20.3k-20.4k


Bitcoin possible paths


The markets all set and ready to turn bullish. We may have one more wick down this week on the S&P to 3520 – 3545. And BTC may wick down to $17.5 – 18.4k.

snapshot
Note
armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/stock-indicies/nasdaq/private-blog-dow-v-nasdaq/

This I agree with this. Armstrong points out that international capital flows will prefer the blue chips stock on DJIA so it would bottom first. And true that capital has no where to go but into stocks, except on flash crashes then into bonds. But eventually that trillions in capital is going into legacy protocol Bitcoin as the Thucydides Trap plays out.

Note though that Nasdaq and crypto will outperform the DJIA on the rallies. And the Fed will have no choice but to Brrrr. Never will the Fed be able to stop itself from enjoining the destruction of the current monetary system.

And thus there will not be any egregious crash until the entire economy is shut down again in 2024 due to nuclear war and/or a cyber attack by “Russia” on the Western banking system.
Note
I warned you guys yesterday the ADA breaking down was a bad sign.

youtu.be/O-Lo6TeGtdU?t=273
(Inflation Nightmare! Disastrous CPI Report LIVE | Meet Kevin)
Note
Ostensibly the Shark pattern is not useful for targeting the bottom as it can extend even to 1.618. Rather is it for targeting the top of rally that follows.

harmonics.app/harmonic-shark-pattern-in-forex/
Note
I think we will bottom in the mid-to-high 17000s. Bounce to ~22k, then decline to a higher-low in November. Then up we go into March/April 2021.

youtu.be/KFZbvhiFR-Q?t=297 ← click for chart of rings

youtube.com/watch?v=KFZbvhiFR-Q&lc=UgyKmkhlE2rsnklfIYZ4AaABAg
(Comments on Dropping some facts about where bitcoin is headed! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

Bear trap. Going to ride that aqua ring up until April 2023 then come down. Central banks and governments are being forced to pivot because the financial system is breaking.
Note
I’m trying to develop a historically consistent model of the current monetary reset and incoming WW3. I had been hoping for Armstrong to lead the way to comprehensive understanding but he has not yet articulated a coherent, holistic model. Let’s see if I can assist.

1. Deflation is not possible until the reserve currency of the world is not held by the strongest economy. Deflation was possible after 1929 because although capital was fleeing to the U.S. because it had the safest economy outside of any warzone (nearly impossible to attack the U.S. except with nukes) but the U.S. dollar was not yet the world’s reserve currency. Thus sovereign bonds will be a very poor investment (other than any flash crash in markets due to black swan event) because interest rates must rise abroad else their currencies implode (driving price inflation to the moon) cratering their economies. The periphery nations (i.e. not the U.S.) must either borrow-and-spend to avoid the implosion that high interest rates and/or imploding currencies will impose. Or for the Non-Aligned Movement nations dehitch from the dollar and grow their way out (which the geriatric boomer bulge demographics cum socialist, unfunded retirement liabilities in the developed world can not do). And ultimately some countries will even default on their sovereign bonds. (Tangentially: Either Americans stop Brandon’s intentional forcing of Russia to nuclear war, or Russia, China, N. Korea and Iran will eventually have no choice but to desperately and fatalistically break the U.S.S.A. and all of NATO with nukes)

2. The turn of the 20th century was the transfer of the Anglo-Saxon empire to the U.S. from Europe. The 1970s was the rise of egregious demand for resources as the global boomers demographic bulge entered the workforce and prime spending years. First there was stagflation as the resource intensive countries (e.g. Russia, Iran, OPEC) asserted their pricing power under the scapegoat of the U.S. support for Israel. But then interest rates rose to nosebleed levels in the early 1980s which caused for example the former Soviet Union to collapse which broke the solidarity of the resource intensive countries. This consequent cheap labor and cheap resources peace dividend is what fed the Western debt bubble since. But that peace dividend and that form of globalization has come to an abrupt end, because the global debt bubble reached the Minsky Moment and the now we have another demographic bulge (in the developing countries) entering the work force and prime spending years competing for resources. The developed world is being intentionally thrown to the dogs because there’s no plausible economic future. The Thucydides Trap is underway and will result in the end of the U.S. dollar reserve currency and Anglo-Saxon empire. Also will maybe end up as Deagel.com predicted back in ~2014 that NATO countries will lose 50 – 75% of their populations to self-immolating economic collapse, war and pestilence (aka societalcide). I’m thinking possibly widespread radiation sickness from nuclear war. Note Carl Sagan’s nuclear winter hypothesis is probably nonsense. And south of the equator would be spared of radiation fallout as the jet streams don’t cross it.
Note
Thus, we are in the Austrian Crack-up Boom. The developed world nation-states have no choice but to enslave themselves in borrow-and-spend with their central banks self-immolating by buying all the sovereign debt. At the end the developed world central banks will hold all of it.

Imagine as interest rates rise the pension funds who were required to hold bonds at near zero interest rates will blow up. The (at least E.U.) banking system will blow up (which is a reason the W.E.F. is promulgating an incoming cyber attack on the banks as a scapegoat). The consumer will blow up. The Bank of England, Bank of Japan and Bank of Australia already pivoted, as well the governments already piling on subsidies and soon more bailouts. The individual E.U. nations with their sovereign bonds issued in Euros are next to pivot to this along with the ECB. The last to pivot will be the U.S.S.A. as our economy also can’t withstand these high interest rates. Are you picking up what I am throwing down? The developed world nations will stimulate into stagflation and will not tolerate a -95% stock market meltdown and deflation.

Yet this stagflation environment is also putting enormous economic and thus internal political pressure on Russia, China, N.Korea, Iran — all of the Non-Aligned Movement nations. Thus the world bifurcates into a WW3 because those nations also need the scapegoat of WW3 to sell their populations on a scapegoat (e.g. covidiocy and next patriotism) instead of regime change. Armstrong is incorrect to frame the war with Russia (and soon China et al) as one-sided instigation by Brandon and the Neocons. China needs this WW3 too and has been manipulating the situation to help bring it about.

Thus there will be some black swan event in 2024 that causes a -63% flash crash on the S&P. For a blip in time mimicking March 2020, bonds will spike to massive profits. And China will sell into that rally for sure. The Thucydides Trap is underway and the West will self-immolate while the East rises to be the economic future of the world after Armstrong’s 2032 ECM peak (of the socialistic, decrepit Western civilization).

As Armstrong rightfully points out that 50T in global capital has no place to go but the private sector, i.e. stocks. And that will also include legacy protocol Bitcoin eventually as the future monetary reset of the world takes form with culmination of WW3 and the Thucydides Trap towards the end of this decade.

So we must buy the dips on the U.S. stock markets because they will rise even with an overall rise in the level of interest rates and dollar, because capital has nowhere else to go. But there will be egregious volatility also.

We need to be on the lookout for another leg down or a pullback in November as the E.U. and ECB are likely the next to experience a Panic Cycle in their situation akin to the recent pivots by the U.K., Japan and Australia. Once that is out of the way then the U.S. stock markets can turn bullish as the U.S. equities are currently far oversold relative to the current state of the economy. Eventually the U.S. economy will also roll over but there are some months to go before that and the U.S. govt is likely to simulate and Fed likely to accommodate over the summer 2023 to spur another rally into Fall 2023 before the flash crash likely in 2024 due to some black swan events that surface because of said need for scapegoats.

The implications ahead are dire for the West in particular because the scapegoats have the West as the target and the government becoming the entire economy looms which means totalitarianism, pestilence, and perhaps even mega-death. You have been warned to GTFO before the exit doors slam shut.
Note
Even with the central banks going insane and buying up all the sovereign debt (and remember the end game is as John Titus’ research revealed that BlackRock already owns the Fed and will ostensibly parlay this into corporate-fascist takeover of the U.S. Treasury Dept as Western civilization descends into a 666 technocracy panopticon), hyperinflation can only occur if the citizens entirely lose confidence in their government cum central banks AND ALSO they have the ability to flee with their capital. But the powers-that-be (e.g. Klaus Schwab, Bill Gates, the Neocons, Brandon et al) have already prepared for that and will impose capital controls preventing capital from fleeing. That is if you do not get your capital out pronto before the stampede begins (probably imminently) then you will not have access to your funds except as doled out in small morsels periodically per capital control limits. This is how they implement the “you will own nothing and be happy only as a renter receiving a small rationing allowance via the CBDC.” The Carbon Credits scam will also be the scapegoat for the rationing. Westerners will live out a dismal life. Boomers will probably just choose to sign-off from life, thus Deagel’s 50+% population immolation.

Of course this will blamed on some scapegoat such as Russian hackers creating a cyber attack on the banking system or whatever. And those who want liquidity will have to adopt the soon-to-be, newly introduced 666-like central bank digital currencies (CBDCs) which in essence means BlackRock will own you and control every financial transaction you conduct.
Note
Note regarding #1 that the Fed (or actually the markets) made a mistake by lowering interest rates in the 1920s thinking that would discourage international capital from fleeing Europe to the dollar, which just caused the stock market to go parabolic because the capital still fled. As the Fed (or actually the markets) raised interest rates capital was able to flee from the stock market bubble to the bonds. Subsequently FDR was able to combat the strong dollar problem with the threat of followed by then the actual order to confiscate gold and devalue the dollar overnight as priced in gold. Thus the world was able to avoid the immediate economic and political pressures of a runaway strong dollar because the dollar was not an embedded reserve currency all over the world and instead the capital flows were speculative. Whereas now the entire world is holding bonds (i.e. debt) denominated in dollars and the dollar debt financial system can’t be unwound without also the Thucydides Trap (i.e. WW3 and end of the U.S. empire). Thus it is impossible for the U.S. to experience deflation for as long as the Fed can prevent it because the entire world must eat dollars. This strong dollar vortex forces the other consumer (i.e. non-export dominant) nations to self-immolate with borrow-and-spend (so as to raise their interest rates and prop up their economies) because otherwise their currencies will collapse (i.e. those nations are on the verge of hyperinflationary wreck if their populations can not be enslaved in CBDCs, rationing and capital controls). The exporting and low consumption nations of the Non-Aligned Movement don’t want to be enslaved and dragged down by the dollar empire’s Great Reset. So they are participating (wittingly or unwittingly whatever the case is behind the curtain) in the scapegoat of an enveloping WW3 which will bifurcate the world’s financial systems to large degree, but with legacy protocol Bitcoin rising from the ashes (as the Phoenix originally promised in the 1989 Economist Magazine cover story) to be the basis of some international trade and settlement regime that (eventually) subsumes said bifurcation regime.

Debt reset is the end game for the aforementioned consumer nations. The debt reset could have potentially taken the form of Armstrong’s proposed Solution wherein bond holders received some new backing (e.g. real estate options) in exchange for taking a haircut on their holdings in the form of longer terms or whatever. But that would have wasted an excellent opportunity for a crisis to grab more power by the powers-that-be. Of course political collectives are a power vacuum that can only be captured by the most ruthless. So instead the plan appears to be that Westerners will be enslaved in a panopticon whereby they must accede to sign away all their future right to private property in exchange for debt forgiveness and to be enrolled into the rationing Carbon Credits scam scheme. In this way the powers-that-be hope to enslave all the capital and siphon it to themselves which they will then use to finance their bankster operation in the developing world as they prepare over the coming decades to complete the 666 totalitarian enslavement of the developing world also. It remains to be seen how successful their plans will be and what if anything the moribund, pitiful Western sheepeople can do to stop them.
Note
Note regarding #1 that the Fed (or actually the markets) made a mistake by lowering interest rates in the 1920s thinking that would discourage international capital from fleeing Europe to the dollar, which just caused the stock market to go parabolic because the capital still fled. As the Fed (or actually the markets) raised interest rates capital was able to flee from the stock market bubble to the bonds. Subsequently FDR was able to combat the strong dollar problem with the threat of followed by then the actual order to confiscate gold and devalue the dollar overnight as priced in gold. Thus the world was able to avoid the immediate economic and political pressures of a runaway strong dollar because the dollar was not an embedded reserve currency all over the world and instead the capital flows were speculative. Whereas now the entire world is holding bonds (i.e. debt) denominated in dollars and the dollar debt financial system can’t be unwound without also the Thucydides Trap (i.e. WW3 and end of the U.S. empire). Thus it is impossible for the U.S. to experience deflation for as long as the Fed can prevent it because the entire world must eat dollars. This strong dollar vortex forces the other consumer (i.e. non-export dominant) nations to self-immolate with borrow-and-spend (so as to raise their interest rates and prop up their economies) because otherwise their currencies will collapse (i.e. those nations are on the verge of hyperinflationary wreck if their populations can not be enslaved in CBDCs, rationing and capital controls). The exporting and low consumption nations of the Non-Aligned Movement don’t want to be enslaved and dragged down by the dollar empire’s Great Reset. So they are participating (wittingly or unwittingly whatever the case is behind the curtain) in the scapegoat of an enveloping WW3 which will bifurcate the world’s financial systems to large degree, but with legacy protocol Bitcoin rising from the ashes (as the Phoenix originally promised in the 1989 Economist Magazine cover story) to be the basis of some international trade and settlement regime that (eventually) subsumes said bifurcation regime.

Debt reset is the end game for the aforementioned consumer nations. The debt reset could have potentially taken the form of Armstrong’s proposed Solution wherein bond holders received some new backing (e.g. real estate options) in exchange for taking a haircut on their holdings in the form of longer terms or whatever. But that would have wasted an excellent opportunity for a crisis to grab more power by the powers-that-be. Of course political collectives are a power vacuum that can only be captured by the most ruthless. So instead the plan appears to be that Westerners will be enslaved in a panopticon whereby they must accede to sign away all their future right to private property in exchange for debt forgiveness and to be enrolled into the rationing Carbon Credits scam scheme. Are you picking up what I am throwing down? Are you seriously contemplating owning anything including land in the Western nations? Good luck because if the W.E.F. with their Agenda 2030 succeeds then you will not be able to hold onto that private property.

In this way the powers-that-be hope to enslave all the capital and siphon it to themselves which they will then use to finance their bankster operation in the developing world as they prepare over the coming decades to complete the 666 totalitarian enslavement of the developing world also. It remains to be seen how successful their plans will be and what if anything the moribund, pitiful Western sheepeople can do to stop them.
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


goodblackcat, I had sold after you were buying because I saw ADA was breaking down. That indicated a move back down to high 17000s was imminent. There’s still hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the VIX on the daily until above 35. Also bearish RSI divergence on the S&P on the 4 hourly. I think one more thrust down still incoming. I still think low-to-mid 3400s is likely. Bitcoin has essentially bottomed. May make one more wick down to ~17.9k. Expecting a rally to $22 – 23k, starting next week. And then a pullback to a higher low in early-to-mid November. Still possible for the dollar to spike to 116 in November. After that, rockets into end of Q1 2023. Was only a short covering rally yesterday. Not sustainable. Shorts will be reloading on the way down thus driving it down and get trapped.

snapshot
Note
Email sent to Ron Walker @ The Chart Pattern Trader…

Ron Walker the reason you can not detect that Bitcoin already bottomed is the same reason you did not see the bullish RSI divergence in June. That is you are not looking at the CME chart. Bitcoin is run by the institutional money in the futures markets, not retail spot trading. Please up your game.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


goodblackcat, hidden, bearish RSI divergence on the DJIA. Needs come down and form a higher low to create bullish, hidden RSI divergence. Which would also create a bullish W pattern bottom.

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin is near to an October bottom. June was the likely overall bottom. I can envision a rally to ~22k at the bottom of OPTICALARTdotCOM’s significant Fib ring then declining again in November to make a higher low. The decline in November might be due to a further crisis in the Euro with the dollar spiking to 116 in an bullish exhaustion capitulation.

I can’t rule out Bitcoin Dominance rising as it did in 2019, although the technical patterns seem to imply altcoins are more bullishly postured at this comparative juncture. This means you should not be entirely overweight altcoins.

1. Bitcoin could top in March or April 2023 between ~$35 – 42k. Thus a confident double or perhaps up to 2.5×. (Note I think it could make a higher high late in 2023 after a significant summer correction)

2. ADA:BTC clearly has a significant bullish inverted H&S now with the right shoulder clearly defined by this week’s drop. ADA is projecting to ~$1.20 – $2.20 by March/April and most likely $1.40 – 1.80. So a confident triple and perhaps as much as 4 – 5×. Could dip to ~0.34ish first.

3. Ditto ETH:BTC. ETH is projecting to ~$4200+. Should be a confident 3.5×, perhaps up to 4 – 5×. Could dip below $1150.

4. DOGE appears to have potentially ~2 – 8× leverage on Bitcoin. And up to ~2 – 4× leverage on Ethereum. But it’s difficult to determine what DOGE will do and when.

5. LTC is dying. It only has about ~1.4× leverage on BTC. Perhaps ~$130 – 150. At most ~$200 but I wouldn’t bank on that. SELL THIS SHITCOIN ABOVE $100. I suggested (to Finite Maz et al) to buy LTC at $4 in 2016 (and was banned from Bitcointalk.org for allegedly “shilling” LTC). It went to $350+ twice. Should have been sold as that is a M double-top projecting down to below $0.

6. Various altcoins appear to have POTENTIALLY (but not assured) ~3 – 4× leverage over BTC, such as DOT, ENJ, LINK, MANA, NEAR, SOL and VET. Perhaps ~5× for SAND. But many of the others on the prior list I don’t consider to have a reasonable risk versus reward. FTM may be the best speculative gamble alternative to DOGE with potentially ~7× on BTC. Tokens such as SuperFarm (SUPER) looks quite risky but maybe up to ~10 – 12× on BTC, especially if they get listed on a major exchange as they can currently only be obtained on a DEX such as Uniswap. SUPER is currently ~$0.12 and it peaked $4.78 in 2021.
Note
Another metric for showing the U.S. stock markets are oversold. I expect earnings reports season next week to be not as bad as everyone expected.

youtu.be/NYrLBr7FFc0?t=242 ← click for chart
(This Signal Was Triggered for the First Time Since 2020. | SP500 Collapse is Not Imminent... | Game of Traders)
Note
MUST LISTEN from the 4:30 minute juncture forward. Especially focus from 28 minutes forward. This explains also why CBDCs will be adopted by bond investors. They also explain why crypto is going to boom massively after the November 8 U.S. mid-term elections.

I listened on 1.75× speed.

youtu.be/ExrcOWdI1kQ?t=271
(“THIS Will Cause Bitcoin To SMASH $100,000..” | Kevin O’Leary | Crypto Banter)
Note
Everything has a perfected 9 count for a bottom except the dollar. Hmm. So maybe I am correct that dollar will spike to 116 in November.

youtu.be/OFqLOhZTqTQ?t=458
(Stock Market Liquidation CRASH Likely Coming Over Next 2 Weeks -S&P 500 9 Count Buy Signal Next Week | Ron Walker)
Note
I am tending to agree with Armstrong about November being a potential threat. The Demonrats are losing the mid-term elections. They may want a military distraction to draw attention away from their expected attempt to rig the elections again. If the markets rally this week as I am expecting might be the case, then perhaps November will mark the lower low?

I have to laugh though at Armstrong not realizing that China is probably the mastermind behind much of this and might also be using Putin to accomplish their goals. Remember the Chinese are playing 5D chess per Sun Tzu’s Art of War.

armstrongeconomics.com/international-news/ukraine/zelensky-still-pushing-to-start-world-war-iii/

“China will NOT stand by and allow Russia to be defeated for they know they will be next.”
Note
> “Alex was also telling people not to go to the capital building on Jan 6, saying it was a trap.”

I was also saying that! Alex Jones warned Trump he better disavow the vaccines (and his ventilators push which was used to murder patients) before he would be blamed for rushing them through the FDA with his Operation Warp Speed. And now the Demonrats are doing exactly that. Do you all not remember I was screaming that in early 2021 on ZeroHedge long before Alex Jones did.

youtu.be/VnigzbdN2JM
(Alex Jones just EXPOSED the truth about Trump and vaccines | Redacted with Clayton Morris)
Note
The bastards have pivoted from COVID medical passports to Carbon Credit tracking apps. So that is how they will lock us down is by monotonically decreasing our personal carbon credit allowance. This is one of the methods they use to apply forced rationing and artificial scarcity so that they gain power and money during the incoming Minsky Moment instead of losing it.

I wonder if they actually have the power to have authoritarian governments in the developing world come cull livestock claiming it is warming the climate? In the developed world they can easily do this by just using the corporations and chokepoints. But in the developing world individual farmers and communities might fight back violently against government thugs as they routinely do in Peru.

youtu.be/ap-pKA1mIEU
(Bill Gates just dropped MILLIONS to track every move you make | Redacted with Clayton Morris)
Note
Apologies for posting those prior updates to wrong idea.

youtube.com/watch?v=u-0BGpKBhic&lc=UgzJ_t4qWryNLHUXEJ14AaABAg.9hN3Vg0UB9h9hN6ZxUaMM3
(Comment on Bitcoin price is literally pointing to $7000 | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

> this guy called 1k at 10k in 2020 just sayin'

He has lost his f-ing mind. I don’t get that result with the BLX nor the Bitcoin index charts. I can only get two lines to converge into the future. One of the other lines marks the June bottom.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
youtu.be/j1rxmzD7C_I?t=65
(Chamath Says, Smart Money JUST started BUYING | Tesla, Nvidia, AMD, Nio Stocks - Should you buy ?)

Spot on correct. We need Apple and Microsoft earnings to disappoint after upside surprises on the most of the rest of the market. And that will be the final capitulation. Microsoft releases on Oct 25. Apple on Oct 27. Down we go for final leg into the first week of November then that is the bottom.

news.microsoft.com/2022/10/11/microsoft-announces-quarterly-earnings-release-date-53/
Note
youtu.be/dRNzKOCVlAs
(CRYPTO HOLDERS: The Real Reason The Fed May Crash Global Markets in November...)

> Interesting concept but Idk if he appreciates the various ways war escalates. Especially when economics falls off the table. His idea of using the dollar to destabilize currencies could ironicaly provoke war at the same clip if not higher 😅 finance guys sometimes have a hard time seeing the forest through the wallstreet

{…}

> I think this theory of FED policy against nuclear war has one big gap. FED policy influences mainly western countries. There is little influence on the Russian people, especially those outside cities. So who's willing to start a nuclear war? Western countries or Russia? Who is threatening nuclear weapons? Russia. Influencing us not to begin nuclear war doesn't make any sense.

Weaponizing the dollar forces the Thucydides trap. The real narrative is that the powers-that-be want to maintain control despite the arrival of a global Minsky Moment. Thus all parties need WW3 as a domestic scapegoat.
Note
My posited interpretation of the recent, insane Janet Yellen proposal, cum recent Fed leak trial balloon through the WallStreet Journal that they will communicate a slowing of interest rate hikes at the November 1–2 Fed meeting, is the powers-that-be’s realization of implausibility to surreptitiously steal the mid-term elections via vote rigging. Too many eyes now presumably focused, at least for the hundreds of contested lower House positions.

Thus further fiscal stimulus legislation DOA, necessitating an alternative diabolical means to stimulate via the executive (e.g. the Treasury department) in defiance of the will of the American voting public for respite from the MMT which is (especially when combined with their intentional destruction of the supply chains with their fabricated faux pLandemic and stoking Ukrainian war towards WW3).

Note Yellen’s “Operation Twist” proposal implies they intend to levitate short-term interest rates in 2023 (with increased issuance) while reducing long-term interest rates (with buybacks deploying funds raised from said increased issuance), thus further exacerbating the yield curve recession signal.

The markets ostensibly are sensing this and a surge up in the risk-on stock (and perhaps also monetary alternatives such as Bitcoin and gold) markets could be possible this week front running the outcome of the election. Which would also agree with the two week lag correlation for the S&P to the recently discussed Net Liquidity epiphany. Even Martin Armstrong privately blogged yesterday finally admitting to my stance that his early November Panic Cycles could possibly be to the upside if the DJIA can clear resistance ~3250 ­– 3284.

Yet I am thinking that Ron Walker’s point about a Dow Theory divergence (transports making a lower high on this bounce while industrials made a higher high) is signally another pullback in November before continuing higher. Not clear if that will be a lower low for the S&P and/or a higher-low for the DJIA. The Fed could rug pull on that said leak.

There is a real risk that Bitcoin could surge to $22+k this week. Even $25+k later in November or early December.

Armstrong is correct to point out that the U.K. and Europe will be disemboweled by the aforementioned premeditated, intentional resultant (concomitant) stoking of inflation via the wealth effect and stimulation of more debt given the abatement of the 10Y Treasury interest rate (via said buy backs) would exacerbate demand driven aspect of inflation simultaneous with presumably ongoing, intentional escalation of supply chains destruction.

Armstrong should abandon his naive belief that the politicians are inadvertently societalciding us because they’re idiots with short-time preference only to save their own skin. Applicable perhaps to many politicians, but powers behind the (deeper) curtain exquisitely premeditated this very intentionally to transition to a 666-like NWO. They’re not failing. Armstrong is simply naive, myopic and wrong. TPTB know exactly what they’re destructively constructing — to fragment our world into thousands of political jurisdictions subservient to regional blocs (each managed akin to an unelected EU Commission) overall servile to a global institutions rising as the 1989 Economist Magazine’s Phoenix Bitcoin as the only unaligned, international reserve monetary asset (reset) in the intentionally crafted multi-polar world they’ve achieved masterfully.

I emailed Martin years prior positing the E.U. and Euro were intentionally crafted in their defunct manner, intentionally structured to fail in a path that ushers in said dystopian NWO — a premeditation in the works for decades prior now bearing fruit.

Biblical Proverbs 22:7“the borrower is slave to the lender.” Ditto 1 Samuel 8 those who embrace statism are enslaved by it.

Lurch into a dystopian world underway with the indebted sheepeople to be fully enslaved in 666 debt forgiveness in exchange for, “you will own nothing, rent everything, and be happy.”

Methinks Armstrong protest too much.

My other postulate is that MMT is just my oft-reiterated model of the process that only the most ruthless can capture power vacuums. The ability to create money out-of-thin-air (something only Bitcoin can resist, because gold is no longer viable in an Internet connected era) is a power vacuum which those who intend to hold onto such power must absolutely deploy said centralized power in the most ruthless and diabolical means possible. If they do not they will be deposed by those who will derive more power from doing so. This is why Armstrong’s oft-reiterated, naive delusion that the Fed is independent (behind the curtain) has to be utter nonsense.

Thus game theory is such that who ever wished to uphold a fiat system has no choice but to eventually strive for the Biblical Revelation end game. This is the Great Harlot system. They have no choice but to devise diabolical plans to maximize the power that they control.

The inability of humanity to admit to themselves the inviolable invariants of power vacuums and power-law distribution of fungible resources is an ineptitude of epic implications and a stumbling block of our collective iniquity.

Wish you all the fortitude and clarity of mind that your carefully, meticulously contemplated actions reflect your understanding.

(can anyone discern that I am on caffeine tonight?)
Note
DJIA has already hidden, bearish RSI divergence on time frames up to weekly chart. It could head a bit higher, but not likely to surmount the ~3250 critical level to remain bullish after this week.

Whereas the S&P doesn’t have such bearish divergences yet. Thus I posit the S&P will surge this week to 3910 – 4000, possibly even 4100.

All these markets including Bitcoin have bullish, RSI divergences on all time frames including the weekly and monthly. Thus lower-lows in November are not required, but remain possible with a final drive of said bullish divergence. Although higher lows with a hidden, bullish forming on the daily chart with a November pullback is also possible.

The 2Y Treasury appears to have topped, as it already had bearish RSI divergence on the weekly and the recent surge formed it again on the daily after it had lost it on the daily with the surge in September.

Thus it is only the DXY (i.e. dollar) that is still potentially lacking a bearish RSI divergence. So I could envision a final surge for the dollar to ~116.4 (or intra-day spike slightly higher) in November to form that bearish RSI on the daily chart. But with the 2Y not confirming a higher high and thus marking the end of this risk-off period we have been in since November 2021.
Note
Ron Walker pointed out the possibility of a bullish, inverted H & S pattern forming on the S&P with A-B-C Elliot Wave structures in play and a five wave count rebound nearly complete now with the right shoulder still to form. This seems to make a lot of sense. If Apple and Microsoft earnings disappoint later this week then a pullback into first week of November before liftoff. I also identified that Crab harmonic pattern which indicates the S&P bottom has completed and is projecting up to 5000. Ron Walker (on his The Crypto Trader) account continues to claim that Bitcoin does not have bullish RSI divergence w.r.t. its June low even though I emailed him last week and reminded him for the second time that Bitcoin CME had a bullish RSI divergence in June and again recently also making a lower low than June. Institutions are now more in control of Bitcoin and they can only use the futures market for now due to regulatory structure. Also remember Kevin O’Leary’s point that the new crypto regulation may finally pass the Congress after the mid-terms which would portend a flood of institutional money buying Bitcoin.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin must be above 29K on December 31. It must be.

Do you need a better guarantee than that to buy soon?

youtu.be/3dFn2ikCU1A
(WARNING: BITCOIN FIRST EVER RIGHT NOW | Crypto Crew University)
Note
Potential inverted H&S still in play if S&P does not move any higher, so would come back down for the right shoulder:

snapshot
Note
Appears the S&P topped out at 3885. Back down we go to form the right shoulder of that previously posited bullish, inverted H&S pattern:

youtu.be/s6N3PWeaMP0
(Manipulation Sucks Traders Into Deadly Trap to Dump on Them | Money Time Machine)
Note
VIX hit my target and now have the hidden, bullish RSI divergence I was anticipating.

snapshot
Note
I am shocked how much household wealth there still is in the U.S.A.. And that it has been deleveraging since the 2008 G.F.C..

Imagine all that coming into crypto as the sovereign debt crisis accelerates.

youtu.be/axovMWn0gTg?t=587 ← click for the chart
(The Moment We’ve All Been Waiting For: Massive SP500 Dead Cat Bounce or a V-Shaped Recovery? | Game of Trades)
Note
Six-day death cross implying a final flash crash for Bitcoin.

youtu.be/HT5zxdpK2V0
(NEW MEGA DEATH CROSS Quickly Approaches Bitcoin | Crypto Crew U.)
Note
fred.stlouisfed.org/series/RRPONTSYD

RRPOs back down again.

My guess is a slight pullback into end of the month this week and weekend, as was the case in late July, then up higher perhaps 4100 on S&P. Markets might be spooked again a bit on Friday with the PCE inflation data and also GDP tomorrow might be strong thus scaring market that Fed might not pivot:

marketwatch.com/economy-politics/calendar
Note
Alternative EW count possibility.

snapshot
Note
Bingo!

youtu.be/S08NYpjtOp4
(The SP500 is About to CRUSH Investors: How The SP500 Bear Market Run Will Fail Or Succeed. | Game of Trades)
Note
ABSOLUTE MUST WATCH: Bitcoin could rally to ~$25+k, then crash back down to 17k before the real bull market ensues. Also I am interpreting it as a possible rally now to ~$26.5+k before crashing back down to 17k.

youtu.be/cL_riGaFG_s
(Bitcoin FLASHES BLOOD ORANGE On Super Guppy – DO THIS NOW! | Crypto Crew University)
Note
Big move incoming. Concurs with my expectations on all points.

youtu.be/RFb1RGxZ3bU
(Bitcoin FOMO Is Back For Price | E.K.C.)
Note
Remember I wrote a couple of weeks back that the crash for the FANG Big Tech stocks would mark the final capitulation. They were the last stragglers that had resisted capitulation.

youtu.be/42B6Pejo2Vw
(Market Internals Are Imploding Behind This Rally Facade | Money Time Machine)

This is the bullish final capitulation of FANG Big tech. The rising 10Y to Nasdaq ratio marks the bottom not the start of a crash.
Note
Fed panic pivot?

youtu.be/HbS21by5KK0
(The Treasury Markets About To Seize Up | Mark Moss)
Note
youtu.be/ZfG0cq17yTs
(Bitcoin About To Have LARGEST MOVE OF YEAR | Crypto Crew University)
Note
Here comes the next FOMO bubble and Elon will help kickstart it, e.g. Twitter Tiles will be a new feature to preview NFT images in tweets:

youtu.be/96-gNzVU8Ug?t=227
(CRYPTO is about to EXPLODE! (HERE is WHY) | Altcoin Daily)

This is why I say that nobody is focused on the fact that all the shit they are creating ends up centralized and controlled by government regulation. They are too busy chasing FOMO money.
Note
1. Based on following linked video, clearly ETH is going to pullback to ~$1400 this week, then rally to $2400 – 2600 over the next one to three months. I think it could be more accelerated than Steve thinks perhaps by late December.

2. Game of Trades’ demonstrated that S&P has a bullish divergence w.r.t. to junk bonds unlike in August, thus likely to push up through resistance this time and establish that the bottom is behind us.

3. Eric Krown Crypto’s statistical oscillator analysis is pointing to at least a 30 – 40% rally for BTC. I suspect BTC will also pullback below 20k this week first.

4. ETH has raced out ahead based on Fib retracement levels from the ATH and the neckline of the topping patterns from 2021. Perhaps other cryptos are going to catch up? For example, if ETH hits $2500, then ADA and LTC should rally somewhere $1.33 – 1.43 and $130 – 170. The ADA:BTC chart indicates BTC should rally to $35 – 38k then which would be Bitcoin’s said neckline.

5. Armstrong’s DJIA monthly forecast array has inflection points in January and April with May as a Panic Cycle. It seems there could be some turbulence and perhaps a significant pullback in January, then perhaps another rally to April, then summer correction with a rally into the end of 2023 and perhaps peaking in Q1 2024.

youtu.be/HDrNOnpizFM
(ETH About To SHOCK THE WORLD | Crypto Crew University)
Note
Loaded the LTC chart and was shocked to see I had predicted the nearly exact price of the 2021 top, ostensibly back in the Fall of 2020:

snapshot
Note
The Bitcoin Accumulation/Distribution indicator did not bottom in October as hoped. Thus any crypto rally might coming back down again as I previously mentioned the possibility of a retest of the lows again (or at least very significant pullback) perhaps in January perhaps after a potential significant rally first. However this could simply mean the indicator will turn up in December indicating a bottom as of November.

youtu.be/KS4SeBXW83k?t=322
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/mgglkQk3CPg
(BITCOIN JUST FLASHED BLOOD RED | Crypto Crew University)

Steve but per your recent Ethereum video, ETH thus far is matching the fractal from the 2019 period. Thus maybe Bitcoin’s bottoming process will be some combination of the 2015 and 2019? Maybe a rally now up to the neckline of the prior double-top ~35 - 37k which is approximately your middle line on the Gaussian channel. Then second retest of the low or thereabouts after 120 days and before the rise back up to the top ~50k or even above the Gaussian channel a year out from now.
Note
Bitcoin’s volume has bullish divergence since September. Shifted from distribution to accumulation.

youtu.be/4ToK9GqeZwo?t=840
(BITCOIN URGENT UPDATE: This Changes Everything! Here's What The Smart Money BTC Traders Are Doing | The Crypto Trader Ron Walker)
Note
Binance trying to destroy SBF and his FTX because he has been lobbying for strict crypto regulation?

Those who have piled in short are probably going to cause a short squeeze first.

youtu.be/SFaLKStdFqc?t=1195
(URGENT: CZ Binance vs SBF (FTX)! Can FTX Survive? | Crypto Banter)

youtube.com/watch?v=S-mBlgjR_M0
(*THIS* will 100% CRASH the CRYPTO MARKET!!! 🚨 🐳 | Altcoin Daily)

youtu.be/yC7rTJ7lDU0
(Could FTX News Cause A MASSIVE Crypto Market Sell-Off? | Crypto Banter)
Note
Amazing how my trend lines have been resistance or support all the way down.

Leads me to believe coming down to 13.9k at the thick yellow line.

snapshot
Note
For those who forgot what that thick brownish-yellow line is. And not the “4?” I had on my chart since last summer! I have always said that we were in a terminal Elliot Wave condition, meaning wave 4 must retrace below top of wave 1 which was 13.9k.

snapshot
Note
I am not giving up on crypto. We always knew that wave 4 was going to be a bitch. But wave 5 should take Bitcoin back up ~410% thus a triple top at 64K in 2023. And that will be the kiss of death for the subsequent ANYONECANSPEND Nash equilibrium restoration event aka “attack,” although there is a possibility of a decline into summer 2023 and then another final peak in late 2023 or early 2024 before the flash crash which I expect will probably be some launch of nuclear WW3.

Hang in there guys! I will also be launching my altcoin 2023.
Note
ETH has nearly hit the Bat pattern target I had mentioned a few weeks ago. Looks like the bottom will be ~$1000. Some bounce underway now probably with the inflation report today:

snapshot
Note
Note the S&P chart I had annotated weeks and months ago. Clearly the S&P already bottomed and the harmonic Shark pattern is projected to 4700 – 5000. Note harmonic patterns (including the Bat in my prior message) do not tell us when, they only tell us the price levels.

Note the ominous repeating fractal on this chart, which is highlighted with the similarly shaded semi-opaque boxes.

snapshot
Note
So the bullish Bat pattern on ETH should be a reversal with the first target ~$1700 – 2000 and the second target ~$2450 – 2900. There are clearly overhead resistance trend lines on my chart at those two levels. Those will correspond structurally to overhead resistance in the $28 – 35k level for Bitcoin. Perhaps a massive rebound in December and then a pullback in January.
Note
Bitcoin has already hit the first statistical target (CME being ~$700 lower than spot). So next downside targets at the 13.9k and ~$11 – 12k levels but that would likely be later in the month, perhaps after a bounce.

We are putting in a macro bottom here in November. Question is how low does Bitcoin go? My bet is just below 13.9k will be the macro bottom.

youtu.be/NgZr5ovEn5A?t=104
(The Bitcoin crash is insane | E.K.C.)
Note
This is well done by Charles:

youtu.be/KRewC7OajeY
(FTX and the Integrity of the Cryptocurrency Markets | Charles Hoskinson)

Altcoin Daily looked into the potential contagion:

youtu.be/bRq1iKsc1Ok
(WORST Crypto News Ever | FTX CONTAGION Will Destroy Market (Binance BACKS OUT) | Altcoin Daily)
Note
You have to sell some portion into the crypto bounces. Bottom is not likely in yet.

snapshot
Note
Need to sell ETH here. Going back down to ~1K before the bottom is in.

snapshot
Note
BTC likely to push up to $18.1 – 18.9k:

snapshot

We need to be really wary that the dollar is going to free-fall. An intense rally is ahead, but the crypto crashing might not be quite done yet if the contagion around FTX has not hit max pain yet. The dollar could still rally back up to test former support which has become overhead resistance.

snapshot
Note
Second wave down for this bottom could be triggered by miner capitulation:

Bitcoin miners ‘next trigger’ for BTC price crash as outflows hit multi-month highs
Note
Dollar could rally for some hours perhaps even back to 109.5 to back test before a more precipitous lower low.

snapshot

But on higher TFs the dollar looks weak and potentially headed down to 103. But there’s already bullish RSI divergence so at any time the dollar could surge (not due to CPI or Fed surprises but) because of Eurodollar debt markets breaking in Europe.

snapshot

So maybe crypto pulls back a bit more (e.g. ~16.9k BTC and $1200 ETH) before heading higher.

S&P looking bullish with even its 21 WMA starting to turn up! Be careful the crypto bottom could already be behind us. Reload and ride up for a while.

snapshot

VIX could drop to 20.6:

snapshot
Note
Q Anon wrote:

> On a side note, didn’t intend for you to encourage anyone to do options trading… most people get rekt.
>
> I haven’t been successful at all with it. Lost it all everytime I’ve done it since it’s all or nothing… I just have some degenerate tendencies and felt it was worth the risk… all I have to do is be right once for an incredible windfall
>
> In the back of my mind, I feel like all the exchanges secretly have teams trading against their users… it’s why almost every month, we see massive liquidations in the options market
>
> That said, find it hard to believe bitcoin will stay below 50k for all of 2023


Indeed it is very difficult because if you have correct convictions, one can still lose by becoming greedy and falling victim to timing.

Perhaps the only way to be successful is to make the decision that is least likely to be the decision anyone else makes. For example if you entered at the height of the crash the prior day, that could end up being prescient. Those who wait for 11k Bitcoin would be one group of people that is holding out for the sure thing. And those who enter at higher prices can get stopped out by their fears as Bitcoin gyrates to find a bottom.

The odds of hitting the perfect homerun decrease the greater the expectation.

I think the point you were making is that you would not be tempted to go into leverage unless Bitcoin declines so severely that it would be a no brainer. Were you prepared to do that when Bitcoin dropped to 3k in 2018 or 4K in 2020? Or was it so unexpected that you were unprepared?

Anyway, the only suggestion I made was to risk maybe $800 for the chance to get 20k. To bet maybe 2 – 5% of one’s porfolio for the chance to maybe hit a ~20 times homerun.

One should view it as gambling.

I think we are going to get chewed up by volatility. S&P could race up to 4300 with Bitcoin and ETH racing up to 32k and $2900, and then another severe decline perhaps in January or May, perhaps not to a lower low.

Speculation is a razor’s edge. Much better to hodl except to take profits during higher overbought, reacquire on highly oversold and instead apply time consuming efforts to work which can generate significant income or project growth.

Actually a society that turns into speculators is an unproductive society that will collapse. I was actually thinking this thought a couple of hours ago myself, before you raised the issue.
Note
Guy @ Coin Bureau provides an excellent analysis of the FTX debacle:

youtu.be/WgJbWZpRWyo
(FTX Insolvent?! Craziest Week in Crypto EVER!! The Latest!! | Coin Bureau)

Essentially too much leverage against an illiquid token FTT as collateral. Let this be a lesson to myself when designing an algorithmic stablecoin (e.g. Rico bank) that the collateral requirements must be modulated by measures of market liquidity.

Alameda was such a pervasive market maker on crypto exchanges that we could see liquidity massively reduced and wilder swings in prices.

Also (as admitted by Sam B-F) Alameda will be trying to raise liquidity this week. Ultimately they are probably going to be forced to dumb more of their shitcoin holdings.
Note
Nasdaq is looking very bullish. Bullish W pattern projecting +10%, although overhead resistance at the 21 WMA and a slight potential bearish RSI divergence on daily which might need a pullback first. Although bullish RSI divergence on daily and weekly as well. Given the Shark pattern indicates the S&P has bottomed, assume ditto Nasdaq.

snapshot

snapshot

S&P on the verge of inverted H&S breakout, although potentially nearly fulfilling first projection thus potentially a pullback first.

snapshot

Dollar can fall more on daily and weekly, but 4 hourly is hinting of a rally.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
The tokens affected by the FTX collapse are being frozen, so selling pressure abated while Alameda liquidity provider gone? Thus a massive reversal is plausible? Climbing the wall-of-worry and shock now? Crypto looks to me like it wants to (possibly only a meager) rally again today.

The Bat pattern indicates ETH’s pullback already bottomed or could double bottom (or slightly lower low). As I mentioned previously the next levels up are ~$1700 – 2100. Then ~$2400 – 2900. The 21 WMA is turning up!

snapshot

snapshot

Bitcoin may have already bottomed. But it has a lot more work to do as its 21 WMA is still heading down. I can’t visualize Bitcoin surpassing 25.3k if ETH hits $2100. I doubt Bitcoin corrects lower than 13.5k in worst case.

snapshot
Note
Ron Walker correctly points out that the DJIA is overbought and likely near a top. Also a bearish divergence with junk bonds. When the DJIA correct down, it is likely to coincide with all stocks and crypto moving down as well. He also mentions options expiry next week. Remember he called for the Bitcoin crash from 20.4k before anybody was worried about FTX.

Ron admits S&P and Nasdaq could move higher first.

My possible disagreement though is his conviction that although the DJIA will make a higher low, that the S&P and Nasdaq will make lower lows. That conflicts with my Shark pattern that indicates S&P already bottomed (although it could double bottom again except my T/A says no and lowest is to come back down to ~3760 to back fill yesterday’s gap up). Ron cites (38:30) for example a lack of bullish divergence between the S&P and growth. But growth made a lower low when the S&P double bottomed, thus forming a hidden bullish divergence. Ron wants growth to lead but what if the DJIA is leading as Armstrong said. Again Ron cites lack of a divergence between the Nasdaq and DJIA at the recent bottom. But Nasdaq made a (significantly) lower low and DJIA did not on a daily closing basis.

If the Nasdaq rallies much more than the DJIA today then it could possible only back fill to the neckline of its W pattern when the DJIA pulls back possibly next week. Crypto may also pullback when the DJIA does, but maybe not to a lower low.

youtu.be/tpWkim2doo0
(Stock Market CRASH: BULL TRAP! The Dumb Money Is Buying The Rally! Not The Smart Money (SPX QQQ) | Ron Walker)
Note
snapshot

If Bitcoin CME closes below 16.9k in less than 2 hours from now, the 5 day indicator is suggesting that Bitcoin will drop below 14K:

youtu.be/qmhVNxC2qnc?t=590
(Bitcoin Price Bounced.. But Is It Over Yet? | E.K.C.)
Note
I would sell now and wait. Maybe one more thrust higher next week first.

youtu.be/8EcRQX-qQJA?t=978
(Evidence Of A Bitcoin Bottom! It's Not Over But BTC Is Showing Signs Of Forming A Liquidation Bottom | The Crypto Trader)
Note
Allegations that SEC Commissioner Gary Gensler was corrupted and involved with the FTX debacle.

youtu.be/-M4V5q3hbyc?t=193
(WTF?!!! BITCOIN: FROM BAD… TO WORSE?!!! FTX CRYPTO CONTAGION CONTINUES!!! | Crypto Zombie)

Although the selling of FTX tokens will be abated by the bankruptcy filing, the counter parties are now illiquid. This can result in an extreme capitulation low for Bitcoin. Be careful here. Wait for the other shoe to drop and for distribution to complete and accumulation to gain the upper hand. I do not perceive we are there yet.
Note
Nasdaq has also Shark pattern bottomed as I predicted it would on Oct 9.

snapshot
Note
Holy crap. Why did I not see this before! Bitcoin has a Shark pattern projecting down to 5.9k! The pattern does not tell you when that price will be hit. So as was the case for the Bat pattern for ETH, the price can rally back up first but not higher than point C. Thus Bitcoin can still rally before hitting 5.8k, but not higher than ~64k. Thus according to Steve @ Crypto Crew U.’s repeating 5.2 times pattern off the bottom, this indicates that Bitcoin must decline now below 13K, before rallying back up. If back fill that CME gap 9.6k, then Bitcoin will only rally to ~50k in 2023 before crashing ultimately to 5.8k (possibly the posited ANYONECANSPEND attack in 2024).

This seems to be indicating that the crash will be worse on Bitcoin than Ethereum as I have a Bat pattern ETH that says the low will be ~1k.

snapshot
Note
Also note that Shark patter projects from 5.8k down to as low as below zero. So it seems that will be the posited ANYONECANSPEND attack. The legacy Bitcoin will drop to 5.8k but the impostor Bitcoin Core will death spiral. Ah it all fits together now. The chart was telling us everything.

snapshot
Note
Okay ETH has that same egregiously bearish Shark pattern and it is worse because there is no price target above $0. So this is so interesting because it jives with the fact that there is no legacy ETH that is to survive which has not already forked off. And the Bat pattern projection for the incoming low for the rally into 2023 is 1K even I move C to the recent rally $1700 (although does not fit a Bat pattern correctly).

So we can watch ETH to tell us when BTC has bottomed. When ETH drops again and tags 1K (or even a wick lower), then we should be looking for a BTC bottom. Strange that BTC might drop much more lower than ETH will. BTC is making lower lows while ETH is making higher lows. ETH will be much stronger into 2023 but this Shark pattern says ETH will not make a new ATH in 2023. Eyeing the 4K level.

Not an exact Bat pattern so ETH could head lower perhaps $950.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

Another very interesting insight that ETH can help us time the incoming bottom. Note that ETH:BTC bottom at the time of this dashed line on the BTC chart at 0.066 which per my analysis of the ETH:BTC chart is the likely absolute low. By the time BTC bottomed, ETH:BTC was 0.069. If this repeats and ETH bottoms $950, then BTC will bottom 13.7k assuming ETH has not risen in price when BTC bottoms. If ETH:BTC makes a lower low then BTC could be lower unless again if ETH price has bottomed and move higher by the time BTC bottoms.

So in other words if the Bat target is correct for ETH, the start buying crypto when ETH hits ~1K or maybe a wick lower.

snapshot
Note
Litecoin has a Butterfly instead of a Shark pattern and it projects also below zero with no alternative price above $0. Thus it appears that even legacy LTC will not survive?

snapshot
Note
Amazingly Cardanao (ADA) does not have this death spiral technical pattern. Appears it will rally significantly in 2023 but the crash will be a major wave 4 thus not going below 2 cents in any case.

Perhaps more importantly this indicates that the death spiral for BTC, ETH and LTC will not be until after ADA rallies for minor wave 5 to complete major wave 3. Yet another confirmation that crypto will bottom soon and rally significantly into 2023.

snapshot
Note
Remember this chart I shared some weeks ago, where I was projecting a possible repeat of 2018, with a final drop into the $13 – 15.3k level?

Note the spike in volume already occurred. Compare to 2018. Thus most likely there will only be 3 more weeks to capitulation bottom not lower than 13k. Probably to bounce this coming week a bit higher first.

snapshot
Note
Look they are crashing Bitcoin with exchange failures so they can pass the new crypto legislation in the USA which will enable institutions to buy and hold it. Bitcoin will catapult back up in 2023, then they fleece all the institutions with the ANYONECANSPEND attack. All going according to the diabolical plan.
Note
7:45 The FTX debacle was a scam to steal money from conservatives to help elect Demonrats 😱🤬:

youtu.be/bY65AnZuX_A?t=503
(The FTX Crypto Scandal Just Got Much WEIRDER…)
Note
Another false breakout to the upside from a bearish triangle incoming as was the case for the crash from 21.5k on Nov 22?

13.5k incoming low? Might bounce as high as 17.5k. I am expecting the S&P to make one more thrust higher next week.

snapshot
Note
My EW count expectation for S&P and 4900 by Q1 2023:

snapshot
Note
armstrongeconomics.com/international-news/ukraine/the-west-must-abandon-ukraine-force-peace/

> “it turns out that FTX was funding the anti-Ivermectin studies that were fake all to exaggerate COVID and destroy our economy.”
Note
Armstrong is simply wrong about a bear market into Q1 2023:

youtu.be/T3Ry08sB9gc
(Why This is Not a Bear Market Rally. | A Massive SP500 Move is Coming as Shorts Get Squeezed | Game of Trades)
Note
Ron Walker is emphasizing what he thinks is a symmetric triangle (pennant) continuation pattern, which he thinks projects to the $9 – 10k level. He is also talking possibly $7 – 8k. May bounce from ~14K and still possible that could be the bottom.

snapshot

youtu.be/PgFnRgke9eo
(A Bitcoin Reality Check Is Coming - BTC CRASH Now In Progress As Correctly Predicted! Check Mate!!!)

My comment is be wary of a rally this week first before the next leg down.

youtu.be/L62HH4roEbA
(BULL TRAP WARNING - Options Expiration May Create The Illusion That The FAKE FED PIVOT RALLY Is Real)
Note
Dollar is forming an inverse H&S bottom. Markets are preparing to dump again. Bitcoin might bottom in December. An 85 – 86% correction would be 10k.

youtu.be/8ap-PGabBB4?t=578
(Wall Street Is Loading Up On These {defensive} Stocks... NOT GOOD! {SP500, QQQ, TSLA, BITCOIN})
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=vfE7UFDceqI&lc=Ugwd_EEFCmk9xCLOtQl4AaABAg.9e4rywL7n6Z9ibPGDM8WAi

> > HEX is a scam because those who staked for 15 years, meaning they can’t even cash out with a 50% penalty for 7.5 years, will likely never get any of their original investment back out of HEX. And HEX was intentionally designed to take advantage of the forgetfulness of humans in that they lose all their investment if they are busy and don’t unstake in a very small two week time window after expiration (and not before expiration because they incurs a 50 – 100% penalty). HEX is also a scam because the origin address received “sacrificed” crypto tokens exchanged for HEX thus obviously an ICO that violates the Howey test for U.S. Securities laws and which probably enabled the insiders to buy HEX from themselves, thus entirely centralizing the token supply and pump-a-mentally creating an illusion of a high market cap and illusion of popular adoption.

> > Here is the follow-up… Which means all penalties are awarded to the insiders. HEX is also a scam because it is promoted as (by implication) equating FDIC insured Certificate of Deposits with an uninsured technology (proof-of-stake) which is going to crash and burn because every proof-of-stake system is entirely centralized and governments can and will be able to crack down on them. Every ICO (including Ethereum) has been insiders buying the ICO from themselves centralizing the token supply. Why do you think Ethereum had sky high gas fees when the oligarchy of mining can compute the smart contracts only once instead of duplicating the computation for the illusion of decentralized miners? Obviously for the oligarchy in control to centralize the token supply. And the power-law distribution of fungible resources in an inviolable invariant in our Universe. Notwithstanding Richard’s condescending, juvenile memes to impress other naive juveniles, who but those inebriated on Richard’s Koolaid are making a fool out of themselves?

> “S. Moore I made more money than you dream of with this scam. lol now imagine for a second, if BTC original owners were FORCED to keep their coins for 8 years without touching them. would have been horrible for them, wouldnt it? so shush and just stake for a year if youre a sissy. also FYI not even 10% of the tokens are staked... this is accessible to anyone who has eyeballs. meaning anyone can stake lets say 30% of their bag and keep 70% fluid. so just shush man, there is so much you dont know its embarrassing. keep holding FTX and ADA-”

@Pulsin'Hexican that is presumptuous of you to assume I don’t know. But what you might not know if that Richard and his insiders were selling the ICO to themselves. Thus your claim of only 10% being staked is BS from the standpoint of the percent of tokens actually held by any fool who is not on the inside. The sheepeople are going to get reamed. It is always that, just FTX in a different flavor and timeline. Don’t attempt to talk down to me, as I have been in this cryptocosm since 2013. I know much more than you realize I know. Stay tuned, you will be hearing my name in the future.
Note
I might accumulate some ~16k. Waiting for a bullish RSI divergence. I think a bounce this week. Everyone is bearish.

snapshot

Although funding rate is not clearly bearish so need to be cautious:

coinglass.com/FundingRate
Note
Potential bullish RSI divergence for ETH on the 2 hour. Also hidden, bullish on the 1 hour. No bullish divergence on the 4 hourly. So I am just nibbling here. Could be enough for a bounce this week, or maybe heading lower than $1070 to form bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly, daily and weekly (which coming eventually even if bounces first).

snapshot
Note
Added a thin red trend line to that prospective symmetric wedge pennant:

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin has bullish RSI divergence on the 30 min chart, hidden bullish RSI divergence on the 30 and 45 minute. And potentially bullish RSI divergence on the 4 hourly if there is a massive bullish reversal in price within the next 2 hours. When BTC does make a lower-low it will very likely form bullish RSI divergence on the daily. As I said, the question is whether the markets are going to have final leg up this week before the significant pullback (lower lows for crypto but not likely for the stock markets) — I think so.
Note
ADA, FTM and DOGE all have potential bullish RSI divergences even on time frames as high as the daily for DOGE for example. On the weekly it appears DOGE could eventually drop below $0.55 again to form a bullish RSI divergence. Whereas on the weekly ADA and FTM appears to be close to a bottom. However there is already hidden bullish RSI divergence for those latter two on the weekly, so there is not necessarily any limit to how much further they could drop.

In summary, I can not rule out an immediate drop of BTC to say ~15k and ETH ~$950, although there could be bounce first this week. And I can’t rule out (from ETH:BTC chart to drop 0.61 – 0.67) that instead ~13.9k and ~$950 when it finally comes. Again possibly a bounce first.

The ADA:BTC chart looks very weak maybe to drop to 0.000016 – 0.000017. So this is implying a price of ~$0.22 – 0.26 if BTC drops to $13.5 – 15k.

The ADA:USD chart has a bullish declining wedge going back to the 2021 peak which concurs!

snapshot
Note
Watch this so you will not why the markets will bottom on the next selloff and rally significantly into 2023.

youtu.be/moSClASbnyc?t=967
(The Stock Market Is Hoping For A Fed Pivot - Historically A Fed Pivot Triggers A Much Bigger CRASH | Ron Walker)
Note
Q Nonymous, {11/21/22 10:56 PM}
My insiders in manufacturing saying the same thing (recession not til late 2023, early 2024, with no prediction on how long it will last) …looks like this will likely be the first time where the halving doesn’t get priced into the market

shelby3 ⏱🌐🧖, {11/21/22 10:58 PM}
Oh I think the halving effect will be the same. Bitcoin will bottom in the next week or two, then rally with the stock market, then crash to a double bottom (or lower low) right before the halving. That has been the pattern every time. Right on schedule plus-or-minus a couple of weeks.

Measure to 2018 and 2015.
Note
As I predicted looks like a bit more upside before the crash coming. OPTICALARTdotCOM has 16.5k as the first stop, then $17+k and the highest would be 18.1k but probably will not make it up there. He still thinks $7 – 9k by February. E.K.C. is thinking more in the mid-to-high 13K by first or second week of December.

snapshot

VIX falling into a SLINGSHOT bottom?

snapshot

As I had predicted back on November 4 as evident by the green and red arrow tipped lines.

snapshot
Note
This is worth expending 5 minutes to watch on double-speed:

youtu.be/_dVK--CXbIU
(This Is Going to Trigger a Massive Top on the SP500. | Volatility is Trending Higher. | Game of Trades)
Note
Carl the Moon is spot on correct here. Now is the time to grind on the altcoin to prepare for 2025 bull market. And we should get a rally on crypto into 2023 probably ~40k. There will be that repeat of the March 2020 crash in Q1 2024 right before the halving.

youtu.be/Sehc6swlMwY
(Bitcoin Next ATH & Next Cycle Top WHEN? (Price Prediction) | Altcoin Daily)
Note
Thread for TLDR
twitter.com/1MarkMoss/status/1597245271301394432

youtube.com/watch?v=jpLOnLIGTy4&lc=UgyjcIn31GNILKuJR9J4AaABAg
(Why Crypto Won’t See Another Bull Market - Its Changed | Mark Moss)

The government is corrupt and does not exist to protect anyone but themselves and their cronies. Very unlikely that the SEC will declare for example Ethereum a security. Are they going to walk away from their gravvy train willingly? I do not think so. The death of the crypto pump & dump will be when there's no more greater fools to be had. Have we reached that point already?
Note
Okay here comes the pump for BItcoin I was expecting. Get ready to go short.

snapshot
Note
The incoming oil pricing war with Russia to start Dec 5 along with the potential railroad strike in the U.S., along with Biden to refill strategic petroleum reserves might be trigger for one more scare in the markets? Also Ben Cowen presents more charts (social media activity is not yet indicating the bottom) indicating that crypto likely has another leg down. Even Crypto Crew U. is now admitting 13.7k is likely.

youtu.be/HgBPrGzs-g4?t=918
Note
Cowan compares the current crypto crash to the Nasdaq Dot.Com crash and makes some very strong points. Total crypto market cap to decline another 20% in December, bottom, rally 60%, then another leg down for the final bottom later in 2023. Perfectly jibes with my analyses and expectations.

youtube.com/watch?v=9ixJXwBT_HM&lc=Ugw7KqXjl6a6CQv7hoN4AaABAg
(Worst Case Scenario for Bitcoin & Ethereum (I'M SCARED)!!! | Altcoin Daily)

Ben(jamin) Cowan is killing it lately. Seen him on Coin Bureau as well. A reputable circle of vloggers in the cryptocosm taking form. Keep up the good work.
Note
youtu.be/VJk-jOjs2qg
(Stock Market CRASH Signals Warning This Is A BULL TRAP - An Opportunity For The Bears Not The Bulls | Ron Walker)

Another sell-off for sure incoming. Remember the prior inflation data was lower because of health care adjustments which won't be present in the incoming PCE report.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=nUpYe_lkszI&lc=UgzPDyeiGKne3aGhuKZ4AaABAg
(Bad News: New MEGA DEATH CROSS Coming | Crypto Crew U.)

Steve this is Shelby from email. Now you are identifying the coming "anyone can spend" attack I was warning you about. There will be massive false breakout on the volatility when the recession hits and Bitcoin Core will be destroyed. False moves are common when so close to the apex of a triangle formation. Only those hodling in legacy addresses will keep their BTC and the rest will be donated to the legacy protocol miners. Subsequently the volatility will crash very low and remain there as the legacy Bitcoin rises as the 1989 Economist Magazine's Phoenix NWO global currency to replace the dollar and yuan in a multipolar world taking shape with the intentional, premediated WW3 underway . This was all planned out decades in advance.(Btw, I am in Thailand now brother)
Note
youtu.be/4O1kZSiXoYE

Bitcoin very near if not already at the bottom. Looks like the average statistical move was already hit with that drop below 16k. The upper end of the std deviation would put Bitcoin in the 13.7k range which is what I am expecting for this next, imminent sell-off.
Note
Railroad strike probably averted. Backed out of my short position and wait for 18k to re-enter:

twitter.com/BreakingNews/status/1598018334813044736
(Breaking News
House passes legislation to avert a nationwide rail strike, sending it to the Senate just days ahead of a crucial deadline.)
Note
GoT explains why the markets will rally into 2023:

youtube.com/watch?v=3lVvWUL1rnQ
Note
Finish the wolfe wave around 1448


I am also thinking one more thrust up before a retest of lows, before the large rally into Q1 2023. Or will it just continue running because too many keep repositioning short after every rally?
Note
Armstrong is warning that January could be the high of this current rally: He seems bearish after a reaction False Move. He thinks maybe continuing the decline after a possible January reaction high.

armstrongeconomics.com/armstrong-in-the-media/interview-nightmare-fall-of-united-states/

He reiterated it in the private blog that Euro could maybe rally into the first week of January. This would be the False Move (armstrongeconomics.com/the-princeton-models-and-methodologies-a-users-guide/the-false-move/) before the move down. The entire year of 2023 could be the final last gasp for the Euro, possibly targeting 0.41 USD by 2027/28:

armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/foreign-exchange/euro/private-blog-year-end-book-squaring/
Note
Ron Walker is also expecting a False Move rally before the next crash. This makes sense there's too much bearishness to crash directly.

youtu.be/KFGMk41Nsvg
(Bitcoin Is In store For A Bounce or Big BTC Bounce Followed By A Massive CRASH In January)

youtu.be/GtRBomGYn80
(The Put/Call Ratio Surges To New Highs! Short Squeeze Coming Followed By A Bigger Stock Market CRASH)
Note
The RSI on BTC has reset bullish on the 4 hourly after that hidden, bearish condition at the spike up to 18.35k. Remember I had predicted a bounce from the Nov. 21 15.5k low up to as high as the ~18.2k area. The daily RSI turned bullish on Nov. 21 and price mush go higher before bearish. Weekly RSI turned bullish on Nov. 14.

ETH:USD and ETH:BTC both of bullish RSI divergence on daily. Maybe ~8% leverage on BTC on this posited incoming False Move rally, so perhaps ~$1440 - 1500 and BTC to $18.5 - 19.2k.

LTC:USD and LTC:BTC are RSI bullish on the daily with perhaps 19 - 65% potential upside on BTC, but currently RSI bearish on the weekly unless LTC can rally to $128+ which is plausible, although bearish RSI could still form at that level against the prior $350 level. LTC looks like it might a significant run now and then pullback significantly.

DOGE looks even more bullish than LTC on posited rally. Looking for a double to triple in price!

Note ADABTC is scary.

Also Eric Krown Crypto has two statistical indicators potentially pointing to a BTC rally to $19 - 22k by next week through possibly end of January.

youtu.be/cqLDlZM8_VM
(Bitcoin Quietly Putting In A Major Low On Price)
Note
Although it's quite scary and counter-intuitive to go bullish with VIX so low (which is probably why the majority is positioned bearish/cautious in conjunction with the FTX scandal), there is hidden, bearish RSI on the daily and week, until the VIX makes a lower low than 19.

snapshot
Note
BTC price looks like it wants to False Move rally as it did in Q1 2019 and the VIX also looks like it wants to continue down as it did in Q1 to April 2019. VIX is also prepping for another major flash crash breakout sometime no later than Q1 2024 to repeat the March 2020 corona dump.

snapshot
Note
My charted expectation on BTC.D (Bitcoin Dominance including stable coins) has played out exactly since I published it in June:

snapshot

This looks very bearish for altcoins. But presuming the False Move rally mimicking Q1 2019 is correct, then there would repeat a bull flag on the BTC.D allowing some altcoins to make in January final dominant rallies for 2023 and beyond. Remember altcoins did not moon again until 2021, so we could be looking at 2025 before they moon again! Note altcoins did rally a bit in summer 2020, so maybe they will rally off the recession lows in 2024 then stall again until 2025 while legacy BTC roars first as it did in Q3/Q4 2020? Also note altcoins were dominant (stronger) during the 2020 corona dump so I wonder if they will be again at the recession lows after Bitcoin dominance peaks sometime in 2023?

Remember BTC.D includes stablecoins which now have market caps rivaling the top altcoins, thus we would need to analyze with stablecoins removed to get a more altcoin focused analysis.

Eric Krown Crypto is also pointing out the strength on the BTC.D chart:

youtu.be/PQDnigr_VOk
(Most Bullish Crypto Chart For 2023)
Note
Ah yes so Bitcoin Dominance without the major stablecoins, exemplifies plausible bearish RSI divergence on the daily, or incoming on a rally above 3 on the weekly. So altcoins might make one more dominant rally in January-ish or Q1 2023.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
I could envision a break out to the upside from this falling wedge (aka "falling pizza") with textbook pattern declining volume, but rejected at say 30k then back down to a lower low later in 2023 or Q1 2024.

youtu.be/cEYg9-JzjWk
(Bitcoin BEST CHART FOR $40,000 in 2023)
Note
The Moon also has identified that Bitcoin is going to break either to the upside or downside, but evidence points up.

youtu.be/0qUkraz64HU
(NO F*CKING WAY !!!!!!!! | The Moon)

> "BTC chart is flatlined because it's holiday market condition. Don't get fooled, it means nothing. Don't trade until the 2nd week of January."

Yet Put/cal ratio spiked on S&P probably insurance for the holidays, so a covering bounce incoming?
Note
youtu.be/ykUGoieiFtQ?t=105
(Stock Traders Are BETTING ON THIS HAPPENING Now! | FX Evolution)

My comment:

> "You're comparing against bear markets but we're not in a bear market. The most likely comparable is December 2018. S&P +2.25% from Dec. 22 thus if repeats 2017 or 2018, January should be up 5.6 to 7.9%. Bear markets typically don't kickoff until the rally as the Fed starts easing and unemployment starts rising significantly. Likely a rally before the bear market."

> "VIX has bearish RSI divergence until it drops below 19. Love that everyone is on one side of the trade because of fear of 20 level on the VIX. Go look what happened in Q1 2019. VIX moved all the way back down to support ~11. Repeat incoming to 17. Looks like HYG (junk bonds) have 5th wave up incoming."

> "HYG (junk bonds) looks like it still wants to complete a wave 5 up. DXY (dollar) looks to accumulate at 103 before reverse up. Agreed $65 oil still incoming. Poland & Germany just put in orders for Russian oil!"
Note
DXY dollar chart:

snapshot
Note
Is this Shark pattern projecting up to 4650 to 4925 invalid? How is that wave 2 is completing and wave 3 to ensue with a breakout of downtrend?

snapshot
Note
On the linked Forecast Array, Direction changes, Oct up, Nov down, Dec up with a Panic cycle. Should be up with increasing volatility until March. So where in the heck is Armstrong getting the idea that January will be the top?

I posted in my Telegram on Nov. 15 as follows...

armstrongeconomics.com/world-news/cryptocurrency/ftx-crypto-implosion/

Armstrong finally published his Bitcoin Monthly Forecast Array.

He appears to be interpreting that December Panic Cycle as another selloff instead of as a massive rally.

He also thinks crypto has entered its Dot.Com bust and will not rise again.

But note the Direction Changes. October was up, November was down, so shouldn’t December be up? Panic Cycles can be to the upside or downside (or even both with a massive slingshot).
Note
Again remember there's ostensibly a BAT harmonic pattern on ETH projecting up to $3250. Why is everyone so bearish given oil likely to decline to $65? Why does Armstrong think June is the top? I will search for bearish arguments.

ig.com/en/trading-strategies/top-7-harmonic-patterns-every-trader-should-know-210608

snapshot
Note
Nasdaq has also Shark pattern bottomed as I predicted it would on Oct 9.

snapshot
Note
Remember these posts from November. The 31 month crash that Armstrong is expecting will come, but in 2024.

shelby3 ⏱🌐🧖,
Holy crap. Why did I not see this before! Bitcoin has a Shark pattern projecting down to 5.9k! The pattern does not tell you when that price will be hit. So as was the case for the Bat pattern for ETH, the price can rally back up first but not higher than point C. Thus Bitcoin can still rally before hitting 5.8k, but not higher than ~64k. Thus according to Steve @ Crypto Crew U.’s repeating 5.2 times pattern off the bottom, this indicates that Bitcoin must decline now below 13K, before rallying back up. If back fill that CME gap 9.6k, then Bitcoin will only rally to ~50k in 2023 before crashing ultimately to 5.8k (possibly the posited ANYONECANSPEND attack in 2024).

This seems to be indicating that the crash will be worse on Bitcoin than Ethereum as I have a Bat pattern ETH that says the low will be ~1k.

snapshot

shelby3 ⏱🌐🧖,
Also note that Shark pattern projects from 5.8k down to as low as below zero. So it seems that will be the posited ANYONECANSPEND attack. The legacy Bitcoin will drop to 5.8k but the impostor Bitcoin Core will death spiral. Ah it all fits together now. The chart was telling us everything.

snapshot

shelby3 ⏱🌐🧖,
{ Album }
Okay ETH has that same egregiously bearish Shark pattern and it is worse because there is no price target above $0. So this is so interesting because it jives with the fact that there is no legacy ETH that is to survive which has not already forked off. And the Bat pattern projection for the incoming low for the rally into 2023 is 1K even I move C to the recent rally $1700 (although does not fit a Bat pattern correctly).

So we can watch ETH to tell us when BTC has bottomed. When ETH drops again and tags 1K (or even a wick lower), then we should be looking for a BTC bottom. Strange that BTC might drop much more lower than ETH will. BTC is making lower lows while ETH is making higher lows. ETH will be much stronger into 2023 but this Shark pattern says ETH will not make a new ATH in 2023. Eyeing the 4K level.

Not an exact Bat pattern so ETH could head lower perhaps $950.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

shelby3 ⏱🌐🧖,
Litecoin has a Butterfly instead of a Shark pattern and it projects also below zero with no alternative price above $0. Thus it appears that even legacy LTC will not survive?

snapshot

Shelby Moore ⏱🌐🧖, [12/26/22 12:33 PM]
Amazingly Cardanao (ADA) does not have this death spiral technical pattern. Appears it will rally significantly in 2023 but the subsequent crash will be a major wave 4 thus not going below 2 cents in any case.

Perhaps more importantly this indicates that the death spiral for BTC, ETH and LTC will not be until after ADA rallies for minor wave 5 to complete major wave 3. Yet another confirmation that crypto will bottom soon and rally significantly into 2023.

snapshot
Note
Also there's a corroborating tweening between a bearish BAT and a GARTLEY which I had previously published, that has now completed. There is no other harmonic pattern that can fit. This seems to confirm a bottom!!!

snapshot
Note
Sorry I can not share the chart from the private blog. I can only describe it to you. Here is why I think Martin Armstrong might be misled about January being a reaction bull trap top...

armstrongeconomics.com/international-news/russia/private-blog-beware-of-november/

Remember from the private blog Armstrong posted the Monthly Forecast Array for the DJIA. He is too focused on that January Aggregate. He also got too focused on his fear of International War breaking out in Russia in November or January. This war is a long process, as he can now see with Germany and Poland about to purchase oil from Russia. Oil will decline to $65 and Natural Gas below $3 again. That International War escalation will come later in 2023. There is a Direction Change in April 2023 which will have formed the top and a Panic Cycle in May which will likely mark the bottom.

The markets are probably in the midst of front running the Fed pivot later in 2023 and better than expected earnings likely in Q4 and Q1 as economies around the world are fully opening up.
Note
I commented:

youtube.com/watch?v=PQDnigr_VOk&lc=UgzRF7cbNeEhW8FTUT14AaABAg

> "The problem with using BTC.D instead of BTC/(TOTAL3-USDT-USDC) is that you missed the hidden, bearish RSI divergence on the daily, which could take months to play out. Please correct this analysis asap."

snapshot
Note
> "But I don't really like chasing the market like this if I can help it, especially if I'm away from the computer screen for long periods.
>
> Since we lost the Pi Cycle Bottom indicator as some kind of marker, I'm more wary of TA (not the only reason). My instinct (which admittedly could be sending me unreliable signals) is that we are in uncharted waters."


I do not understand the 'chasing' sentiment? What is the basis of that perspective?

My perspective is that the bottoms I have been calling for since early October have held as predicted. The FTX FUD has everyone and their shoeshine boy expecting lower prices. The market rarely does what everyone expects. Do you know anyone bullish on crypto right now?

The Pi Cycle Bottom had never been used predictively in the past. It was only retrospectively (formulated) correct twice whereas the Pi Cycle top was correct 4 times. It was a new theory based on only two data points. Do you realize there is probably numerous Pi Cycle Bottom formulations that can predict the same prior two instances? And there is probably a different formulation of it that will yield all the prior bottoms and the current one also.

Hey I almost bought at 15.5k, but was too hectic preparing to (or already) traveling. So I missed the bottom thus far. Yeah sucks to buy at 16.8k in that respect, especially when there is likely more downside later in 2023 or 2024. That is why I am analyzing this very exhaustively. My analysis is not yet complete. Looking for counter-arguments.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=3t9REGuXTrw&lc=UgzWnCiXaonkNsvL2AV4AaABAg
(Elon Musk on Fixing Twitter (Free Speech, Shadow Banning & Being CEO) | All-In Podcast Clips)

21:00 Definitely the flash crash will be Q1 2024 and then the Fed will monetize the hell out of it again. So dawn will break in Q2 2024. But note there is likely a final rally incoming Q1 2023 as the market front runs the eventual Fed pivot and gas plummeting to $65. Poland and Germany just put in orders for Russian oil.

Interview gets cut when they talk a bit too much about the FBI. Elon doing his best to avoid talking to directly about the FBI in any serious tone.
Note
Again thinking more about that Direction Change in April and Panic Cycle in May on Armstrong Economics' Monthly Forecast Array for the DJIA, that can't be a bottom and rally, because that will be right about the time the Fed's interest rate hike start to really manifest problems in the economy in earnest. Whereas, Q4 earnings to be reported in January are likely to be better than the doomsday pessimism. And if oil and natural gas decline precipitously as expected (affirmed by Poland and Germany to buy oil from Russia), that should lead to exuberance in Q1.

Thus I think January might actually be a bottom for S&P and Bitcoin along with a right shoulder of a massive, bullish, inverse H&S on the DJIA.
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


> "We really like this setup. It can work out very well. Thanks for sharing."

SwallowPremium, looks like a rally incoming in Q1, then pullback with another rally before a flash crash in Q1 2024 (possibly caused by International War), thus more or less repeating the pattern of 2019. Yet pay attention to updates as the interpretation remains fluid.

"They will try to push war during the summer of 2024 to influence the election."
Note
For Bitcoin, FX Evolution points out a possible miniature inverse H&S pointing up to that ~17.4k level, which the prior vlogger Crypto G I cited mentioned in the context of the larger bearish H&S pointing down to 14.9k. FX Evolution also mentioned distribution on the DJIA pointing to a correction after any bounce. The mentioned statistic about stocks below 52-week MAs with 200 MA down at least 83 days pointing to negative performance in Q1 might be lacking context (e.g. that stock market crashes usually begin when Fed stops hiking and there's often a rally before the Fed pivot).

youtu.be/THlPGGXZmqE?t=1337
(80 Years Of Stock Market History Signal Worse Things Are Coming?)

Unfortunately I can not share screen captures of videos here, thus you readers are missing some of the context that I am able to share on Telegram. Anyway click the videos and find the relevant charts.
Note
My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=THlPGGXZmqE&lc=Ugz3h9_fiF1RK0ZXaOB4AaABAg.9jzh20iqkGQ9k89fcTe9fM

> "Interesting that you don't mention 'risk premium' when talking about valuations - 17 forward PE might be fair in low inflation environment - during high inflation stock multiples have to come down quite a bit more. Cheers!"

What if inflation is plummeting? What is oil falls to $65 and natural gas below $3? What if the market front runs the Fed pivot? What if I told you the Fed just published a paper says their computation of rents (which is 33% of the CPI) is too laggard and they should switch soon to a more forward looking metric for their interpretation of the CPI? What is I told you a recently published Fed document shows that there were only 12,000 new jobs created in 2022 and they are reevaluating their hawkish stance? View Meet Kevin's channel.
Note
Ron Walker has identified divergences which point to a rally back up but given his indicators are not oversold, he expects the rally to fail with the S&P and Bitcoin possibly to new lows.

I believe the Shark pattern on the S&P doesn't allow it to close a week below 3560. It could wick lower or double-bottom.

youtu.be/jIUfDPsvpd8
(DISCOVER HOW TO WIN: If You Want To Make A Fortune Swing Trading The S&P 500 - Follow These Signals)

Ron is pointing out that after the expected incoming bull trap bounce, the DJIA might make a higher low to form the right shoulder of massive, bullish inverse H&S along with the Transports making a lower-low thus being a Dow Theory buy signal and major bottom. Thus I think the bottom wick will be 3512, not 3199.

youtu.be/kInb02mut1k?t=303
(Stock Market CRASH: Will The KISS OF DEATH Be Validated By S&P 500 Closing Below The 50 Month MA?)
Note
ETH can actually come down to ~$950 - 1000 and still be compatible with the two harmonic patterns I had identified:

snapshot

Thus expecting a bull trap move up, followed by the final capitulation in January. Perhaps Bitcoin will only revisit the lows, perhaps a wick to 14.9k given that Armstrong's Monthly Forecast Array for Bitcoin has a Direction Change for December (and next not until March) thus the bottom for Bitcoin should be more or less behind us. We may get one more scare in January and then rally massively in Q1.

2023 - Year From Hell


> "BTC $16,880 igniter was activated on daily data!"

goodblackcat, another failure from ~17.4k likely. Bottom in January. Then the rally in Q1. C.f. my latest updates.
Note
The two harmonic patterns agree on an exactly $1010 bottom for ETH. The target projection is $3250. If this is correct, then buying ETH at $1050 is going to be a triple and I have to believe this would be by April, because I don't think the longer term bullishness of the Bitcoin Dominance allows for altcoins to reach that price later in 2023.

So if ETH:BTC is to rally to between 0.09 - 0.12, that would indicate BTC to ~$27 - 36K:

snapshot
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=_3RkdFB16Hc&lc=Ugxj2WG7gLmzccLraGx4AaABAg.9jga5LTfMJk9jvBa6AIXOM
(Worst Crash in 100 Years Begins as Indicators Warned Days Ago | Money Time Machine)

Does anybody have any f-ing clue why he is bearish out to March? I have the S&P bottomed already with a Shark harmonic pattern. See at most a retest with the DJIA coming down to form a right shoulder of a massive, bullish inverse H&S. There have been some not widely publicized developments at the Fed that virtually nobody seems to be aware of. They just admitted that only 12,000 jobs were created in 2022 and that the delayed effects of rent on CPI are invalid. Looks like they are positioning for an early reverse out of their hawkishness. Also historically bull markets only begin after the Feds starts easing. Historically we should get a massive rally in Q1 before the recession crash when the earnings plummet and unemployment skyrockets. Can someone help me understand Cal's thesis? He was bullish, then suddenly turned uber bearish.
Note
Can someone help me understand Kal's thesis? He was bullish, then suddenly turned uber bearish.

The only explanation I found in his recent videos was this statement about 2023 being all about horrible earnings and recession with Fed rate hikes and high interest rates crushing the market:

youtu.be/4ly8HlswU0U?t=460

But actually there are signs that the consumer is holding up and if oil and natural gas come down to $65 and $3 as expected, this doomsthink might be incorrect?
Note
My Oct 8 prediction hit precisely:

Buy around 209 - big upside
Note
{ Album }
Total crypto market cap continues to hold above 2018 highs and June lows. "More likely than not, to bounce from here."

Monthly jewel indicator in the same position as the macro low March 2019. Volatility is incredibly low (the upper curve, lowest for longest in entire history) so a massive move to the upside or downside is forthcoming. Avg move 90% over 58 days! Whoa! 1st std dev 40 - 137%. Note 100% means a doubling. He measured March 2019 as +145% but I measure it +185%. So my tripling expectation for ETH is right in line with this as not all will rise that much! Fib levels agree.

youtu.be/X3YDq-IanK4
(Bitcoin & Total Crypto Market Capitulation Analysis | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
[ Album ]
We have the Deep Crab pattern on ETH projecting up to $3250. LTC:ETH is projecting 0.097 - 0.1121 thus $315 to $365 which is 4 - 5 times gain.

snapshot

LTC:BTC has two possible projections 0.0071 or 0.0175. Neither seem to make sense for $315 or $365.

snapshot

Thus if only the handle of the cup forms at 0.0704, thus only $229÷0.0071= $32253 BTC which works. Assuming LTC to retest $48 if ETH retests 1K, then LTC to more than quadruple.
Note
If BTC is to rally for a double off a retest of lows, then DOGE appears to be a 5 to 6 times multiple off a retest of its lows. This is of course contingent on the overall thesis of a Q1 rally with Bitcoin Dominance bull flagging (i.e. declining).

snapshot

snapshot
Note
I know you guys need your eyes drawn to visuals so you can grasp the potential massive reversal underway. Here was a key chart from the video I shared previously.

youtu.be/cqLDlZM8_VM?t=333
(Bitcoin Quietly Putting In A Major Low On Price | Eric Krown Crypto)

Don't forget we got the MACD cross as well.

youtu.be/PAaHHDE7f-k?t=157
(Bitcoin Getting Ready For Next MAJOR MOVE | Crypto Crew University)

Sorry Tradingview readers need to click to the videos, because I am unable to share the photo album that I share on Telegram.
Note
Even the uber bearish OPTICALARTdotCOM has flipped his 9k prediction from 12 days ago to a bullish rally to 22k. I commented. WATCH THIS VIDEO!

youtube.com/watch?v=HUth1WN6hEE&lc=UgxUrK9UKuSXijJtDO94AaABAg
(Bitcoin could pump to 22k from here! I explain why.)

Going to ride up that red & orange ring intersection (also the blue ring on the M chart) to ~35k over the next ~7 weeks before the next drop. First stop in that $21 - 22k range. You should look at the Deep Shark harmonic pattern of the ETH chart. Go look at Eric Krown Crypto's statistical indicators. Look at Crypto Crew University's MACD cross. Look at that Shark pattern bottom for the S&P. Projections all pointing to a significant rally in Q1. Also we already know what the Black Swan events are. The Fed recently published obscure reports that only 12,000 jobs were created in 2022. And that the lag on rentals which impact 33% of CPI is an incorrect interpretation of reality. Also Poland and Germany just ordered oil from Russia.
Note
Thus far OPTICALARTdotCOM's conditional is failing with the next stop 15.9k, so I would hold off on establishing long positions and wait for some more information. This by no means invalidates the bulilsh possibility. His thesis was in terms of weekly bars, so any wick down is not an invalidation.

I'm looking to buy some in that $15.9 - 16k area if wick down there, because Ron Walker continues to see evidence that very likely to get a bounce in the market heading into January 4. Note this will likely not be the final bottom an instead some failed rally that might come back down to final lows or retest prior lows.

youtu.be/evtMwpLWaoo
(Stock Market CRASH: After SPX Tanks 8.27 % Momentum Turns To Bullish At Extremes - SPX Bounce Likely)
Note
I shared five screen captures from this video on Telegram. Tradingview readers will just need to watch the entire video, lol.

{ Album }
youtu.be/mTA80P4eX2o?t=472
(Is Bitcoin Forming A Bottom? | Crypto Banter)
Note
[ Album ]
MUST WATCH!

This blows up the argument that Q1 must trade according to fair value for forward P/E ratios. Well done GoT. Market presumes the Fed is hawkish enough to bring Inflation down (and in fact inflation is falling precipitously regardless if it will end up surging again later that is not the reality now. IOW, the market has not yet priced in inflation's reaction to the higher interest rates. Remember we will likely get one more significant risk-on rally before the recession actually starts when the Fed is forced to ease because of rising unemployment which has not started yet.

youtu.be/zNw4xNk1qWM?t=114
(This Only Just Got Started: Data Shows Us the SP500 Is Still Exactly Like May 2001 and June 1970 | Game of Trades)

The following is incorrect and myopic:

seekingalpha.com/article/4566328-poor-earnings-shallow-recession-s-and-p-500-lower-initially-recover-to-4151-by-year-end-2023

My comment on that Seeking Alpha blog:

> "Meet Kevin revealed recent Fed publications pointing to only 12,000 jobs created in 2022, lag in rents as a major component of CPI being misleading, as well as charts indicating oil headed to $65 and natural gas below $3. I think the markets will price in Fed overshooting into deflation (instead of disinflation) with a massive rally back up to 20 forward P/E. Game of Trades just pointed this out comparing to the late 1960s scenario. CPI is YoY change with declining prices means negative percentage change!"
Note
Do you guys understand this? Seems most people are oblivious to the fact that as commodity prices are declining this means YoY inflation could head much lower than what people are expecting. Lagging rent BS in the CPI computation has been obscuring the fact that CPI has reversed. Yeah Armstrong might be correct that inflation heads back up again in a few months but the markets have yet to price into forward P/E ratios the fact that Fed is very likely to create even deflation at least temporarily. This bounce in oil to $82 is a last bull trap before the drop to $65. The markets will have to price in this reality before any future yet unforeseen reality of resurgent inflation in the future. Yeah China may open back up and eventually create more demand for oil and such, but they probably have a stockpile of inventory already and the easing of the supply chains with more goods flowing causing more disinflation is the more likely immediate effect. The fear about a wage-price spiral is nonsense if it is true that only 12,000 jobs were created per recent Fed paper. Tech is laying off employees and other Big-Tech are envious that Musk cut workforce by 75%. Amazon and others to compete with Musk as Big-tech is under intense pressure to downside as the surplus of demand from the p(L)andemic subsides. Sure the new bill passing through Congress will elevate govt spending again but that is some months from now. This is why any Q1 rally will fail, as well as the economy will roll over into recession eventually but with massive govt spending coming in 2023, the recession may be pushed off into 2024. Also the forward earnings need to reflect this massive govt stimulus coming in 2023, which I think the Seeking Alpha article totally failed to incorporate.
Note
{ Album }
Nike has already returned to positive earnings after 2 quarters of negative earnings. China will be disinflation or deflation force in November and December at least! Remember January inflation reports will be retrospective.

January economic data releases could surprise the market which overly bearish. Fedex reported firming consumer demand with declining costs, while downsizing to level of new lower level of demand from prior declines (i.e. laying off workers).

Not a macro, broad collapse, rather more of an ecommerce reset to post-pLandemic normalization with solid underlying demand.

youtu.be/53GCET67j0U
(Santa will FLIP The Stock Market | Meet Kevin)
Note
{ Album }
Fed turned nasty in December, revising projections for economic growth down and inflation up, making the markets very pessimistic. This moved everyone to NPC mindless, groupthink one-side of the trade. In this video Kevin was thinking the lag of owner's equivalent rents in CPI won't be reflected until Q2 and Q3.

youtu.be/Op7-XrIbiEk
(Timing The Federal Reserve's U-Turn | Meet Kevin)

BLS has said unemployment plummeting & created 2M jobs, but household survey says only 12k jobs created! Now the Fed is admitting it! New Fed working paper admits lagging rents in CPI is misleading! Leading housing indicator is horrific, Fed will create massive deflation! Companies to buy back stock with excess cash than invest, bcz downsizing in anticipation of recession!

youtu.be/Z7zYPkq443Q
(PROOF the Fed & Jerome Powell was LIED To | Flip Coming) <—MUST WATCH

Stonks Gamer commented:

> "No mistakes Kevin they are doing it on purpose to "have to" do more stimulus checks but now with the new cbdc coin as that will be so much more efficient in giving everyone cash. Thus transitioning us to a fully digital currency they track and control in every possible way."
Note
My post from Oct 10. Harmonic patterns projecting...note a target of 0.62 - 0.79 (~1.07 - 1.10) or 1.127 - 1.62 (~1.18 - 1.24) of XA on the Gartley reversal/bottoming pattern for the EURO:

school.stockcharts.com/doku.php?id=trading_strategies:harmonic_patterns

The EURUSD has bullish Gartley reversal pattern and bullish RSI divergence on the weekly and monthly:

snapshot

Natural Gas has a Shark pattern projection to $3:

snapshot
Note
Video I cited today from OPTICALARTdotCOM had Fib circles for Euro:USD which he interpreted to be a short at ~1.07 (current price) but he admitted if breaks above that then next move is up to ~1.24. Euro boost black swan incoming...as Croatia goes full retard to join the Great Reset...

ft.com/content/18d0cd2f-3afe-49c8-9157-71aefb5cf2e0
(Croatia anticipates economic boost as it prepares to adopt euro)

> "Former Yugoslav nation long in pursuit of closer integration with EU switches to single currency on January 1"

> "The central bank, meanwhile, has brought in the army to store and guard some 40 per cent of kuna coins that it expects to be exchanged for euros."


Armstrong private blog on Dec. 16, stated that is Euro:USD closes above 1.0775 for year end then upside, if below 1.0635 then vulnerable to downside. Either way, 2023 a major bull trap for the Euro with 0.41 target into 2027/2028.

armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/foreign-exchange/euro/private-blog-year-end-book-squaring/

Looks like there could be a major rally on the Euro:USD. Something is happening. Poland and Germany looking to buy oil from Russia. Will the sanctions be averted because oil drops below the $60 threshold of the sanctions anyway? Lol.

armstrongeconomics.com/international-news/russia/poland-germany-offer-to-buy-energy-from-russia-for-2023/

Who else assimilates all of this like I do? I have collected a lot of information from many sources. Even Armstrong should be paying attention to me!

Note the $65 oil target after a bull trap to $82 is from YT vlogger FX Evolution.

I pretty much had this all figured out in October. Now it is all playing out as the chart patterns were projecting.
Note
Archived including all comments
(this required a tweak to the archived url)
Note
Holy Batman. Manipulations have shown up in the charts.

GoT didn't make this precise point in the previously cited video (This Only Just Got Started: Data Shows Us the SP500 Is Still Exactly Like May 2001 and June 1970 | Game of Trades). Yet notice that the bottom in ~1970 was just after when inflation rolled over same as now (even though bottom was lower on days 200 DMA trending down). Thus bottomed for at least a significant relief rally, i.e. ditto for the corresponding case May 2001. Inflation was much more egregiously accelerated and exaggerated this time thus earlier termination (duh it was intentional, premediated by Brandon et al). Thus relief rally will be accelerated and larger (red inflation further gap below below forward P/E in prior cited video)

BINGO!!! 🎯🎯🎯

youtu.be/BlJRpT_Gh4g
(History Shows Us That This Will End Within 5 Months. | SP500 Volatility Is at a Pivotal Moment | Game of Trades)
Note
> "I watched the GoT vid (noted he expected a drop to $15,957 if $16,697 is broken), plus The Crypto Trader. Waiting to see where we go. Neither bullish or bearish."
>
> "Appreciate all your efforts as regards research and brainstorming btw."


I am more than 50% convinced (80?) any lower-low is irrelevant as Bitcoin will be above 30k by March. I do not want to miss that. I do think it is probable will at least retest near to lows, possibly lower 14.9k, and even still remotely possible $13,9k. For me below 13K is out of the cards now before the posited Q1 rally.

Yw. I needed to do it for myself and others. Hope it's correct. I am sleep deprived a.t.m. so factor that in, but I'm alert.

EDIT: you mean the OPTICALARTdotCOM video.
Note
Click link for MXN:USD Forecast Array. C.f. MXN:USD exchange history also.

> "Do not delay getting your capital out of the E.U. and U.K. in 2022. This is going to heat up in 2023 and will go berserk in 2024. Appears that it will be impossible from 2025 forward. I suppose the CBDCs will be activated and everyone’s funds over there will be locked down. The year 2025 looks like an utter horror. Remember 2025 is the year Deagel.com predicted 50 – 75% depopulation of NATO countries. Some kind of utter insanity is ahead. I am making the correct decision to diversify out of the West."
>
> armstrongeconomics.com/international-news/mexico/the-flight-to-mexico/


Is that collapse in 2025 all capital controls, or is the currently freedom-oriented Mexican Prez replaced with a Great Reset sycophant?

Yet MXN peso has been declining since 2022 consistent with the Direction Change. So does the peso's decline cease in 2024/25?

No Volatility 2025, as if no liquidity. Looks like capital controls to me. Then legacy Bitcoin (1989 Economist Mag's cover story Phoenix) starts rising in 2026/7.
Note
> "If you had to guess, what do you think the 2023 top will be (let’s assume no G7 country introduces CBDC to the general public)"

Bitcoin $30 - 35k no later than April. Might try for another high in Q4 2023/Q1 2024, before the MEGA CRASH to ~10k. My thesis 2019 is more or less repeating. Will rhyme but not exact duplicate.

> "Working on growing my business so we can exit to have the resources to do it the way I want. That’s the #1 priority"

I doubt that is going to work out. You probably better start thinking about needing to share economies-of-scale with others. One of the reasons I have a mutual interest in your thoughts/plans.

Still a small chance I launch an altcoin to generate millions.
Note
Gareth Soloway thinks a "rip your face off rally" to ~30k may catch people off guard before the 10k low after May.

youtu.be/AOF8v6k7YZY
(Gareth Soloway: Bitcoin Will Shock Everyone By This Date!)
Note
OPTICALARTdotCOM has moved his support level down and by now have already crossed over the ring. Looks like we are probably headed up, before any later retest in January:

youtu.be/xJ1KaSMCM24
(Emergency Bitcoin update! Time Sensitive!)
Note
Ron Walker also thinks a bull trap rally is incoming. OPTICALARTdotCOM is still in a long-position but does not rule out a drop to 15k first.

youtu.be/dzTg-Mz_tNQ
(Epic Bitcoin suckers rally pump incoming! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)
Note
youtu.be/RX0pRSotrjE
(My Stock Market CRASH Were Right! Bounce Likely As NASDAQ & SPX Get Bullish Candle Reversal Patterns | Ron Walker)
Note
youtu.be/0o-uMhYtjx4
(S&P 500 Stock Market CRASH: The Put/Call Ratio Surges To New Highs Again! Big Short Squeeze Coming! | Ron Walker)
Note
This argues that crypto likely to make a lower-low in 2023, possibly it will even be in January after any bounce this week, but will be significantly higher than current price sometime in 2023. Also 2024 and 2025 are likely to be bullish. However, this does not factor in the first recession that crypto has experienced and that 2022 was Bitcoin's first yearly bearish, engulfing candle. I am not ruling out a wick low in 2024. I do agree sometime in 2023 the price will be higher than it is now. I do agree crypto appears to be preparing for a temporary bottom perhaps in January.

youtu.be/_4QNW2A1saU
(Why 2023 Could Provide Investors With The Greatest Opportunities!)
Note
If the S&P forms another Shark pattern on lower-low, then the target would be ~$3400 - 3420. This would seem to be compatible with the $1000 harmonic pattern low expected for ETH. So maybe BTC is going to make a lower-low after the posited bull trap bounce this week.

snapshot
Note
Remember there's two corroborating harmonic patterns on ETH pointing to ~$1000 bottom incoming. Thus perhaps more predictive unlike the Shark pattern on the S&P which can continue to ratchet lower and lower if the prior one is invalidated.
Note
Probabilities continue favor Bitcoin rallying a bit before dropping to establish the final bottom:

youtu.be/eGQ2IFNIw0Y
(Be A Bitcoin Winner In 2023)
Note
Fed's Bullard just further shifted the narrative to the Fed's nearing a pause. Here comes our bull trap as expected.

youtu.be/sRTw2GNzaLI
(A Key Part of the Fed *JUST* Flipped.)
Note
ETH may complete a 30+% bull trap move over next couple of weeks or so:

youtu.be/5mH1M78Xm5A?t=251
(Ethereum January Price Statistics)
Note
Bouncing off test of support from October Accumulation


> > "I resisted commenting on your most recent Bitcoin update, but I thought support would hold at least for a bounce into January. After that there might be one more leg down for a bottom. Regardless I am expecting a face ripping rally in Q1 after the bottom forms."
>
> "shelby3, are you referring to the run to S&P 4300 as the face ripper?"

JerryManders, yeah not thinking new ATH until 2025. Fed's Bullard hinted yesterday a pause in rate hikes will be signaled soon. Market will front run that. Historically the markets rally into the pause or easing before the lagging effect of recession drags everything back down. Also my model is the overlords are premeditating global events to force flash crashes to force the central banks into supporting egregious stagflation and ultimately self-immolation as the pathway to the NWO wherein legacy Bitcoin will rise as the Phoenix world reserve asset in a multi-polar world from the ashes post-WW3. Probably escalation in Ukraine to direct conflict between NATO and Russia widening the scope of the war, capital controls and supply chain disruption. Thus another bout of flash crash event (2019-2020 is repeating more or less) leading to worsening price inflation with even more egregious central banks off-the-rails. Btw, Mark Moss just pointed out that bank bail-ins are coming to the U.S. eventually. FDIC only insures 125B and 12.5T of assets. Bank deposits are unsecured creditors. My current thesis is a bull trap bounce incoming in January, possibly a retest down, then the full on face ripper ending by April-ish. Yet I am open to Q2 face ripper scenario, although that seems to be a lower probability based on the signals I am looking at. Will be curious to see what you are detecting in your mathematical-based analyses?
Note
Hope you guys have been riding this rally up. I bought DOGE at $0.068 and it hit $0.078 already today. Bought ETH $1192 and it's hit $1320 already, probably headed to ~$1550 after some consolidation and back fill test of this breakout.

youtu.be/_lOxU94K4pE
(Bitcoin Breaks Out As Predicted!!! Last Chance! Big BTC Rally Likely Towards 20K)
Note
Bitcoin is carving out a bottom. Main conclusion is there will likely be a significant bounce at some point on 2023 and 2024 should start a new bull market. This does not guarantee that Bitcoin can't go lower.

It has been pitiful to see Marting Armstrong entirely miss the boat on crypto. And never once helping his subscribers reap the enormous gains of each 4 year bull market cycle. The man who claims to be so astute about cycles, can not seem to see that Bitcoin has a repeating 4.3 year cycle, 2.1 years up and 2,1 years down.

youtu.be/H2gYtplI_rs
(Bitcoin Just Flashed TORNADO WARNING | Crypto Crew University)
Note
This video is also supporting the thesis that the 4 year Bitcoin cycle is intact:

youtu.be/XE6Gkt65FhA
(My 2023 CRYPTO Predictions - Wyckoff w/ Ryan)
Note
"Official" (impostor) Bitcoin Core to Drop to $0 in 2023?


> "ah btc will be 0 okey im buying now 2millions usd😁😁"

GUIDE_BJV, you better read more slowly and in detail. I never said legacy protocol Bitcoin will go to 0. I said if you store your Bitcoin in non-legacy addresses (i.e. that begin with a 3 or bc1 instead of a 1), then you BTC will be donated to the miners. Now please prove me wrong by not storing your BTC in addresses that begin with a 1. I will be laughing at you. Now if you paid attention and I ended up saving your a$$ then you should thank me in the end. Because nobody else bothered to inform you.
Note
[ Album ]
Short-term hoping for crypto to back test a tad to posited support.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Looks like more upside to go.

youtu.be/d8sr__P0x4Y
(Market CRASH: S&P 500 Gets A Bearish Shooting Star & Reverses At Gap Resistance Erasing The Rally | Ron Walker)

Also OPTICALARTdotCOM has a new video still expecting Bitcoin to push higher.
Note
I have Bitcoin rallying to at least 18.6k after a pullback. And as high as ~21k. ~10 - 20% gains.

snapshot

After pullbacks ETH and DOGE also looking bullish up to ~25%.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
SPX Structure


Per my recent reply, I posit the posited right shoulder is not fully formed yet. The October low matched a bullish Shark harmonic pattern bottom, projecting 4650 - 4925. Yet another Shark bottom could form with a drop to 3400. Crypto has formed bottoming patterns though. My guess is a rally now ~4030, following by drop lower than the December low to completely form the right shoulder. Followed by rallies into Q2 as was the case (even for Bitcoin) in 2019. Martin Armstrong has Panic Cycles in April and a peak in May/June on his A.I. data mining Forecast Array. I was originally thinking there would be a high in Q1 with those being a crash in Q2. Now I am thinking more of a repeat of 2019 - 2020 with another COVID-style flash crash coming in Q1 2024 to align with the recession. Possibly Russia nukes Kviv as Macron has suggested he do, if he wants the E.U. contingent of NATO to have second thoughts about Brandon's intentional provocation in Ukraine.

snapshot
Note
My current analysis is that 2019 - 2020 is repeating more or less. Thus an intense rally sometime in 2023 ($35 - 50k), then eventually rolling over into a recession. Could be a flash crash recession again due to some new coordinated malfeasance akin to COVID but perhaps instead nuclear war or a cyber attack blamed on Russia.

It's unclear if the current bounce underway is the big one for 2023. I think probably not. I think this bounce will top out below 22k (if even that) and one more retest of the bottom (possibly lower) into March. Then same as 2019, a rocket launch in April, perhaps because of a Fed pause.

So we will want to sell into that 2023 rally. Then repurchase in probably Q1 2024, then ride that new bull market to new ATHs by 2025.

Note, make sure you are storing your BTC in legacy addresses that start with 1, not 3 nor bc1. It's a possibility for non-legacy addresses to be donated to the miners if there is a restoration of the Nash equilibrium with the taking of the pay-to-script-hash booty.
Note
Bitcoin appears to be prepping for a run to $35 - 58k in Q2. Probably coming back down after this rally to retest one more time, but not sure if will make lower-low or not. For me below 13.5k is a very low probability before this posited Q2 rally

snapshot

ETH is prepping for a Q2 rally to $3200.

snapshot

Yet BTC is poised to be dominant again on this rally repeating 2019. Also BTC Dominance appears to be in a bear flag, thus altcoins to perform much better in 2024! Is that ANYONECANSPEND attack coming against the impostor, non-legacy protocol Bit-cOn?

snapshot

snapshot

ETH:BTC looks like it could drop to 0.053 - 0.076 thus $42 - 60k, albeit 0.064 - 0.68 looks like a sweet spot which is $47 - 50k.

snapshot
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


goodblackcat, we agree except you are buying into this FOMO which is what we need for one more rejection and retest. Not sure it will make a lower low. This could be the rally of 2023 underway if the S&P can clear overhead resistance and flip the bearish divergences bullish. I am still researching this possibility. Also my indications are that BTC will be dominant on this 2023 rally but not as dominant as 2019. Yes I might create a new thread if have the time to prepare an organized summary of this thread and the new focus.
Note
[ Album ]
Don't chase this. Massive hidden bearish RSI divergence on weekly and daily, as well as overhead resistance downtrend line and 200 DMA. I am waiting for significant retest down. It could rally all the way to 22k instead without any retest but I am not chasing this because I doubt this is the launch of the major 2023 rally:

snapshot

Also waiting for ETH to retest breakout:

snapshot

And DOGE is too near to the posited end of this rally for the short-term, and later in January will open up to much higher prices:

snapshot
Note
S&P and Nasdaq forming bearish H&S. Also rally into the CPI report has been bearish every time. Also earnings season is starting off with bearish projections for Q1, such as TMSC warning of 0% growth for Q1. I'm not as bearish as these two though.

youtu.be/panxtlSL78g
(Bitcoin Rally As Predicted To Form Yet Another Bear Flag - Once Completed BTC Will CRASH To 8K or 9K)

youtu.be/G9uhtJOr0TU
(Epic VIX Complacency Crash Signal Flashes For First Time in Decades)
Note
I think it's quite plausible that the S&P has already bottomed and Shark harmonic projecting to 4750 - 4950. Question is does come back down and form a right shoulder the larger posited, bullish inverse H&S (by completing a smaller posited, bearish H&S) or is a bullish W pattern underway soon to breakout above that major downtrend line? The latter would surprise everyone. We need to look closely at indicators to see if too many are shorting this rally, then it could be the latter?

snapshot
Note
This is guesswork but it called the recent bottom exactly with a confluence. It's indicating the bottom in March to be either above ~13.4k or ~9k. I will bet on the former, not the latter. The bottom could also already be in.

snapshot
Note
[ Album ]
OPTICALARTdotCOM has Bitcoin topping out at ~20.5k on about Jan 27 though the end of January.

youtu.be/EeJG7lSU8s4
(Bitcoin will top out at this exact price on this exact day and crash!)

I had some confluence already charted which matches that prediction, possibly with a move first to ~19.6k after a retest of 18.6k, with a possible retest of ~18.1k before the top. Concurs with the S&P making one more surge to ~4029 before a pullback before the double test of overhead resistance (c.f. the Money Time Machine video I shared earlier today). Ron Walker (The Crypto Trader) also has a 0.786 Fib retracement level ~20.2k. If so, his bear flag will be invalidated, unless an intraday wick above ~19.6k.

snapshot

snapshot

Assuming ETH pulls back to $1352 if BTC retests 18.1k, they both have about the same upside. DOGE doesn't appear to have more upside either.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Fed liquidity has stopped being predictive and is following the S&P.

Bitcoin surprised obviously. Watch out for the debt ceiling crisis in the U.S. next week!! That might be the catalyst to bring the market back down? Fear of less supply of Treasuries could send interest rates back up? Less government spending could impact company earnings thus driving stock markets down?

The dumb money has been FOMOing on this rally while the smart money has been selling (c.f. latest FX Evolution video).

I will be preparing to go short on Bitcoin. Will follow-up on that as I partake of my study and hopefully another follow-up from OPTICALARTdotCOM. Remember I had a chart showing Bitcoin could rally as high as 23K which also is the upper end of Eric Krown Crypto's statistical indicator. So we need to wait and see how OPTICALARTdotCOM pivots his macro understanding if Bitcoin closes above 21k and moves higher invalidating his current thesis to short from that level.

Watch this!

youtu.be/KmUGa5Ydxt8
(Stock Market Peak Next Week & CRASH Wave 3 Will Begin As Debt Ceiling Crisis Creates Financial Chaos | Ron Walker)

snapshot
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


goodblackcat, debt ceiling fight will give us one more chance to buy lower before the Q2 face ripping rally. C.f. my latest update. Dumb money has been FOMOing in. This was a short covering rally that caused the dumb money to be sucked in for the slaughter.
Note
Decent probability that Bitcoin pulls back ~20.4k over the weekend, then makes another move next week to ~23K to finish off this FOMO pump. If so, OPTICALARTdotCOM has to completely alter his current thesis. I will not try to call the likely pullback range for Bitcoin in March yet. Also waiting for Ron Walker (The Crypto Trader) to update his Bitcoin analysis because his bear flag thesis was just blown out of the water.

youtu.be/Ct_VMZWwLu4?t=402
(Bitcoin Bull-Zooka Has Arrived | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
VIX has bullish RSI divergence and structurally appears to be roughly at the comparable juncture to April 15, 2019. Yet key differences are Bitcoin hasn't yet formed a higher low as it had, and the trajectory is much more lower curvature rounded, less U-turn or V-shaped. So expect Bitcoin to come back down significantly to form a higher low at least. Also the strongest level of overhead resistance back in 2019 was at the April breakout level, not up at the incoming posited ~23K end of the breakout as currently. This rally is a Wycoff retracement of the Nov 7 FTX dump (twitter.com/GertvanLagen/status/1613679250149720069) from 21.4k, not a macro scale Wycoff. Thus should pullback from ~23K perhaps to ~18k (youtu.be/3-aNeqAcZK8?t=789) (buy the higher low of the subsequent Mark Down (medium.datadriveninvestor.com/94b4934f6fb8)).

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Guy from Coin Bureau thinks this current FOMO pump will fade. (He also worries the opening of China might recreate/extend the COVID nonsense)

youtu.be/mq-TjmiFSHc?t=40
(Prepare For What's Coming - Coin Bureau Update)

I replied:

> "It's interesting to see how much emotions can affect a market. Looks like everyone that fear dumped FTX just fomo'ed back in on a short squeeze. I think the fed is going to clamp these rallies in February, but who knows, really."

Also the looming debt ceiling crisis. This will come back down to at least a higher low. Notice how in 2019 there was already a higher low before the face ripping rally. The face ripping rally is coming but probably not until April.

> "Reading the comments I feel like everyone has PTSD and is in disbelief that the bear market is potentially over. These are the same people that will fomo in after 30k . If you were DCA'ing the entire time down and more aggressively when things are down 90+% you'd already be in the profit"

Okay moonboy. Don't cry over the looming debt ceiling crisis and the lack of a higher low yet (c.f. 2019). The face ripping rally is coming but probably not until April.

> "Getting back to before FTX collapse is normal in my opinion. Not buying is still a mistake because the next pump will be to Luna collapse."

Yep eventually, but don't cry over the looming debt ceiling crisis, Fed reasserting hawkishness in February, and the lack of a higher low yet (c.f. 2019). The face ripping rally is coming but probably not until April.

> "Hm, let me see…what would the crypto market do when everyone thinks it’s going to take longer than usual to start a bull market?🤔"

And when many have your thought and FOMO in before a higher low has been established prior to the face ripping rally, c.f. 2019.

> "Up too fast too much. Not organic growth, bull trap. Start buying in 6 months at these prices 15/18k"

> "@RicVee1 lol 9k is a dream. What's going to drive that? If FTX didn't do it what on earth will?"


jeff Burg that 9k may come in the posited Q1 2024 recession which could be a corona-like flash crash. Possibly Russia nukes Kyiv as Macron has invited him to do or a cyber attack on everyone's bank account promulgated by our overlords erroneously blamed on Russia (another false-flag as was the pLandemic of a billion flu tests). There will be a face ripping rally in 2023 as was the case in 2019. 2019 is repeating but we need a higher low before the face ripping rally probably by April.
Note
The Bitcoin pump is ahead of the reality. FX Evolution pointed out that these 200% pumps in meme stocks such as Bed, Bath & Beyond typically correspond with a top on the market, as they typically come near the end of a rally.

youtu.be/LEsWyA3rJjQ
(BITCOIN BULL MARKET or BEAR MARKET FOMO RALLY with Gareth Soloway)
Note
Bitcoin just had a monthly cross on Eric Krown Crypto's stochastic indicator. Statistically this has always marked a macro bottom and led to a ~240% rally. Thus targeting ~57k. Interesting his 57k is the upper end of the range I wrote about this week, based on a different method of analysis (the harmonic pattern on ETH chart projecting to $3200 and ETH:BTC and Bitcoin Dominance projecting $35 - 57k). Obviously not necessarily underway immediately. The June 2015 instances actually came back down to test the bottom before rallying.

youtu.be/Qj37lPjvaLU?t=432
(Bitcoin Is $30,000 Realistic In 2023)
Note
There will be a stock market rally in 2023. 7:00 a lot of smart money traders missed the 2020 rally. 33:00 options expiry this week, should end the week approximately 390 (i.e. 3900) for max pain.

youtu.be/Y6cfvrufaVg?t=325
(Is This The Beginning Of A New Stock Rally? 80 Years Of History Tell Us This... | FX Evolution)
Note
Armstrong is now contemplating a SLING SHOT rally kicking off in earnest by April peaking by end of June. He contemplates that his A.I. Socrates model Weekly Forecast array Panic Cycle in early February night be the retest down to get everyone back to thinking recession, then a SLING SHOT up due to some geopolitical event which forces capital flight to accelerate again to the U.S. (but wouldn't that cause the dollar to rally thus making being incompatible with a risk-on rally?). Although I am think it could simply be the Fed forced to turn less hawkish after the debt ceiling crisis creates sufficient drag on the economy thus accelerating the Fed's planned pause?

armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/stock-indicies/dow-jones/private-blog-the-risk-of-a-sling-shot-in-2023/
Note
Gareth Soloway also expects ETH:BTC to break out to ~0.137. So given I was thinking it might decline first to on the posited 2023 rally, perhaps that rally will come in 2024? If instead coincides with posited 2023 rally then Bitcoin would only rally to 25K if ETH to 3200ish. Note ETH:BTC did outperform on the finally rally in Jan/Feb before the March 2020 COVID crash. So maybe a repeat?

youtu.be/9oinEGKzz6Y
(Gareth Soloway - Bitcoin Is About To Shock Everyone.)

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Ron Walker is skeptical of this Bitcoin rally pointing out that the dollat is at key support! Good point. Dollar likely to rally with the looming debt ceiling crisis.

What's very interesting is that if 69k was end of wave 3 then if this was the bottom, Bitcoin would need to rally to new ATH to complete wave 5. THAT WILL NOT HAPPEN. Thus the correct E.W. count is that 69k was end of wave 5, thus any 2023 bounce will be a W-X-Y (A-B-C) correction meaning unlike in 2020, the 2024 crash would make a lower-low. Ah ha! That's exactly what I've been expecting. I have predicted this back in summer of 2021!!!

youtu.be/tHGSsu8s2ck <== click to see E.W. counts.
(Could This Be The Bitcoin Bottom? The Signal That Called The Top & Predicted The CRASH Turns Bullish)
Note
Yeah I like this idea a lot. Looks like a bottom in W-X-Y corrective pattern which will take BTC up to $35 - 57k for wave X, then back down to a lower-low inQ1 2024 for the next variant of the March 2020 corona crash. I bet come back down to test that yellow uptrend line ~17.5k before rockets in April. Essentially 2019 is repeating exactly as I had predicted since summer of 2021 when I had identified the megaphone pattern.

I will start scaling in bullish on any correction even if only to 19.5k. We can not be sure this will not run (to 23K or beyond). Pullbacks should be bought. But keep in mind the possibility of one more retest nearer to lows, but perhaps not below 17.5k.

snapshot
Note
Click this to see the chart which supports the thesis of a 2023 rally followed by a 2024 lower-low:

youtu.be/sQXh7lA_c3E?t=410
Note
> "7:00 a lot of smart money traders missed the 2020 rally"

Large Traders (i.e. the smart money) are the most bearish they have ever been, repeating their May 2020 incorrect bearishness.

youtu.be/KBsBhkcvTr0
(They Are Exiting the SP500 Before the Big Rug Pull. | Largest Outflow Since December 2021.)
Note
> "So what do you think is the move"

I think the move is up this week, after possibly a pullback to 19.5k.

I am leaning to a retest below 19k after this week. And then a significant rally beginning in April. But I can not rule out that the rally will continue unabated from here.

I think the markets will crash again to lower lows in Q1 2024.

This is guesswork based in conjectured probabilities. If everyone is expecting a pullback over the 3 day weekend, maybe it doesn't come to fruition and up we go.
Note
Bitcoin looks likely to head quickly to $23 - 25k (this week or next), after a shallow retest $19.5 - 20.4k. There's a CME gap ~19.9k. I think the deeper retrace will come after this rally terminates at those levels, probably 23K with perhaps a wick to 25k.

youtu.be/VEii-B8nXIM
(Bitcoin This Will Create Massive Opportunity [price statistics] | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
People are calling for a larger pullback thinking this is an inverted H&S but that neckline does not exist! This looks more like a Cup & Handle and this Cup may already be or soon-to-be completed? I bet maximum pullback to ~20k at the 0.236 Fib.

The projections for the C&H are in the same ballpark as the Fib extensions ~23k or ~25k. Will we get there by the first week of February at the latest, then correction? Or is Armstrong's Forecast Array Panic Cycle in the 2nd week of February on some markets going to a massive move to upside?

thepatternsite.com/cup.html

snapshot
Note
Correction down in early February before rallying into March/April? Massive puts to expire worthless on February 17 if the price gets slammed back down.

youtu.be/NVGWwDE5SuQ
(The Last 7 Times We Saw This Bad Things Happened To The Stock Market...)
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=03txnH10kcA&lc=UgxCCSB8l5vz12EIL-p4AaABAg
(Monster Crash Signals From 2002 & 2008 Flash Again After 15 Years | Money Time Machine)

Kal Moan can't just go compare a fractal and conclude that the same environment is in play without analyzing the environment actually in play. If you did that you would realize this video is complete nonsense. I suggest you partake of Game of Trades, Q4 Newsletter – Today’s Fears Won’t Be Tomorrow’s: The Fed and Beyond. Those Dotcom and 2008 G.F.C. crashes came as unemployment was rising precipitously, Fed interest rate hiking cycle had peak many months prior, and this was the end of a multidecade secular bull market that repeated in duration before. The current secular bull market is not yet near to the duration to rollover sideways for 10 years as it did from 2000 and 1970. The 200 WMA will hold as support in a secular bull market. There's always a rally at the end of the interest raising peak. Never has a Xmas and January rally every ended with negative year. I do think there could be one more retest down, but not a lower-low.
Note
twitter.com/GameofTrades_/status/1616495774048702465
(click for the chart)

The lower this indicator, the lesser the selling pressure in the market

Who’s left to sell? Hardly anyone

Max pain to the upside
Note
Exact repeat of 2019-2020 underway in 2023. First leg down bounces of 200 WMA, then the Q1 2024 crash will pierce it!

snapshot
Note
[ Album ]
Bitcoin could be done, but I am expecting likely ~25K before this has a major pullback in February. A new bullish 9 day count has started, although also on 10 of 13 day countdown.


I don't think Bitcoin will go above ~25K, so I am sort of in agreement with Ron Walker (The Crypto Trader), except he still entertains the possibility that Bitcoin could make a higher-low or a lower-low after the peak perhaps this coming week or next. I am confident of a higher-low (perhaps $18.3 - 19.6k, lowest 17.7k), which I will buy hand & fist.

On my log-scaled DXY chart the dollar already break down below the uptrend line and thus any rally will only be back test before going much lower.

Major bearish divergence on the 4-hourly chart.

youtu.be/gpHqNncPVdM?t=19
(Bitcoin Forming A MoonBoy Bull Trap! MoonBoy Indicator Warns BTC CRASH Coming! Dollar Breakout Soon!)
Note
Scenarios...

snapshot
Note
Eric Krown Crypto has been nailing this entire rally off the bottom in advance. Watch this on double-speed. Bitcoin has very likely bottomed. Likely continuation to 23.1k perhaps a pullback to ~22k, then onwards ~25K to finish this move perhaps by end of first week of February.

youtu.be/zEe93wZFKkA
(Bitcoin Do You Know How Far This Rally Will Go? [price statistics])
Note
[ Album ]
Pullback then Cup&Handle targets?

Target, Max Upside
~22.2k BTC, +10%
~$1615 ETH, +25%
~$0.083 DOGE (0.0815 - 0.0855), +35%

DOGE:BTC bottoming? Speculating that BTC will slowdown now and altcoins will catch up as the signal of the end of this Elliot wave #1 of the 2023 bull run.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

Crazy speculation that DOGE is projecting to 4× leverage on BTC on the 2023 bull run, possibly more than 10× gain in price, yet could decline significantly on posited wave #2 pullback. Essentially BTC to $40 - 55k and DOGE to ~0.60 - 0.80. Alternatively 2× leverage so ~$0.40 and BTC ~$35 - 45k. Latter probably more realistic, bcz the harmonic projection on ETH ~$3200 - 3300 after $1360 pullback, so maybe only ~0.5× leverage if that. Other scenario is DOGE:BTC declines to 0.03 as BTC rallies to ~57k, thus $0.17. If 2019 repeats altcoins underperform.

snapshot
Note
Pullback to 20.4k then next week or first of February one final move to 25.2k? After that a pullback into Feb/Mar for the right Head of a bullish, inverse H&S? So far my projections have been hit precisely.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Correction: 22.4k pullback.
Note
Bitcoin low is in until after a major rally.

youtu.be/6JGlU5gJnBM
(Bitcoin The Macro Low Is In For Price [statistics])
Note
Very likely to get rejected at ~25K and a major pullback but not lower than ~17.5k. Then on up from there.

youtu.be/RxV3kiDnP7M?t=169
(BITCOIN: THIS IS YOUR FINAL WARNING!!!!! DON’T SCREW THIS UP!!!! 🚨 [the ONLY thing that matters NOW] | Crypto Zombie)
Note
Headed back to 25k.

youtu.be/5QnlQ2XRXA8?t=154
(History is About to Repeat on Bitcoin. | Why PAIN for Crypto Investors Continues. Wyckoff Analysis)
Note
EDIT: Bitcoin low is in until after a major rally. Wave B of an A-B-C correction is underway.

youtu.be/6JGlU5gJnBM
(Bitcoin The Macro Low Is In For Price [statistics])
Note
Bitcoin is overdue for a pullback retest, but I think it will make one more move up to between the 200 WMA (~24.6k) and 50 WMA (~25.9k) but most likely not higher than horizontal resistance ~24.9k. This could be a wick up and might be difficult to sell if don't have limit orders waiting. There's strong confluence (200 DMA and former downtrend line resistance turned support) around a pullback price ~19.6k.

snapshot

Frankly the downtrend resistance for that next move up looks dubious on the BTC and S&P charts. Immediate drop would fit the T/A well, but an overshoot of the more solid downtrend line seems to be likely to lure in FOMO for the bull trap and presumably so many shorts with SLs at those too obvious overhead, downtrend resistance lines.

snapshot

snapshot

Whereas ETH sports a less dubious wick up to $1775 - 1800, then pullback to $1375 - 1400.

snapshot

Supported by Nasdaq which appears to have more upside as I don't think that bearish H&S is valid.

snapshot

And VIX not yet hit up trendline target.

snapshot

Dollar could make one more drive down.

snapshot
Note
Steve @ Crypto Crew University has essentially the same outlook as I do. Up to his one red MA curve just below 25K, then down to his other red MA vurve ~19.6k. After that the bull run probably continues into Q2.

youtu.be/TLSrOpjbkSc
(Bitcoin About To Have GOLDEN CROSS – It’s NOT What You Think)
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


> > > Better watch out for underestimating BTC's momentum. It's a momentum acceleration game. It is possible that BTC will catch the God Candle, I mean, over 20% in 1 day.
> >
> > goodblackcat, I do not have enough fingers to count how many times you have been wrong since I have known you over the past 2+ years. Yes Bitcoin is going to complete wave B in Q2 of an A-B-C correction. But there will likely be a final scare before the real liftoff.
>
> shelby3, Amen to that!


goodblackcat, bull trap then bear trap pullback around this breakout level, then rally into Q2. C.f. my latest updates. I don't think you can be correct that this runs away from us on the bullish side directly, because we need to give the bears one more chance to short the retest thinking it will crash to 11k, lol. Also the bulls will FOMO like mad on any wick breakout which then ideally would fail. Also there are bearish divergences developing.
Note
Looking at the Market Calender, perhaps that GDP report on Thursday will be the impetus to push the market one final wick higher. But either the PCE report on Friday or the actual Fed funds rate decision on next Wednesday Feb 1 could start the pullback.

Because there's too much speculation now that the Fed could pause (futures market is betting 33%) or only do 0.25 (67%). Fed is likely to hold off on pivoting from "we will hold rates high for a long-time" (until the March or April meeting), as the bond market has been saying recently they will not be able to do (possible reason for the pump in the markets and for the Nasdaq starting to come alive a bit growth P/E multiples very interest rate sensitive).

youtube.com/watch?v=bSQCsZVukog&lc=UgxPvWI8El08ntUdxwx4AaABAg
(Breaking News! 🔥 BLS Will Change How they Compute CPI Thus Drop Faster)

> The Fed uses PCE as their main base rather than CPI. I do think it might trap a lot of retail investors getting excited into pushing money into the market early.

youtu.be/b33ll3R1z2s?t=656
(Bond market leading the Fed back down | Meet Kevin)

Some other videos from Meet Kevin showing that the BLS is going to reinterpret data to support a Fed pivot. Also he had a video which I can't find quickly, where he showed the Fed would change how they interpret owners equivalent rents lag to bring their CPI number down faster as well. So a lot of speculation that Fed pivots in February but Fed will likely disappoint one more time.

youtu.be/sRTw2GNzaLI
(A Key Part of the Fed *JUST* Flipped.)

youtu.be/rnWD_zOPY6A
(The Fed was LIED to *AGAIN* -- SHOCKING Reveal.)
Note
Here We Go Again – Altering the Formula for CPI

There are some who are claiming that the revision of the CPI is to help the Federal Reserve stop fighting inflation.

{...}

This is NOT about helping the Fed to lower rates or stop raising rates as the majority seem to be touting. Powell is not that stupid and this will have ZERO impact on Fed decisions going forward. This is all about government spending which is a far greater problem than worrying about the pressure of the Fed. Virtually EVERY program is automatically INDEXED to CPI. Thus, agencies’ budgets are automatically increased each year based on the CPI. Your taxes are indexed to the CPI. By reducing the CPI, they collect more taxes! There is NOBODY in Congress or at the Bureau of Labor Statistics that gives the Fed a second thought.
Note
Ron Walker's latest. I think he's too bearish (especially expecting major new lows on S&P and Nasdaq), but at least he now recognizes the possibility of a inverted H&S forming with a pullback on Bitcoin. And he see that we could be in a wave B or a A-B-C correction (he labels it W-X-Y instead).

youtu.be/PWtFiyU5IzY
(If You Believe The Bitcoin Crash Is Over You're In For A Rude Awakening - BTC Crash Coming!)

youtu.be/aCxhZ1H2f5A
(If You Believe The Stock Market CRASH Is Over You're In For A Rude Awakening- KING Of All Indicators)
Note
FX Evolution agrees with me. Pullback starting in February.

Another factor is the commodity prices heading back up due to China reopening. This could be another FUD to support a pullback.

youtu.be/SmA5XX1Thig
(Buy The Rumor Sell The Fact Stock Market Trap?)
Note
Kyle @ Crypto Banter essentially agrees with me (and bottom is behind us for this wave B) but he doesn't discount a massive wick to close January. I doubt this based on Eric Krown Crypto's statistical analyses. 21:10 The Wycoff analysis in my interpretation (currently early in phase D) seems to indicate a pullback from ~25K (to end phase D), then a massive rally (for phase E) heading into March or April.

I like his recommendations at the end to buy DOGE, SOL and MATIC and sell $1.10, $36, $1.25 for 25 - 50% gains this week.

youtu.be/7nXR8z4rTiw
(Is Bitcoin About To Have Another Massive Breakout?)
Note
ETH Bigger Picture (Supplement)


The BAT harmonic is projecting to 3200 perhaps in April or May. If BTC tops ~25K with a retest of ~19.6k, ETH should pullback from ~$1800 to ~$1400. Else if BTC goes parabolic to ~28k, then ETH to ~$2000 with a pullback below 17k.

snapshot
Note
I was forehead-on-the-keyboard last night as I was watching this, I didn't have time to share it before I crashed in the bed. I did however sell all my altcoins before sleeping to reevaluate in the morning. I woke up and the dip Sheldon @ Crypto Banter was expecting has already occurred. So I am re-accumulating now. He only expects ~$28 move for SOL(ana), not $36.

youtu.be/jt5W2ChVhms?t=1357
(Altcoins' Next Moves Mapped Out?)
Note
Bitcoin to correct back to ~$21.2 and ETH to ~$1400? That's clearly a mini Wycoff distribution.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin retest incoming:

youtu.be/cIzVfqhTkWw
(Breaking: Bitcoin Just Entered Gaussian Channel For FIRST TIME SINCE 2018)
Note
Markets appear to be in topping process prepping for a pullback retest. Might shoot up on more time this week.
Note
Armstrong's latest private blog is supporting my expectation of pullback (at least for gold), then rallying higher perhaps into April or summer. Perhaps risk-on markets peak in April?

armstrongeconomics.com/markets-by-sector/private-blog-the-close-of-january-2023/

My comment on the following video:

youtube.com/watch?v=iS8--HcO5w4&lc=Ugzhb1bA4HRXbE-0xGZ4AaABAg
(Black swan event to crash all markets within 60 days! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

> "I have to charts that show we are about to have an epic crash for the stock market, oil and bitcoin. This crash will take place within the next 60 days. This will be a black swan even that will finally pop the everything bubble."

Could it push above the ring for a couple of months, then ride down the ring as it did on the prior ring? That would fit better with my long-standing projections for a rally into April/May then a crash no later than Q1 2024.
Note
Gareth thinks Bitcoin will come back down again.

youtu.be/oswt2FaLkvI
(Gareth Soloway Update: Leaving Soon - This Time Is So Different.)
Note
Amazing how Bitcoin is tracking gold so precisely but with a lag. And Martin Armstrong still doesn't believe Bitcoin will become the new gold and the new world reserve currency, lol. 🤦🙈

twitter.com/TechDev_52/status/1618420018664046598
(What if #Bitcoin continues to follow Gold / DXY ?)
Note
Is Bitcoin still in a Wycoff accumulation pattern and thus to come back down to test lows one more time? Recent rally a short-covering rally only?

youtu.be/hefoG8hHwRc?t=583
(BUSTED! Whales’ playbook for 2023 | CTO LARSSON)
Note
Repeating pattern from 2015 would expect a another retest of lows.

youtu.be/EkRK_BQ89g0?t=374
(Will It GET WORSE For Bitcoin | C.C.U.)

2018 didn't have same pattern (not 3 tests of yellow MA and red MA wasn't curling down)

youtu.be/0pw55R0dDew?t=110
(Bitcoin Faces MEGA FORCEFIELD | C.C.U.) ««« 2 mos ago
Note
Whether there's a correction first—which I think is likely at least for the right shoulder of an inverse H&S (if not still in Wycoff accumulation)—Bitcoin is likely to shoot rapidly up to ~$35+k to catch up to gold. Then gold is likely to break out after that to repeat the outperformance from 2019 to 2020. I'm expecting 3k gold in 2024—likely due to escalation of NATO vs. Russia war. Gold is getting stronger, whilst Bitcoin is weakening (this should continue until legacy Bitcoin is restored as the Phoenix world reserve currency).

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Although Bitcoin is threatening to breakout to 30k, it looks like it's almost done and we will get a correction into March or April to get one more opportunity to buy nearer to 20k before the actual 2023 Fed pivot rally. The bond markets have reversed and are pricing in a Fed funds terminal rate far above 5%. Looks like the market is going to be shocked soon and we will get one more selloff.

youtu.be/krZ1oU1moQo
(Bad News: Bitcoin TORNADO WARNING | Crypto Crew U.)

Steve the bond market has suddenly U-turned pricing in a Fed funds rate far above 5%. Looks the Fed is going to slam the markets back down one more time.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=SkLUIsHmAJk&lc=UgzB3uobAk8VdmbNPzp4AaABAg
(Bitcoin The Macro Picture Changes Tonight [statistics] | Eric Krown Crypto)

The bond market u-turned and is pricing a massively higher Fed funds terminal rate. This looks like a bull trap. The macro indicators you cited also have examples where the price came back down to test the low, e.g. 2015. There's bearish divergences all over, e.g. DJIA Transports vs. Industrials, junk bonds not making a higher high, lower highs on the daily RSI, etc.. Bitcoin might make one last gasp up, but that should be all, until a retest nearer to 20k. Or maybe this is some Wycoff retracement of the May/Jane capitulation and there is wild final green dildo up to 30k, then the retest.
Note
Very likely to come back down as in 2015, not continue up as in 2019. I think Bitcoin comes back down to ~20k form a right shoulder of a bullish, inverse H&S pattern.

youtu.be/ozPXRJy6SwQ
(WOW! Bitcoin Just Flashed GREEN On Gaussian Channel | Crypto Crew U.)
Note
youtu.be/BQY370P6aHY?t=292
(The Biggest World Debt Market Is Starting To Flash RED! FX Evolution)

4:52 chart of bond market u-turn since Feb 10. Last rate hike projected at July 25 Fed meeting.

6:17 chart of timing of Fed pause, cuts and stock markets. Stock market should rally until Fed pauses.

6:58 stock market should peak ~45 days before last rate hike, bcz highly inverted yield curve. Thus expect summer rally to end in early June.
Note
Some officials wanted a 50 basis rate hike in February. Market about to be slammed back down!

Everyone seems to have forgotten that China reopened. This has sent commodities back up.

youtu.be/kT3svvNEqRk?t=153
(The February Fed Minutes May Reveal That Rates Have To Go Much Higher | Mott Capital Management, LLC)
Note
My charts on Feb 15 showed that gold has been more bullish than Bitcoin, as was the case in 2019, before Bitcoin rallied to catch up. See that gold is about to breakout to 3k as in did in H2 2019. The 2019 - 2020 is repeat as I identified as a repeating fractal back in summer of 2021!. I was so prescient and early. Then after the 14K peak in 2019, gold outperformed until after the March 2020 flash crash. Remember I am expecting a repeat of this pattern with a flash crash in Q1 or Q2 2024, except it will be worse with Bitcoin to make a lower low in 2024 ~10k. So I am expecting a correction into March/April, then a rally in June where Bitcoin catches up to gold as it did in 2019. Then underperformance of Bitcoin relative to gold until the crash in 2024.

GoT is seeing the same strength in gold on the stocks-to-gold ratio. Looks like one final rally on this chart for stocks into June, then gold will outperform from 2023 to 2024.

So I am looking to sell some Bitcoin in June, wait for a slight correction in gold, then buy and hold gold until 2024. Repurchase Bitcoin ~10k in 2024.

youtu.be/1-e5jgIumTA
( We Saw This Happen on the SP500 4 Times Throughout History | It Signaled Massive Turning Points. | Game of Trades)
Note
Exactly. Need some correction action before resuming 2023 summer rally.

youtu.be/a70G-E-FWKQ
(Bad News: GAUSSIAN Channel TROUBLE)
Note
My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=xp3cga1aOv0&lc=UgwvWj9M2T-ZfqZPTe54AaABAg
(Bitcoin Is $28,000 Reasonable In March [price statistics] | Eric Krown Crypto)

So essentially this week is critical as to whether this is a bull trap or not. If Friday closes below 24k, probably headed back down to at least the bottom of the Gaussian channel ~20k. Else up to ~28k. What you're failing to zoom in on is that even in 2019, the bottom of the Gaussian channel was retested before breaking through the median. Ditto 2015. Even the green MA was always retested after yellow MA crossoever which is ~21k.
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


> > "Now or never? BTC $24,944 igniter."
>
> "dump pattern"


goodblackcat, I upvoted your other comment:
2023 - Year From Hell


Yeah looks like the pullback scenario will play out starting at end of the week? If so might need to retest lower than 21.1k? Maybe ~20k.
Note
I'm buying this dip. This appears to be the BU/SOS phase of a textbook Wycoff accumulation (school.stockcharts.com/doku.php?id=market_analysis:the_wyckoff_method) pattern (click link to see accumulation and distribution charts). About to enter Phase E with a rocket launch to 30k? Other possibility is that the SOS/BU has turned into a smaller Wycoff distribution with UT completed but a possible higher high UTAD incoming before a further pullback into the $20 - 21k region (to form the right shoulder of a bullish, inverse H&S). Either way it makes sense to dollar cost average into some here below 24k. Not likely that price is headed back below 19.5k until 2024 and after a significant rally sometime before July.

snapshot
Note
Even the uber bearish Ron Walker who has been bearish during the entire ~50% rise off the bottom (back when I correctly identified a Wycoff accumulation and told everyone to buy back in below 16k), thinks Bitcoin could make a higher high.

Fucking retard keeps boasting (SO SICK OF HIM BOASTING FOR 40 MINS, CAN NOT GET DIRECT TO THE POINT SUCCINCTLY) about calling the top (well yeah I sold 66k also!) and refuses to admit he totally fucked up calling the bottom and is still calling for 9k. And he wonders why nobody wants to donate to his Paypal.

youtu.be/Z5ESFuN5Ijc?t=904
(click for the chart of his moonboy oscillator)
Note
S&P wants to bounce possibly to 4300. Both BTC and S&P now have bullish RSI divergences on the daily. Nasdaq is still within a broadening wedge pattern, which is bullish for now. Also both have harmonic bottoming patterns projecting for massive rallies ongoing. Ron Walker is drinking too much Koolaid. Finally he admits there could be another bounce. Again I do agree there could be one final pullback to $20 - 21k for Bitcoin in March or April. But there's also a risk of exploding to 30k because Bitcoin is doing the same catching up to gold it did in 2019 after the Chinese New Year and Hong Kong is opening Bitcoin buying to all Chinese suddenly & massive stimulus being poured into Bitcoin.

youtu.be/1iXJPB0vHlI
(Stock Market CRASH: S&P 500 Bounces Off 4 Trendlines & The 50 Day Moving Average - Bounce Likely | Ron Walker)

snapshot

snapshot
Note
There's no doubt (even Ron Walker admits it) that there will be huge rally incoming very soon in 2023. There only question is whether there will be a slight pullback first. Ron Walker is delusional call for lower lows.

youtu.be/_HkVXb6lh-M
(Bitcoin MOTHER OF ALL SIGNALS Prints For ONLY 5th Time Ever | Crypto Crew U.)
Note
My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=RR6SzgYYo6E&lc=UgwxWZfN7zBltkfmZvF4AaABAg
(Top for Bitcoin if Bull Run & Bottom if Bear Market! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

Correct, the Fed will surprise with 50 basis points in March, but this will only provide a pullback not a crash, because the market is pricing in the pause in May. Historically there is a final rally when the Fed pauses then the markets tank as they begin to pivot lower on interest rates. Lower low not until 2024. As I have been telling you since summer of 2021, that the 2019 to 2020 pattern would repeat. We are in a Wycoff accumulation now with the bottom behind us. Will rally up to at least 30k if not 57k, possibly with a retest of 21k in March. Then it will roll-over with the recession in 2024 and make a lower low at your red trend line. Yes your 9k is coming but not until after an epic 2023 rally.
Note
BTC near term projection
Note
youtu.be/8ZqJZ7UzRiE?t=357
(click for the chart)

GoT are you blind? The stock market kept rising until the unemployment rate started to rise in several instances, even after a significant correction before the final leg up. You were mentioning this months ago. Why suddenly you change your message and are all worried about the stock market crashing which will not happen until the Fed begins to ease!
Note
I sold the BTC I had purchased the prior day at no loss right after the PCE inflation report came out hot, bcz I observed the S&P breaking down through support. But the support has held on a wick and BTC came down to the stronger support level, so I am reloading for another final push up before the major correction. Bullish daily or 4-hourly RSI divergence. BTC could push down to ~22.5k for better divergence.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Very likely Bitcoin is going to have a deeper correction, before rallying to $30+k. Yet I think likely one more attempt to break above 25K will occur first.

youtu.be/CQtBpdYIbdA
(Bitcoin WORST CASE SCENARIO | Crypto Crew U.)
Note
Get your cash positioned and ready to buy in March. A correction is incoming.

My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=CQtBpdYIbdA&lc=Ugw692U6KQbkTMQH8Ax4AaABAg

Steve given the double top and double bottom mirroring, why not a mirroring in terms of this incoming correction to bottom at the first of the double bottom, thus forming a massively bullish, inverse H&S pattern? This would also keep Bitcoin in its Wycoff accumulation pattern with the correction being the LPS before the Phase 2 parabolic rocket. There is a small Wycoff distribution ongoing now, so perhaps one final stab at 25K, then the pullback to ~17.5 to 20k.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/iRsCffkOT6Y?t=164
(Bitcoin FIRST SINCE 2019! Get Ready | Crypto Crew U.)

2:43 Incorrect. This deceleration of Bitcoin is an omen that the price will crash to below 10k in 2024, before the next higher-high bull run resumes. And the non-legacy (aka "official") protocol Bitcoin (actually the 2017 soft-fork impostor) might NEVER make another new ATH after the looming anyone can spend Nash equilibrium restoration event "attack." The legacy protocol will ATH in 2025/2026 but most hodlers including you will be fleeced because you ostensibly did not heed my email warnings to you last year.
Note
Click for screen captures...

{ Album }
Posted: twitter.com/shelbyhmooreiii/status/1629298837134225409

youtu.be/iRsCffkOT6Y?t=164

2:43 deceleration of ₿ is a crash omen below 10k in 2024…non-legacy (aka “official”) protocol ₿ (…the 2017 soft-fork impostor) might NEVER make…new ATH…looming ANYONECANSPEND Nash equilibrium restoration event “attack…”

archive.is/6vZMN
Note
9 minutes into Ron's latest, I was nodding my head and about to send you a kudos for being professional and respectful. Think I could eventually support your channel, if you can continue that professionalism. And then you just couldn't stop yourself from ridiculing others "Koolaid" etc..

You seriously need to go to remedial class in how to interact with the public. Nobody likes a boastful person. We all know the markets run on greater fool theory. Stop using it to boast about yourself!!!!!!!!

YOU SUCK RON. You do some decent analysis but your enunciation needs some serious remedial education.

youtu.be/DItiMbn9bAE
Note
Excellent video. FX Evolution has also been pointing out that March is typically down for markets. Crypto Crew U. also pointed out that a possible correction into late March before the resumption. April should close green, thus another rally up. He's also agreeing with my extrapolated target of June from FX Evolution for the top of this 2023 rally.

youtu.be/sZKSrDDB8y0
(#BITCOIN: DUMPS!!! What does SEASONALITY tell us??? | Kevin Svenson Crypto)
Note
My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=kGQZE2-Duxg&lc=UgynBT878Xe15h2icRx4AaABAg.9mZrsEwOiOo9m_eBrFZS0U
(Warning: This Bitcoin Chart is Pointing to TWO New Targets (good and bad news))

Alessio Rastani you have several mistakes. I am very familiar with Steve Courtney's 5.3 factor model. First that would be the high in 2025, not 2023. Just look at the high in 2019, which corresponds to 2023. Secondly the low will be in 2024 with a lower low. In 2020, the flash crash was not a lower, but it will be lower in 2024. The 2017 NY agreement impostor Bitcoin will NEVER make another higher all-time high. Mark my word.
Note
I sold. I think this will come down at least to next lower purple trend line before any significant bounce.

snapshot
Note
I don't have time to clean up this chart right now. I just want to focus on the cyan trend line that marked the top in 2019. It's indicating ~$30 - 36k for the top of this summer 2023 bull trap. Note the harmonic projection to below $0 in 2024 (it ends down off the bottom of the chart).

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin is headed to the $30 - 35k no later than June. Any higher low must be bought. Ron Walker is fucking delusional calling for lower-lows on Bitcoin. He missed the 50% bull run off the bottom. And he is probably going to miss the move to $30+k also.

youtu.be/-qPYPsu-VLc
(The Macro Case For Bitcoin)
Note
Excellent. Validates my recent points about what I expect for Bitcoin.

youtu.be/jhNtMTobm_c
( #Bitcoin's Price @ 4th Halving = ??? | Kevin Svenson Crypto)
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/uA2-FtSJ8p8
(Start of 60% bitcoin crash in March of 2023! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

1:49 price is headed up to above 30k at the intersection of your two fib circles, after a higher low correction. You will be REKTD.
Note
Btw, I repurchased 0.5 BTC expecting another ~10% bounce which I will sell. I might buy up to 1 BTC if it drops to ~22.6k again.

After the bounce, I expect a sharp decline into March which I will buy hand & fist with all my sidelined cash.

Expecting a rally into June ~$30 - 35k.

I will sell that June peak and wait for a significant market drop. Then I will buy gold and hold until the crash I expect in Q1 or Q2 2024. I will sell the gold and buy Bitcoin ~10k in 2024 and hodl for $60+k in 2025.
Note
My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=gUZ4XUDTQnY&lc=Ugy_DB0Zb_7TcI_57pZ4AaABAg
(This is the 4th Time in Stock Market History We See This. | A Massive False Breakout. | Game of Trades)

GoT you're wrong and I will tell you exactly what is different this time from those prior three instances 1974, 2001, and 2008. Specifically there is a bullish Shark harmonic bottom that formed this time pointing up to as high as 4800. Now it is possible for the price to come down to 3500 and form a second bullish Shark harmonic bottom pointing up as low as 4650. Either way, the egregious crash you are currently calling for is not going to happen. You had shown us in 2022 that markets typically turn bullish as the Fed pauses and then crash as the Fed begins to cut. There will be some choppiness in March (and potentially April), then the rally will continue to a peak by June based on the timing I worked out from FX Evolution's recent videos. Also Bitcoin had a Wycoff bottom, likely currently in Phase D. Or in Phase B with a final wick lower low incoming if S&P makes lower low. But indications are higher lows only incoming.
Note
Absolutely no way that Bitcoin is going to an egregiously lower low in 2023— will make those crash lows in 2024 after a significant rally in 2023. Ron Walker, OPTICALARTdotCOM and Game of Trades are smoking crack.

youtu.be/h0rImQwhH5g
(Bitcoin It Finally Happened [price statistics] | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
Here's what I am referring to about Bitcoin undergoing a Wycoff accumulation bottom.

youtu.be/sGio6NdcVEQ
(Smart Money is Fooling Retail Bitcoin Investors, Again. | Beware of USD Pressure, Wyckoff Analysis | Jason Pizzino)

Another indicator that Bitcoin has either bottomed or will approximately double-bottom.

youtu.be/ytOWxEvlReU
(Warning: EVERYONE IS WRONG About Bitcoin Right Now | Crypto Crew U.)
Note
[ Album ]
Bitcoin has dropped into the top of my buy zone. Probably bounce here. Might come down some more, but I doubt below ~19.8k.

snapshot

Apology this next chart has collected too many annotations. Focus only on the cyan overhead resistance lines and the cyan measured projection of the current potential inverse H&S. Take profit targets are $31.9, 34.5k and a wick to ~38.5k. Expecting a repeat of 2019, with a summer rally that fizzles out and eventually rolls over down to ~$9 - 10k in 2024.

snapshot
Note
Let's not forget that ETH has a bullish BAT harmonic pattern projecting to ~$3250. Looks like ETH wants to back test ~$1500 with the lowest ~$1400 but I doubt below ~$1470 if that.

snapshot

ETH/BTC broke up out of a small bullish declining wedge and looks headed up to 0.083 - 0.09. Which thus correlates ~$3250 with the highs I expect for Bitcoin. Should be buying some ETH on this decline. ETH has some upgrade coming in about a month.

snapshot
Note
Remember what I wrote on Jan 24:

ETH Bigger Picture (Supplement)


The BAT harmonic is projecting to 3200 perhaps in April or May. If BTC tops ~25K with a retest of ~19.6k, ETH should pullback from ~$1800 to ~$1400. Else if BTC goes parabolic to ~28k, then ETH to ~$2000 with a pullback below 17k.
Note
Meet Kevin makes a compelling argument that it's unlikely that inflation is about to skyrocket again. Thus the Fed is almost done raising rates and may not even go 50 basis points in March. Likely some fear around the 10th and 14th and possibly even the Fed meeting on the 22nd. Choppiness is mostly due to fear. While the smart money has been buying this pullback.

youtu.be/vOOjVose_FA
(The Hell that's Coming | Punishing Fed.)

Ron Walker's ego has overruled his ability to think clearly. Boasting that he called every top and bottom when in fact he failed to call this recent bottom missing out on a 50% gain for Bitcoin. And still expecting Bitcoin to crash to 8k soon. Anyone listening to him is going to miss the entire summer rally.

youtu.be/a06IA1fdHmw
(Bitcoin May Rally To 27K Before A Bigger BTC CRASH Happens With The Fed Or Next Inflation Reports)
Note
FX Evolution points out that risk on has been dominating this selloff, indicating that the bullishness has not subsided yet. Institutions piled on this pullback. He mentions that if stagflation is trapping the Fed, expect gold to fly later in 2023, which is exactly what I have been expecting.

youtu.be/JbKMJkzWOJU
(Wall Street Are About To Set The TRAP?)
Note
FreeMoneyCrypto FreeMoneyCrypto, {3/3/23 3:12 AM}
last cycle it was Tone Vay's friend from Wall Street the late Tyler Jenks calling for ridiculous lows like 1k. now theres a few of them. Gareth Solodoom, Ron Walker and others.

Munjeviti Jurić, {3/3/23 4:25 AM}
I belieive we bottomed in stocks and yields yesterday...metals on 28th..bitcoin is close to bottom maybe 20-21k !.. melt up starting.. new highs in parabolic fashion..buy now or never
Reminder me later to not sell and to wait for 10y at 2%!!!

Shelby Moore ⏱🌐🧖, {3/3/23 5:17 AM}
Also OPTICALARTdotCOM and now suprisingly Game of Trades flip-flopped from his prior excellent reasoning that the final bullish move is as the market prices in the Fed's pause. Those guys will end up correct in 2024, but after entirely missing this summer's rally.

Shelby Moore ⏱🌐🧖, {3/3/23 5:20 AM}
I will make sure you sell in May/June at the top and not wait for rates to start coming down, which always corresponds to the recessionary crash.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=cMH0zXJINow&lc=UgyhYJ9TJ5BBACHbmRF4AaABAg
(bitcoin price prediction? | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

@OPTICALARTdotCOM that's wise you flipped to long. Bitcoin is in the Phase D of a Wycoff accumulation about to go parabolic to $30+k after this pullback. After this summer rally, markets will decline to sideways as they did in 2019, and then crash into 2024 as the Fed breaks the economy by holding rates too high for too long. I will sell Bitcoin in June, wait for a pullback and then buy gold. Gold goes crazy in stagflation as it did in late 2019. Bitcoin is currently catching up to gold as it did into summer 2019. The 2019 to 2020 pattern is repeating as I predicted it would in summer 2021 when I also predicted Bitcoin would decline to test between $13.5 to 20k. Your 9k is coming but not until 2024. Don't get REKTD. Look at that Shark harmonic bottom on S&P projecting up to ~4800. And the Bat harmonic bottom on ETH projecting up to $3250. Come on man, the markets always rally as they price in the Fed's looming pause. This FUD about inflation returning is a buying opportunity for this summer rally.
Note
youtu.be/b_T5P5LF3o8
(Bitcoin The Low Is In [price statistics] | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
I don't like the recent price action on Bitcoi. I sold. Will just wait for the pullback. I will forsake any bounce that may or might not occur before the pullback.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/Ow4D8FUA2cU
(This Warned the SP500 Bull Traps in 2008 and 2001 | Investors are Wrong About The Economic Recovery | Game of Trades)

Problem with using a bottom in unemployment as a timing indicator, is that the stock market peaked well before unemployment bottomed, unlike the prior cases. COVID messed up the supply chains sending inflation up at the same time that consumers were flush with cash. Thus risk on took a big hit early than it would have otherwise if an organic situation. Thus risk on likely to catch up with unemployment bottoming and form a second peak perhaps a lower-high, but higher than the current bounce level as the Fed signals a pause will be coming.
Note
Nostradamus predicted last October 2022.

> Natural Gas has a Shark pattern projection to below $3:
>
> snapshot


Nailed that one.
Note
I do think there will be a bounce this week to 23.2k. From there it could possibly try again for 25k. There's hidden bullish divergence compared to Feb 10-13. And this accumulation looks ditto of Feb 10-13.

snapshot

Eric Krown Crypto thinks so also:

youtu.be/OucGLKb2eJ0
(Bitcoin 24 Hours For Price)

Expecting ~7% bounce for ETH compared to ~3.5% for BTC.
Note
This chart screams that Bitcoin is going to explode to the upside as soon as the Fed pause is being priced in. Compare to 2019. Stonks have been a bit less sensitive to FEDFUNDS continuing to increase because earnings were sustained and some had pricing power. Also Bitcoin was broadsided by FTX. Appears the market is trying to price in a 50 basis points raise in March, but markets seems to be mostly brushing it off and pricing in the pause that is coming by summer. Yet bond markets (c.f. linked video below) are too bearish bcz expecting Fed to raise slowly and not pause until Sept. I expect Fed will go 50 basis in Mar, 25 in April and then data will cause them to pause! I bet the market will sniff this out soon and rally steeply and suddenly!

snapshot

Notice that forward earnings didn't quite go negative in 2019. Looks like Bitcoin (no earnings) will outperform stonks when the Fed pause is priced early this summer.

youtu.be/TtqCw0-_h_4?t=190
(3:10 c.f. chart)
Note
Also note from chart in my prior post, that as the FedFunds pivoted lower (not just paused) in 2019, the crash was delayed unlike prior instances. Ostensibly because the Fed was responding to Libor financial stress abroad.

I expecting a redux of the March flash crash in 2024. This seems to indicate that the stress will once again be outside the U.S., i.e. China's debt bubble so desperate they locked down entire population to prevent runs on the banks. Now they are giving stimi-loans to the morbidly elderly. Will a global cyberattack false-flag be the only alternative to China attacking Taiwan as a scapegoat for martial law? 🤔

youtu.be/eeFPhDb77XA
(The Stock Market Is Setting Up For A BIG MOVE Again... 100 Years Of Data! | FX Evolution) <-- click for relevant charts
Note
Imagine the supply chain destruction and stimulus the Fed would need to inject after/during a cyberattack cratering of the economy? COVID 2.0.
Note
Loading my crypto bags now!

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
youtu.be/3V29PAyowKM
(The Patterns of History continue to Play Out on the SP500. | Why Sentiment Doesn't Change Macro | Game of Trades)

BS. Every time the 50 DMA golden crosses the 200 DMA after a long correction, that marks the start of a significant bull phase. Your failure cases were all just minor corrections along the way in a bull run. Sheesh. Come on man, your analysis is really starting to suck lately. I used to follow you. The weakening economy is out-of-sync with the Fed rate cycle nearing a pause with employment still holding up. Fed started rate hikes out-of-phase because of artificial effect of pandemic. The golden cross is pricing in the eventual Fed pause. The market typically makes final rally into pause. You can't compare to the recession bottoms as our recession crash hasn't even started yet, as that will be coming in 2024.
Note
Meet Kevin had dinner with Peter Schiff and Schiff's Bitcoin aficionado son. They discussed enforcement of smart contracts, "Who owns the militia?"

Kevin discusses the importance of Friday's job report on market direction.

youtu.be/BTS6MKjr0cY?t=1365
Note
Kevin confirmed my thesis!!! BTFD!
Note
youtu.be/6er6EJK9JtI
(Stock Contrarians are Investing *HERE* | Meet Kevin)

Best way to be hedged long against EPS downgrades is to hold Bitcoin, as it has no earnings! It is playing catch up!
Note
youtu.be/xW-nezNSIV0
(This might be a good time to exit Bitcoin and the Stock Market! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

This is complete, utter nonsense. Overlay the FedFunds on your DJIA chart. You will see the recessionary crash never occurs until after the Fed pauses and begins to cut rates. We are no where near the recessionary crash yet. The markets rally into the Fed pause. You will be REKTD!!!
Note
FTX taken down so that BlackRock and WallStreet could prevent any competition to their incoming 666 CBDC enslavement plans.

youtu.be/064KLVW9M1E
(Silvergate Bankrupt!! What it Means For Crypto! | Coin Bureau)
Note
Potential failure of Silicon Valley Bank is causing the bond market to suddenly call the Fed's bluff and push projections of Fed Funds rate hikes down.

youtu.be/XIeK_ROxOJ4?t=290
(Is NOW Our Stock Market Breaking Point? | FX Evolution)
Note
BTC maybe down to ~19.1k and ETH ~$1360.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Again Ron Walker is smoking crack with his call for new all-time lows. Nasdaq is bull flagging. Has a harmonic projecting up to 390+.

snapshot
Note
Ron Walker continues his insulting, logorrheic, vengeful diatribes towards all cryptocurrency investors. Continues to scream that Bitcoin will go to 9k and claims he was right and we were all wrong. When in fact we sold the 24k top and called for a higher-low pullback. And we bought 15.8k and rode it up to 24k when he failed to call the bottom and only thought it might bounce to 19k at most (and he was not sure it would even bottom). So now he lying and claiming he called the bottom when in fact he missed the entire 50% rally all the way up and is about to miss the next phase of the rally.

youtu.be/x_Fu99NBVcA
(Bitcoin CRASH As Predicted - BTC Down 22.22 % - The Sell Signals Nailed It Again!)
Note
Back down to the bottom of the Gaussian band expectedly as I had publicly stated it would. E.K.C. also has a possible downside wick to 19.07k as I do arrived but a different methodology. Likelihood of a bounce soon is high.

youtu.be/6GvMGQwiqt8?t=217
(Bitcoin Is Down Bad & What's Next [price statistics])
Note
> > "Best way to be hedged long against EPS downgrades is to hold Bitcoin, as it has no earnings! It is playing catch up!"
>
> "@S.Moore lol"


Soniel Elica Bitcoin has been catching up to gold as the Fed's pause is nearing same as it did in 2019. Bitcoin will run to 35k, while gold only to ~$2075 this summer, then 2019 will repeat and a nasty crash in 2024 same as 2020. I predicted this all publicly in the summer 2021 which I identified the repeating megaphone pattern on my trading view. Get a life please.
Note
I want to remind everyone that the video I had linked about the Wycoff Accumulation pattern bottom does allow for not being in Phase D, but rather in Phase B, where the bottoming process would be of a longer duration sideways, with Bitcoin to come back down to retest lows, possibly even slightly lower. But that's the lower probability outcome because for example we see that the Nasdaq is bull flagging and back testing the major overhead resistance lines it broke up out of. Ron Walker dismisses those trend lines and claims stonks will make new lows.

The other reasons that not likely in an extended bottoming process is include the fact that the Fed is already breaking things such as Silicon Valley Bank. Also the jobs strength was apparently because of the unseasonably warm winter, so more employees were retained but hours worked per week declined, as well hourly wage was disinflationary. Also the January BLS bullshit was really just about seasonal adjustments, meaning that the reality is anything the BLS wants it to be. So if Yellen calls up the BLS and tells them to make the jobs report soft tomorrow, then so it will be.

As consumers have been running up their credit cards with higher interest rates on balances, and post-pandemic child care returning to pre-covidiocy norms, females are rushing back into the workplace thus setting up for an increase in unemployment or other metrics such as average hours worked per week.

IOW, this Fed will have to raise rates insanely into summer is likely FUD. Ron Walker will eat his hat if so.

Powell clearly alluded to the unseasonable warm weather, and the recent data perhaps being an anomaly.

Fed will probably surprise and raise only 25 basis points and then signal that they're almost done. Markets will have a face ripping rally into April and Ron Walker will finally go hide under a rock where his diarrhea mouth belongs.
Note
Exactly as I stated/predicted. Listen on double-speed playback to at least the 5min mark.

youtu.be/YkHMbPICBvY?t=37
(The Disastrous Jobs Report & Fed Impact | Meet Kevin)

Fed may be forced to pause in March!!! Or signal an imminent pause after March hike. Bank failures have arrived. Remember in leaked video the FDIC opined a (nation-wide?) bank holiday could be announced on a Friday evening.

youtu.be/aMp6ezT70kY
(A *MASSIVE* Bank Run *JUST* Started | DO THIS NOW | The 2023 Financial Collapse | Meet Kevin)
Note
Well said (listen on double-speed):

youtu.be/-bPfSeSqFOA
(BTC EMERGENCY ACTION | CTO LARSSON)
Note
Larson also mentioned the worst case extended Wycoff accumulation possibility, which I mentioned.
Note
Incredible shift back down in the bond market expectations. Now expecting only two more small rate hikes from the Fed. Eat humble pie Ron Walker.

youtu.be/puuosbUmCT0?t=446
Note
This has been working like clockwork. Nearing a buy zone again?

snapshot
Note
Croatian, {3/12/23 5:38 PM}
Notable that the new Bank Term Funding Facility allows banks to pledge collateral at par. Meaning holdings of long-dated Treasuries or MBS with mark-to-market losses can unlock liquidity based on original value.

They can hike rates without worry further....

shelby3 ⏱🌐🧖, {3/12/23 6:32 PM}
Exactly my thought. Thus I am selling this rally.
Note
Be careful the CPI report may come in hot on Tuesday in the U.S., then PPI on Wednesday:

seekingalpha.com/article/4586774-february-cpi-surprise-market

marketwatch.com/economy-politics/calendar
Note
youtu.be/_-PF5qaoCqw
(CPI Report Will Be Big Test For Stocks)

Looks like CPI will come in slightly hot, albeit mixed on overall Y-o-Y. While PPI on the subsequent day expected to be cooling. Is this the warm winter in January creating more consumer demand, while producers are seeing their prices come down still as for example copper and energy had been dropping? Much volatility but I think the Fed is getting close to a terminal rate pause and hold rates because of the lag effect on what they will have broken (other than just some banks). I am preparing to buy this pulback hand & fist for the summer rally to ~4800 based on the Shark pattern harmonic bottom that had already formed back in October. Bought the crypto pullback this past week and rode it up on the expected spike. Sold waiting for a retest down.
Note
Armstrong is writing on his private blog about expecting interest rates to rise into the May 2024 ECM turn date from the April 2023 turn date. I presume because he expects war to intensify in Ukraine aligned with the April 2023 turn date. I think he is wrong. Clearly Biden doesn't have the support to push further with a false-flag attack on Moscow right now. Russia is mopping up now the war in Ukraine. Neocons are also confronted with massive backlash (on Twitter and Tucker Carlson on Fox News) about January 6 capitol riot lie.

Instead I think the Fed will signal a pause by April, create massive summer rally. I think rates will flat-line then moderate down briefly into a global recession by May 2024— the necessary economic crisis impetus for launching the world in earnest into WW3 by June 2025 or June 2026 with a Panic Cycle and Aggregate peak on Armstrong's yearly International War Forecast Array for 2026. After that interest rates should rise precipitously into the next ECM date in June 2026 or 2027.

Also the halving timing and other studies I have exhaustively analyzed for Bitcoin strongly suggests a rally into June, more or less repeating the 2019 to 2020 pattern, thus with a flash crash of some sort in Q1 or Q2 2024. After that Bitcoin should rally significantly into Q1 or Q2 2025, but it might only triple top instead of making new ATHs (based on Crypto Crew University's model and assuming Bitcoin bottoms ~10k in 2024).

Something will break in the global economy by 2024. Perhaps bank contagion due to interest rates held high for more than a year. I think the massive false-flag cyberattack (which will be the pretext for forcing everyone onto CBDCs) will not come until 2025 or 2026.

armstrongeconomics.com/wp-content/uploads/2019/01/ECM-2020-2028-R.jpg
Note
I believe Armstrong is misinterpreting his Year timing array for the U.S. Discount rate. He seems to be focused on the Direction Change in 2024 after the Direction Change in 2022 when the Fed started raising rates. But that Direction Change could apply to when the Fed starts decreasing rates, not to when it pauses them. A pause will cause a significant rally in the markets. The situation is somewhat similar to 2019 when stress in the Repo markets and such force the Fed to back down and then Bitcoin rallied crazy from April to June, catching up to gold. Then gold outperformed until after the March 2020 flash crash, when Bitcoin began to outperform again. Even Armstrong's own chart indicates Discount Rate should top out ~5.25%— thus the Fed is likely to pause after a 25 basis point hike in Mar and May.
(charts for the above only available on Armstrong's subscriber-only private blog)

Armstrong's public blog post shows 10Y peaking by May, and flash crash Panic Cycle in EU banks in 2024. Yield curve predicted to un-invert by 2024, which historically, typically coincides with recessionary crash. From 2026 to 2029 the yield curve might remain inverted again— apocalyptic nightmare!

armstrongeconomics.com/world-news/banking-crisis/the-banking-crisis-is-global-not-confined-to-the-usa/
Note
Eric has an excellent, timely video out (listen on double-speed) and I agree with it 💯. I am reloading my crypto now for another push up on Monday. CPI release is not until Tuesday. My comment...

youtu.be/3oY7Wm0TOro
(Bitcoin Turn On The LIGHTS [price statistics] | E.K.C.)

Krown remember I informed you in these very YT comments over the past weeks that Bitcoin would come back down to retest the bottom of the 5-day band, when you were leaning to it breaking to the upside. Now I am going to tell you that Bitcoin will have a summer rally as it did in 2019, then it will flash crash to 10k or lower in 2024 as a repeat of the rona dump but it will be a bank contagion in 2024. So prepare for ~$35+k Bitcoin by June, but take profits, move into gold and wait for 2024 to re-enter. Mark my words. Note I think likely to have another test to the downside before starting the push through the middle of the 5-day band, as your presented statistics also indicate could be the case. The fundamental reason is CPI report expected to come in hot, but the PPI report the next day after expected come in cooler. So we have some choppiness before it becomes clear that the Fed will pause in May at 5.25%. Once the market sniffs a pause, it will be a face-ripping rally.
Note
START DOLLAR COST AVERAGING INTO ETH & DOGE. BOTH HAVE UPSIDE LEVERAGE ON BTC. LOOKS LIKE THE BOTTOM IS BEHIND US. HEADED FOR A JUNE PEAK, REPEATING 2019 AS I HAVE BEEN PREDICTING SINCE I IDENTIFIED THE REPEATING MEGAPHONE PATTERN IN (summer or) ~OCT 2021.
Note
DOGE looks like up to 4x gain on a spike (need to have limit sell orders waiting ~$0.29), ETH 2x (~$3200). BTC only about 1.5x gain from here.
Note
Fucking retard Ron Walker (The Crypto Trader YT channel) totally missed calling the bottom of the recent Bitcoin pullback and has screwed up the Bitcoin follower again after failing to get them into the 50+% gain coming off the 15.4k bottom. This pompous, arrogant idiot has fucked over all his Bitcoin subscribers massively on this Wycoff accumulation bottom. Delete him from your list of analysts to follow on Bitcoin, as he is entirely unable to call the bottoms. He did call the top but that was easy as nearly anyone with a brain stem called the top. I also sold 66k.
Note
I think there will be a slight retracement down from here. All the following with bearish RSI divergences on the daily charts. DOGE at the 200 DMA resistance.

snapshot

ETH at overhead resistance.

snapshot

snapshot

BTC potentially at overhead resistance unless it wants to fill the higher CME gap now.

snapshot

snapshot

ETH and DOGE leverage. Which indicates that risk-on is approaching! The Fed will soon pause.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
youtu.be/ojmmcKcuU90?t=103 ← click for chart
(Bear Market Crash on Repeat, Only Worse Every Time | Money Time Machine)

You have on oversight. 1:43 On your chart, the lower-low is lower than the low between the lower-high and the higher-high. Since that low is for the first time higher than the low before the lower-low, then the incoming lower-low which will be higher than the October bottom. The bottom is in. Markets always rally when the Fed pauses. The recessionary crash does not start until the Fed pivots. The Fed is nearing a pause not a pivot. The Fed shoring up the banks so they can hold rates high, not to continue to raise rates. Markets will pullback as the overreaction stabilizes, then rally into June then top out for 2023 as the Fed signals that 5 - 5.25% is the end of the hikes. This is not yet the stage of the Lehman collapse because the banks are not sitting on subprime NPL derivatives timebomb, but instead on Treasuries which the Fed just entirely stabilized by offering to take them at non-mark-to-market par through the discount window. Lehman had not been shored up. You are comparing totally different situations. The divergences you identified pointing to taking out the December low, do not yet point to talking out the October— don't jump the gun. 25:30 you said pause and cuts as if there will not be months of lag between those two events, lol. The declining steepness of the rallies since the top in 2022 is indicative of a bottoming process, not a rolling over. Too steep off the bottom is not sustainable.
Note
{ Album }
The charts are respecting my trendlines. ETH has pulled back to the first support as expected. Probably going to revisit ~$1535 after a bounce.

snapshot

Per my recent shared comment on Money Time Machine's latest video, I expect S&P to eventually come down to the 200 WMA support which is also horizontal support, just below the December low— not to make a lower-low.

snapshot

Bitcoin probably eventually wants to retest ~23.5k or ~22.7k support.

snapshot

Ron Walker finally started to be a bit more humble and recognize that might not make lower lows and that he totally fucked up expecting Bitcoin to retest lows when it had in fact Wycoff bottomed. Yet he still continues to talk about his favorite moon boy as a stereotype for all us, which is highly insulting. How does he expect to get any love from us crypto investors when he ridicules us with a stereotype? Duh. Ostensibly has a PhD yet socially inept.
Note
Refinement. Clearly it's the downtrend lines that are acting as support. Bitcoin needs to come back down to fill that ~20.25k CME gap. Looks like after the Fed's rate decision next week. This concurs with an expectation that the S&P will come down to ~3750 and break the December low. Bitcoin will continue to make higher lows, not even close to the December low which was CLEARLY THE BOTTOM (wish Ron Walker would admit it).

snapshot

snapshot

Thus ETH maybe back down to ~$1424.

snapshot

DOGE down to ~$0.064.

snapshot
Note
{ Album }
I doubt that CME gap will be filled before the summer peak. The Swiss central bank has backstopped Credit Suisse alleviating the immediately concerns of bank failure contagion. Likely Fed will raise 0.25% on March 22 and signal a pause. If BTC closes above 23K today, then it has closed within the upper side of the median of the 5D Gaussian band. This has never retested below the median which is ~23K and declining. So I am expecting at most a retest of ~22.9k before heading higher. E.K.C. has identified a 5D volatility expansion statistic, which is likely pointing to ~32k in April.

youtu.be/T8OMkQqyQ7A?t=480
(Bitcoin Printer Is Coming [price statistics]

Ron Walker noted bullish divergence on the S&P so possibly up to test resistance 4040 before back down next week to make the final low ~3750?

youtu.be/wsnGBFo316g?t=402
(CRASH: NASDAQ (QQQ)Triggers Bullish Signals! Can It Break The Downtrend? Will The Market Rebound?)

snapshot
Note
Printer is Coming...

twitter.com/zerohedge/status/1462797616903770129
(click for humorous image)
Note
[ Album ]
My posited repeating megaphone which identified after correctly predicting the Pi Cycle first peak, enabled me to predict the 2nd peak and the bottom. It has a range of price targets ~$32 - 55k for a posited moonshot into June.

snapshot

The retracement in Phase E of the posited Wycoff accumulation is 48K with nearly a triple top in 2024 instead of 2025 as expected by my other analysis.

snapshot

The posited inverse H&S is projecting to ~37k with a more realistic target price for 2024.

snapshot
Note
[ Album ]
The similar pattern on ETH in addition to the Bat harmonic pattern (ig.com/en/trading-strategies/top-7-harmonic-patterns-every-trader-should-know-210608 projection clearly targeting ~$3250, as well for ETH to nearly triple top in 2024 after the pump expecting after a banking system collapse emergency reflation ('rona dump redux). An "upgrade" soon to be FOMO activated on Ethere(d)um(b/p).

snapshot

snapshot

Although ETH is a double from $1625 but BTC may not even double from 24k, ETHBTC appears bullish inverse H&S but could slide first down to $0.064 - 0.065 (or 0.059?) ETHBTC may wait until BTC hits 32k before rallying?

snapshot

Ditto DOGEBTC (and similarly DOGEETH) could decline more first before rallying.

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin Dominance (also in orange w/o stablecoins which are becoming increasingly popular) contrasted with BTC and ETH prices.

1. BTC dominance peaked on the first bottom and has been rising during FTX collapse, thus has less of a turning up than in 2019, could turn down at a double-top?

2. 2022/3 bottoming much less V shaped than 2019, with ETH having a much more significant V proportional-to-the-decline recovery off the June bottom than BTC and than in 2018. ETH fell off a cliff in 2018, whereas FOMO has sustained even through FTX.

3. ETH pumped whenever BTC paused on the moonshoot to 9k by May 2019.

snapshot
Note
Bump & Run bullish pattern activated for Bitcoin!

youtu.be/wH1hjG2sBKs?t=533
Note
[ Album ]
youtu.be/wVgpRxqmhiI?t=273
(Warning: EVERYONE IS WRONG About Bitcoin Right Now)

4:33 Steve Courtney @ Crypto Crew U. is pointing out bearish RSI divergence on the Bitcoin daily chart.

Well he's incorrect. Firstly the daily bullish RSI divergence was reset on the recent crash to 19.6k. And the recent face-ripping rally did not actually close a daily candle higher so there's no flip of the RSI divergence to bearish yet. On the breakout to 32k, then daily RSI will rise high enough to avert bearish divergence.

snapshot

Also the 4-hourly chart has reset the bullish RSI divergence after the pullback from the wick high.

snapshot

The weekly has had bullish RSI divergence since the Q4 2022 bottom. Although there's some bearish divergence forming, the bullish daily is in control in the meantime.

snapshot
Note
This confirms my expectations.

youtu.be/CxRopvkeCgg
(History Shows Crypto Investors Losing EVERY Time We See Bitcoin Pumping. | Altcoin Reckoning | Jason Pizzino)
Note
[ Album ]
Ron Walker's socially-inept hubris has returned again. He's still on his "quadruple negative RSI divergence" on the daily. Steve Courtney's point which I had rebutted.

youtu.be/7Zg82EjWXXs?t=225
(A Massive Bitcoin CRASH About To Happen! You Can Ignore The BTC Warnings But You Will Pay The Price!)

We have a new development that BTC looks like it will close a daily candle higher but the RSI has also moved higher thus potentially invalidating the posited bearish RSI divergence (as I had said it would)!

snapshot

Note though that the bullish RSI divergence that had reset on the 4 hourly might potentially turn to bearish if BTC closes higher.

snapshot

Unless BTC rockets through the overhead resistance, I am expecting another pullback. Ron would argue that the bearish RSI divergence remains on the first lower-high to the latest.
Note
Ron Walker informs us that his hubris was influenced by incorrectly thinking the market was pricing in a 50 basis points hike. This to me is evidence that he's overwhelmed with the emails I have been sending him. Giving him much to ponder. Past weeks he was so uber confident that the Fed would remain hawkish.

youtu.be/lEovAREgLf4
(Correction To Fed Funds Futures)
Note
And now the the weekly RSI is no longer exhibiting bearish divergence. Exactly what I wrote would transpire.

snapshot
Note
I am thinking a slight pullback before higher? One final opportunity to onboard?

snapshot
Note
And the new facility is potentially up to $2 trillion.

twitter.com/saxena_puru/status/1636517880820019201

"Yes...the sham Fed just undid 50% of its QT over the past year in about 10 days to help the banks.

Powell cannot tell the world with a straight face that the Fed is committed to reducing its balance-sheet and fighting inflation when half of QT is undone in 10 days!"


shelby3 ⏱🌐🧖, {3/20/23 11:44 AM}
Replied: twitter.com/shelbyhmooreiii/status/1637887300557234176

Not if banks receiving fleeing deposits park in reverse repos at Fed’s discount🪟. Thus Fed might hike rates, and hold them higher than the short-covering, mechanical bond market overreaction priced in. OTOH liquefied face ripping stampede when Fed pauses.

youtu.be/zyLy8qZX4_A
(The Fed Should Hike Rates This Week And Signal For More To Come | Mott Capital Mgmt)
Note
I have watched numerous videos and analyzed numerous charts. I don’t have the patience to screenshot every chart and detail. I will just summarize my analysis and findings.

BTC just filled the 28.7k CME gap from June 2022. Next higher is 35.2k from May 2022, but won’t be headed there until after a pullback.

Most likely one final push up for crypto today or early this week to ~$29.6 - 29.8k on a wick at highest possible overhead resistance of broadening wedge (also Eric Krown Crypto’s near-term statistical range high). ETH to triple top ~$1840. Note a non-zero chance ETH could surprise breakout to ~$1980+ at next higher horizontal resistance.

After that there will be a significant correction. BTC has a triple or quadruple (and certainly quadruple it one more push higher) bearish RSI divergence. It didn’t have this on the comparative breakouts in 2015 and 2019. ETH also has bearish divergence. My guess based on resetting RSI to hidden bullish divergence on daily, is BTC will not correct below 24k and thus likely a wick down (on the 5-day chart) to 25.3k only. Should hold on a closing basis above the ~26.3k top of the 5-day Gaussian channel (per Crypto Crew U. & Eric Krown Crypto). ETH correction ~$1680 - $1710, but not below $1630. Ron Walker (The Crypto Trader) is too bearish. He’s overlooking that weekly RSI above 60 is bullish and the hidden, bullish RSI resets don’t require massive drops.

Explicit $3200 Bat harmonic target for May/June top for ETH. I can’t rule out that top coming as soon as late April. RSI is suggesting to me that BTC won’t top above 47k. Whereas ~35.2k is a near certainty. ETH:BTC and DOGE:BTC charts suggests BTC dominance is nearing completion and altcoins to outperform, albeit BTC might make one more dominant surge after the posited incoming correction. DOGE:BTC is suggesting DOGE maybe to only ~$0.14 although I can’t rule out a wick to ~$0.28.

The bearish RSI divergence on the weekly chart indicates unlikely long 2016 bull run is ensuing after posited correction. Instead more like a repeat of 2019 (which also concurs with my long-standing, repeating megaphone fractal model, and agrees with Crypto Crew U’s observation that the breakout from the 5-day Gaussian channel is too abrupt same as 2019).
Note
snapshot

snapshot
Note
Forgot to mention expected 25.3k support is the 200 WMA.

I followed up on the math that Eric Krown Crypto didn’t fully reveal.

I compute ~28% std deviation for the upside move. Given a breakout price either $19.5 or 21.6k. I get for one std dev (i.e. 67% confidence) a range of either $41.8 - 52.7k or $46.2 - 58.3k. For two std dev (i.e. 95% confidence) a range of either $36.3 - 58.1k or $40.2 - 64.4k.

Again based on RSI I don’t expect higher than 47k. My repeating megaphone fractal model is suggesting ~$36 - 42k.

I compute ~7% std dev for the initial downside move from the summer peak into an initial Q3/Q4 2023 low. Which means 2023 low should be ~50% of the high. But note the declines are monotonically increasing, so decline could be 65+%.

Note I am expecting a corona-dump crash in 2024 to ~9k probably due to bankpocalypse— just project a support trend line from the 2018 and 2020 lows! Stats for ’rona dump redux are up to -80% for two std devs which would satisfy the target. But note the declines are monotonically increasing, so decline could really be any huge number close to 100%.

youtu.be/zPVkBQtdif4
(Bitcoin Balaji's $1,000,000 Price in 90 Days {price statistics})
Note
Ron Walker how is that you are still waiting for a bottom for Bitcoin when it is nearly 29K after bottoming at 15k? That nearly a double. Are you insane?

You think there's no bullish divergence on S&P yet there's was Shark pattern bottom in October projecting to 4800+.

It's just dumbfounding to watch you go through bizarre acrobatics to try to fit the price action into your inane confirmation bias that is still waiting for a bottom so many months after the bottoms.

OPTICALARTdotCOM was calling for 8k Bitcoin all the way up from 15k he shorted. Finally he relented after bankrupting himself and his followers.

You retards are two peas in a pod.
Note
I sold. Waiting for the correction.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
youtu.be/Xg4oIl49V2Y
(Bitcoin Historical 33.21% Price Explosion {price statistics} | Eric Krown Crypto)

The breakout in May 2019 wicked nearly all the way down to the top of th 5-day Gaussian channel after ~33% peak above it, before reaching the ~47% rise you’re attributing to it. Thus both 2015 and 2019 retested in the vicinity of the top of the said Gaussian channel while still in the red zone. If the Fed disappoints this week with somewhat sustained hawkishness, the possibility of retesting the Gaussian channel sooner-than-later seems reasonable, especially given the triple bearish RSI divergence on the daily chart which were not present in 2015 and 2019. Also considering the $28.7 CME gap was just filled. Next CME gap up ~35.2k and I bet a backtest of channel before going higher. Also the median of the weekly Gaussian channel appears to be acting as overhead resistance but was support in 2015 and was sliced right through in 2019.
Note
youtu.be/oFLa9MnZkBI?t=1655

27:35 Yes the Fed will be able to cut one more time aggressively in 2024, but that will be the last because WW3 will break out in earnest in 2025.
Note
After studying and thinking about Eric Krown Crypto's analysis more in light of also numerous other analyst videos I consumed, I am very wary that Bitcoin can push right through this overhead resistance to $30 - 33k at least before correcting. If there's a correction we must buy it hand and fist. And we should consider holding some of our trading position through any correction, as it's likely to be brief, minimal and the price may go higher first. If the correction begins today, then it will be at most ~4 days.

Again make sure you jump onboard of crypto this week regardless. Perhaps a key influence on my thinking is the latest FX Evolution video, which I will share with you in the comment.

Again the maximum downside I am expecting is ~$25.3 - 26.5k for BTC and ~$1650 for ETH, but no guarantee they correct first before going higher although I think probabilities favor a correction. Remember my upsides are ~$35 - 47k and ~$3200 respectively. I think some other altcoins may rip as well, but I just don't have time or the patience for their herky-jerky volatility, e.g. DOGE likely a double to ~$0.15 but possibly up to ~$0.28.

Ron Walker is out of his fucking mind. He still thinks the Fed will come out hawkish, when in fact the chart from EX Evolution shows clearly they can not because the 2Yr has already forced them to pause.
Note
youtu.be/PMCV4PXWs2I ← click for chart
(Look What Happens When Bond Traders Take This Odd Action... | FX Evolution)

The 2YR Treasury bond is signaling the Fed will pause soon and hold rates flat. Thus the markets will face ripping rally up until the Fed has to cut, then crash anew.

Key today is Fed guidance. If they say pause is contingent on data forward, then might get an exhale correction due to uncertainty. Also as bonds and bank stocks stabilize there could be some capital profit taking on crypto back before next move up. That BTC is rising into the 2pm announcement is probably short-term bearish.
Note
youtu.be/aeQiR2SNNgY?t=174 ← click for chart
(The Fed & Jerome Powell's FOMC Speech & Projections | Meet Kevin)

2:54 I like how you pointed out that Fed essentially skipped the rate cutting phase and proceeded directly to U-turn bailout. They are attempting to bluff but they know damn well they have embarked on cloaked QE. They are deploying high interest rates to drive it. The market will eventually figure this out that the pause is in and face ripping rally after it sells off while sorting this out (especially crypto). The Fed is intentionally centralizing the banking system, as evident when Powell deflected the question about why not use reserve ratios instead to avoid collapsing the banks. Bingo. Will add to my blog Coercing the dystopian FedCoin.
Note
I extensively overhauled and expounded my blog. At the minimum, you must re-read the following linked section as there's critical new insights including my rebuke of or insight into 150 IQ Curtis Yarvin’s latest blog post.

anonymint.substack.com/p/coercing-the-dystopian-fedcoin
Note
Careful the over-excitement (e.g. Bitcoin) about BTFP may be premature as first need more bank failures to create more easing.

snapshot

Posted: twitter.com/shelbyhmooreiii/status/1639010204657553409
Note
Let's not forget that Bitcoin had a bullish RSI weekly divergence and then broke out with weekly RSI now in the bullish control zone. We got the backtest of 26.6k that I expected. Looks like more bank bailouts looming. I think Bitcoin could run without further pullback.

For example Bitcoin could tag $30 - 32k before coming back. And no guarantees it comes back to 27K again before topping out at our expected $35 - 47k target. Ditto ETH to ~$3200.

I've been re-accumulating the profits I took above 28k.

Also the bond market is starting to price in a Fed pause for their May meeting.
Note
Re-read this section:

anonymint.substack.com/p/coercing-the-dystopian-fedcoin

I added my critique of Arthur Hayes’ blog post. The comparison to Japan is not accurate because Japan was trying to create inflation.

Also in the subsequent section I explained why Bitcoin will become the next reserve currency. Martin Armstrong is a stubborn donkey on this point and ostensibly can't wrap his mind around the facts as I have summarized there. He probably will not even read it because he has his blinders on. He deserves his fate then.
Note
Eric Krown Crypto has pointed out that ETH:BTC is likely to continue to decline.

youtu.be/oADmHUgsWIc
(Bitcoin Dominance - The Most Bullish Chart In Crypto)

Studying the ETH:BTC and DOGE:BTC charts again more meticulously (rather than just looking for broad patterns) I do note that they’re declining on every huge green Bitcoin dildo. Thus I conclude he’s probably correct, also because his indicators were correct at my posited corresponding juncture in 2019 as well.

The implications of this are shocking. I have ETH projected to rise to $2900 to $3200, although I guess it could possibly get hung up at ~$2100. If ETH:BTC is to decline closer to 0.05, that’s projecting a Bitcoin price $42 - 64k. 🤯
Note
[ Album ]
My very thick red trend line scenario (my original, longstanding megaphone hypothesis) does support a Bitcoin bear trap rally to 57k.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
May come retest ~26.5k as support one more time but no guarantees. I am leaning very strongly to will not decline below that level, although the next level down in low 25000s.

snapshot
Note
Jason Pizzino is focused on the 25.3k level for the close of March as a confirmation that a major bull run is underway. So again the ~26.5k and ~25.3k are the critical levels to watch for this week.

youtu.be/93XLZTSuwS4
(This Never-Fail Signal Called The Bitcoin Bottom Every Cycle. (It’s About To Flash Green AGAIN!))
Note
S&P is about to break up out of a declining channel, which is bullish.

youtu.be/-28rde8Q-Ro?t=291 ← click for the chart
(Be Careful Of SP500 Crash Predictions | Watch THIS Pattern)
Note
QAnon, {3/25/23 7:30 AM}
I would like a touch of the weekly 200MA. It has been such significant support and resistance so it makes sense to drop down and test it before continuing

QAnon, {3/25/23 7:31 AM}
Of course it could also be tested at a later date

shelby3 ⏱🌐🧖, {3/25/23 8:13 AM}
I was thinking that too originally but we could go tag $32 - 35k first (fill that CME cap up there). As you said we can have a scary retest after that before heading to the higher targets. Or we could retest 200 WMA (~25.4k) now. But I am not going to snub 27K just trying to grab 25K, when 35k is looming. I have re-accumulated 33% of what sold above 28k, with an average price ~27k. I am still on the lookout for clues. Ron Walker notes a probably 9 count sell signal for Apple and Nvidia on Monday. Bitcoin had a 9 count sell signal 4 days ago, which results in the retest of 26.6k.

So my take is don't be too complacent.

Another potential clue that maybe pullback before face ripper?

Downside Setup for TSLA
Note
Check my Twitter for my tweets about this.

youtu.be/VMYKaWlLMjs
(A Credit Crunch is Inevitable in 2023 | Stocks are Much Too Optimistic. | Game of Trades)

All throughout Q4 2021 and most of 2022 you were of the opinion that stocks would rally from the time the Fed paused until they actually cut rates. Recently you have been on this illogical rant about an imminent crash. Dude wtf happened to you? You are going to be REKTD. Nearly everyone is positioned on the same side of fear (FUD) as you are you. The majority is always wrong. The smart money has been buying like crazy since the so-called bank crisis started. Rising credit swap spreads now become bullish because they equate to an immediate expansion of the Fed's balance sheet. What has changed is the Fed will now preempt any bank failures by allowing them to come to the BTFP discount window at par valuation when they are distressed. It's as if you are entirely ignoring the radical shift in policy that the BTFP pogrom entails. Read Arthur Hayes latest blog Kaiseki then read my blog which expounds on it.
Note
Loony tunes Ron Walker is still calling for a 9k crash for Bitcoin.🤡🥴 He lacks basic understanding of some facets of technical analysis which is ostensibly outside his repertoire.

youtu.be/XOJyF00NlHY
(The Dollar Bounce Off The Rising Trendline Could Trigger Another Selloff For Bitcoin | The Crypto Trader)

For example, one of his main arguments in his latest clown show, is his hopium that the dollar is poised for a major rally. So let’s dissect the DXY chart employing basic RSI divergence T/A which Ron doesn’t appear to be cognizant of.

The weekly DXY chart had bearish RSI divergence at the top, broke below key support which was retested as overhead resistance and declined anew. There’s potential bullish RSI divergence, but so there was also all the way down from 106. And the weekly RSI is in the bearish control zone and needs to decline further to have unequivocal bullish divergence.

snapshot

The daily chart is even more bearish as there was bearish divergence at the top but no bullish divergence has formed yet. RSI is still in the bearish control zone. And price is fighting with both strong horizontal resistance 103 - 103.6 plus overhead resistance of the declining channel.

snapshot

The 4-hourly provides some zoomed insight into the technical structure which is appears not to be a bullish declining wedge as claimed by Bozo The Clown, but instead the volatility around the apex of a failed declining wedge inside the overall declining channel. In addition to bearish RSI divergence, although could rise a bit more to complete the bearish RSI for all three annotated and because RSI is in the bullish control zone.

snapshot
Note
So you guys are aware that I was expecting S&P to drop to 3750 and am still open to that pullback with a BTC pullback to the 200 WMA ~25.3k. No guarantees.
Note
[ Album ]
Also Ron even identified a more significant, very bearish declining channel for the dollar, yet he is delusional to think it will break out to the bullish side. Don't break out on the first test! That’s a very basic rule of T/A. 🤦

snapshot

One point I agree with Ron is that 4-hourly BTC chart has bearish RSI divergence and a retest of the 200 WMA ~25.4k looks very plausible along with a dollar last gasp to 103.6.

snapshot

But Ron is incorrect about the triple/quadruple bearish RSI divergence on daily, bcz unlike prior instances, this one was reset bullish and remains bullish!! THIS IS HIS HUGE MYOPIA ALONG W\IGNORING THE BULLISH WEEKLY RSI. Note that correct yellow LARP curve I projected back in early Feb.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Ron Walker has one final chance on this possible incoming pullback to the 200 WMA 25.4k to redeem himself and board the Bitcoin rocket else he will totally embarrass himself after already failing to be bullish since the +90% gain off the 15k bottom.

Ron watch this video and educate yourself. You are ignorant a.f.. Does he not know what a bullish engulfing monthly candle is?

twitter.com/shelbyhmooreiii/status/1639768599144411136
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/Qfgp00nz_Ew
(Bitcoin Bears Were Right, Price To $12,000 | Eric Krown Crypto)

Looks like incoming a retest of ~25.4k for 200 WMA and the horizontal W pattern breakout.
Note
Here is a copy of that update from March 15…

youtu.be/ojmmcKcuU90
(Bear Market Crash on Repeat, Only Worse Every Time | Money Time Machine)

You have an oversight. 1:43 On your chart, the lower-low is lower than the low between the lower-high and the higher-high. Since that low is for the first time higher than the low before the lower-low, then the incoming lower-low which will be higher than the October bottom. The bottom is in. Markets always rally when the Fed pauses. The recessionary crash does not start until the Fed pivots. The Fed is nearing a pause not a pivot. The Fed shoring up the banks so they can hold rates high, not to continue to raise rates. Markets will pullback as the overreaction stabilizes, then rally into June then top out for 2023 as the Fed signals that 5 - 5.25% is the end of the hikes. This is not yet the stage of the Lehman collapse because the banks are not sitting on subprime NPL derivatives timebomb, but instead on Treasuries which the Fed just entirely stabilized by offering to take them at non-mark-to-market par through the discount window. Lehman had not been shored up. You are comparing totally different situations. The divergences you identified pointing to taking out the December low, do not yet point to talking out the October— don't jump the gun. 25:30 you said pause and cuts as if there will not be months of lag between those two events, lol. The declining steepness of the rallies since the top in 2022 is indicative of a bottoming process, not a rolling over. Too steep off the bottom is not sustainable.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/QGHhw6K3hS4?t=516 ← click for the chart
(Start of next big move for bitcoin only hours away! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

I agree with this analysis and despite being your critic sometimes, I agree your A1 chart appears to have some significance. I was also expecting a drop to the 200 WMA ~25.4k this week before the continued face ripping rally up. After this pullback, Bitcoin is about to enter the parabolic Phase E of the Wycoff accumulation bottoming pattern, which will proceed to at least ~35k if not as high as 57k. It’s so ironic that your ring analysis told you a pump was coming off that bottom, but you were so married to the idea that Bitcoin had to decline to 9k before a 2019-style rally, that you positioned yourself illogically bearish. Your 9k is coming in 2024 when the non-linear effects of the Fed’s new BTFP pogrom combined with pausing funds rates longer, will create some massive contagion on par with the COVID crash. Note the DXY (dollar) is very bearish, so that should tell you that a face ripping rally is ahead. More deets can be found from my About.
Note
youtu.be/O102YQUYyFM?t=265 ← click for chart
(Crypto Zombie)

4:25 falling wedge breakout with retest projects to as high as ~$52 - 57k.
Note
youtu.be/NwEibJ-o06k?t=740 ← click for chart
(BTC URGENT UPDATED: Bitcoin Reversing Off Major Resistance - CRASH Inevitable)

12:20 Ron Walker🤡talking nonsense out of his ass again. The b wave can’t reverse the a wave. Thus his W wave should be a 5 wave ending where he annotated ‘b’. Thus his annotated 5 wave push up was merely the first wave in a 3 (i.e. a-b-c) or 5 wave push up to complete wave X before wave Y for the expected 9k low in 2024. 15:07 he responded to my weekly bullish RSI point, by comparing to an instance where there was bearish divergence 🤦🤡 16:29 cherry picks a channel instead of the broadening wedge that touches more points while also ignoring the drastically different surging volume🤦 Can’t evaluated Ron’s arrogantly titled Moonboy Oscillator, because he doesn’t show its history in bull markets (e.g. 2019 rally) nor tell us how it’s computed. Ron such a liar claiming those that disagree w/him now didn’t call the top at 66k which I did.

snapshot
Note
Ron’s faux pas Achilles heel is that he limits himself only to a subset of T/A tools. Just because those tools worked at the top, doesn’t assure they’re comprehensive enough to work at the bottom. Although there’s a scary gap at 20.3k that needs to be backfilled eventually (which could wait until Ron’s Y wave which I think comes after the May/June summer top), the current pullback appears to be a diamond pattern reversal, which projects at most back to the 200 WMA (and these don’t always reach 100% of the measured target).

snapshot
Note
Steve points out how critical the 200 WMA has been. And he knows we will probably retest it one more time, before breaking through the overhead resistance. Once we break above 30k, then everyone will capitulate to the bullish side. Ron Walker continues to claim that maximum capitulation will be to make a lower-low, but in fact he is not reading the market sentiment correctly. So many people are afraid of this bear market rally. They are selling into every resistance. And thus we are climbing the wall of worry. Maximum capitulation for the bulls will come in 2024 with his Y wave. He is premature in expecting maximum bull capitulation now. He fails to understand the 4 year cycle and fails to understand Bitcoin is rally in 2023 for the same cycle timing as in 2019. There can not be another retest lower until 2024 because it would violate the 4 year cycle timing as Jason Pizzino explained and Eric Krown Crypto has eloquently explained the 4 year cycle in a couple of his recent videos. Ron is myopic. He covers his eyes and ears to any outside feedback and information. 🙈🙉🤡

youtu.be/GpFTlOGehcw
(Bitcoin WAKE UP CALL ☎️ | Crypto Crew U.)
Note
Mathematician's computations also targeting ~25.3k pullback:

Bearish Wolfe Wave
Note
Posted: twitter.com/shelbyhmooreiii/status/1640519826421547010

1:37 Wycoff schematic&vol spikes: Phase A🟰FTX, C🟰stablecoin FUD, D🟰bankpocalypse FUD. 12:47 Phase E exits 25.3k trading range top. “Reactions short-lived.” 17:46 same “going to 1K” FUD as 2018 btm. 18:58 4-year ₿ cycle can’t retest lows until 2024.🧐

youtu.be/4SGeIMhlMfI
(Bitcoin: What Happens After a Wyckoff Accumulation Breakout? | Beginning of a New Crypto Bull Market | Jason Pizzino)
Note
Correct the link to the comment from the mathematician.
Note
Posted: twitter.com/shelbyhmooreiii/status/1640527620285636611

3:34 4-year ₿ cycle analyzed in detail.

~28% 𝜎 upside. Breakout $19.5 or 21.6k. One 𝜎🟰67% confidence)🟰$41.8 - 52.7k or $46.2 - 58.3k. Two 𝜎🟰95% confidence🟰$36.3 - 58.1k or $40.2 - 64.4k. ~7% 𝜎 downside🟰~35-50% of summer high. Crash to 9k 2024.

youtu.be/Qfgp00nz_Ew?t=214
(Bitcoin Bears Were Right, Price To $12,000 {statistics} | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
Posted: twitter.com/shelbyhmooreiii/status/1640735204686921732

Wycoff 2019-esque bear trap rally📈underway, as predicted by a megaphone pattern I charted on my Tradingview in Sep&Oct 2021. Binance’s dominance vulnerability∴2020-esque 9k📉in 2024

Crypto winter underway but with higher highs and lower lows?


Cryptopocalypse delayed until 2023?


cointelegraph.com/news/binance-ceo-announces-recovery-funds-conversion-from-busd-to-native-crypto

youtu.be/r2h9WOOJCvI
(An Urgent Bitcoin Warning BEFORE the Next Halving)

(Meet) Kevin has pointed out that Binance’s exchange dominance its large influence over the March 13th pump bodes not well for resiliency of the Bitcoin price when the recession contagion ensues. My comment:

youtu.be/r2h9WOOJCvI
(An Urgent Bitcoin Warning BEFORE the Next Halving)

In May 2021 I publicly on my trading view identified the megaphone pattern from 2019 to 2020 that I posited would lead to a double top and then a crash below 20k. This pattern is also in alignment with the 4-year cycle theory. So 2019 to 2020 is repeating and after this rally into May/June, Bitcoin will flounder down to sideways until a flash crash in Q1 2024 to ~9k. Realize I publicly charted and predicted this almost 2 years ago.
Note
snapshot
Note
I’m not ruling out a no-see-um (momentary) wick down to 22.6k on this CFTC Binance lawsuit.

snapshot
Note
I swear I did not get the Diamond top pattern idea from Crypto Banter. Just now had a chance to watch this:

youtu.be/g5621GyEDgU
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/tkFYLb49_0A
(This is a Major Threat to a Fragile Banking System | Charts Say a Big Move Is Coming Soon | Game of Trades)

This GoT video offers no explanation as to why stonks shouldn’t rally with the Fed having already unwound ~70% of the QT it did since the market top. The QT pivot is what created the 2019 rally. Stonks are hesitating ostensibly because fools are reacting to FUD and also because the May pause hasn’t been definitively priced in by the futures market yet, as it seems the market is waiting to digest the PCE report on Friday. Any further bank bailouts will just mean more Fed balance sheet expansion which is more bullish. The crisis has actually lowered interest rates thus should ease financial conditions. Any reduced lending will show up on a lag on earnings, but that won’t affect stonks in the current earnings season. Duh. 🤦‍♂️
Note
Bitcoin looking bullish.

youtu.be/ycOI96Av_WA
(Bitcoin Bears Haven't Seen This Since April 2019 | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
YOU WILL NOT FIND ANALYSIS THIS DETAILED FROM ANYONE ELSE. THIS IS MY UNIQUE WORK.

Weekly BTC is amazingly similar to early May 2019. But there’s some key differences.

The initial Apr 2019 breakout had no major (horizontal, down trend, nor Gaussian channel) overhead resistance until ~5k and when breaking through $5915 had already back tested all major down trend and Gaussian channel as support, thus free ride to the top of weekly Gaussian channel. After which it back tested major $6504 major horizontal support before proceeding higher.

Whereas the Jan 2023 initial breakout hit overhead resistance at the 200 WMA, bottom of weekly Gaussian channel and the second major down trend line. This precipitated a major pullback to back test ~19.6k at the first major down trend line. Which catapulted to next level of overhead resistance at range of median to top of weekly Gaussian channel and major horizontal resistance $28.5 - 31.8k. Given there’s consolidation at said resistance, it should be expected there would be a pullback to the next lower level of major horizontal, 200 WMA and top of 5D Gaussian channel support ~25.3 - 25.6k, before proceeding higher.

In May 2019 BTC rallied to above the top of weekly Gaussian channel after closing above the median, but then back tested major support almost down to the median. This suggests that BTC will back test the 200 WMA even if after a rally to $30.3 - 31.8k if not before. The greater steepness of the Gaussian channel compared to 2019 allows for a more significant back test pullback at this juncture resistance than May 6 resistance below the median.

The angle of the top of the broadening wedge as drawn seems to indicate 30.3k would be the maximum upside before back test of 200 WMA, but maybe it can be drawn steeper on the lower time frames? These two charts otherwise don’t hint whether $30.3 - 31.8k will be tested as resistance before the posited pullback back test. Will need to investigate lower time frames to find more clues.

In 2019 the top was the height of the weekly Gaussian channel, times two. Thus ~48K should be the late May or early June top. Which will be a double-top for the echo rally in Q1 2022.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Comparing to the 2019 time frame, the BTC daily chart seems nearly identical in terms of indications of short-term price direction, with both having potential bearish RSI divergence at this juncture. THUS RON WALKER FOCUSING ON DAILY RSI DIVERGENCE IS NONSENSE. HE SHOULD BACK TEST HIS INDICATORS ON 2019 TO SEE THEY DO NOT WORK PROPERLY.

But note two significant differences. In 2019, the RSI inside the box was in the bullish control zone above 70, whereas not currently. And the volume spiked on the break out from top of broadening wedge, whereas currently spiked on the back test of the major support and has been declining as it has been grinding higher in what appears to be another distribution preceding a looming pullback, akin to Jan 2023. Will volume surge again on a back test enabling another catapult?

snapshot

The 12 hour chart illustrates this volume pattern distinction more clearly. In 2019 the volume was surging on moves higher, thus the broadening wedge had a horizontal bottom or was perhaps a rising channel. Thus a breakout on the third test of the top. Whereas currently the volume is surging on back tests, which then catapult to the next higher level, which so far has been at the top of the broadening wedge.

Note currently the top of the daily Gaussian channel is heading rapidly towards the 200 WMA. And note the deep back test was slightly below the bottom of the daily Gaussian channel. Keep that in mind when we compare to the 3-hourly Gaussian channel in 2019.

snapshot
Note
Another clue is provided by comparing 2019 and currently on the 6-day BTC chart. Note that price oscillated wildly around the top of the 6-day Gaussian channel and back tested horizontal support below the top near the median after breaking out over the top, just to wick right back up over the top again. Thus volatility between $25.3 and 30.3k seems plausible if the pattern repeats.

snapshot

Zooming in on the 5-day chart at the current juncture indicates a potentially repeating pattern of 3 indecision bars followed by volatility. But the pattern has inverted in the vertical orientation. The 5-day closes on Friday. So maybe a wick down this week to ~26.2k, followed by 10-day rally to $30.3 - 31.8k. Then a back test of $25.3 - 25.7k by week starting Apr 16. Followed by the catapult to fill the ~35.3k CME gap by week starting May 11. Perhaps wick to ~37.4k, then back test ~$30.3 - 31.8k, before heading to final top in June.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
[ Album ]
Ron Walker is correct that if the DXY (dollar) rallies, then BTC will drop.

youtu.be/Ie8vobprw2w?t=968 ← click for Ron’s chart
(Bitcoin Gets a 13 Countdown Sell Signal at Major Resistance - Bitcoin to $9,000 in 90 Days | The Crypto Trader aka Ron Walker)

Ron is still delusional, calling for 9k Bitcoin before this Spring/Summer rally completes.

DXY can only rally to ~104 where it will have bearish RSI divergence and decline again allowing BTC to catapult to the next higher level of resistance.

snapshot
Note
The ~35.3k CME gap seems 90+% certain to be filled in May. But levels above that into June are more speculative.

snapshot

s3.tradingview.com/snapshots/g/gyJOcBAH.png
(click this if you want to zoom in great detail)
Note
Ron Walker is married to the bearish scenario, which blinds him to patterns contrary to his confirmation bias. Here he only sees a bearish rising wedge on the Nasdaq, but that’s hardly the only pattern that could be posited.

youtu.be/haIMq_qNls4?t=1762 ← click for Ron’s chart
(Stock Market CRASH Will Resume: 2 Signals That Will Mark S&P 500's Top & Will End The Short Squeeze | Ron Walker)

I have bullish parallel channels and Shark harmonic bottom patterns on both the Nasdaq and the S&P.

Jason McIntosh explains the parallel channel thesis:

youtu.be/CsolOX6bt_U
(Big Losses For SP500 Bears | Watch THIS Pattern Closely | Stock Market Technical Analysis)

What Ron visualizes as a bearish rising wedge, I can visualize as a broadening wedge, or more saliently overruled by down trend line breakouts and the aforementioned. S&P even has a small, bullish inverse H&S as annotated.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Ron apparently dug in his heels after I emailed him so much lately pointing out what an idiot he has been on this Q4 2022 bottoming process. Ron is now grasping at strings and instead of learning, he is going to bury himself in stubborn pride.

youtu.be/QSNNB7U1J8U?t=103 ← click for Ron’s chart
(Banking Crisis & Credit Crunch Coming: S&P500 At Levels Where Tops Develop In A Risk-Off Environment | Ron Walker)

Ron’s hallucination proposal is the gray parallel channel as follows. Holy crap, is this guy taking drugs? How could the price action be attacking the top of his channel so aggressively and suddenly fall down to the bottom of it. The dude is smoking bear dung laced FUD.

snapshot
Note
Ron Walker cherry picks data and doesn’t inform his viewers about data contrary to his hypothesis. This is why you should never trust a vlogger (and Twitter profile) that disallows public replies and comments.

Ron asserts that every time the VIX has a declining wedge that the S&P crashes. This is not the case. Look at the two rectangles from 2018 and 2019 on my chart for examples where the VIX can oscillate up and down while the S&P is rising.

youtu.be/QSNNB7U1J8U?t=579 ← click for Ron’s chart
(Banking Crisis & Credit Crunch Coming: S&P500 At Levels Where Tops Develop In A Risk-Off Environment | Ron Walker)

snapshot
Note
On the prior split VIX:S&P chart, note that the choppiness in the summer of 2019 was because the Fed did not definitely announce QE until Oct 2019. After restarting QE the S&P rallied while the VIX loitered horizontal with some wick spikes up.

yardeni.com/chronology-of-feds-quantitative-easing/

There’s an alternative, prospective Shark pattern on both the S&P and Nasdaq which portends Ron’s lower low. But the problem with that scenario is the Nasdaq already back tested the red down trend line and broke up out of the posited blue parallel channel. What the heck will cause such an egregious a break down of what appears to already be bullish structure?

Ron thinks the banks are tightening the financial conditions so much that this is in effect ongoing rate hikes, except maybe the banks’ earnings reported first in April. And that will cause the sudden capitulation. But I had already debunked that by linking to Meet Kevin’s detail analysis. And besides the effect of any suddenly increased financial conditions w.r.t. loans, will take some time to trickle down into actual earnings. Certainly won’t be reflected in Q1 earnings about to be reported starting from April. Q2 earnings aren’t reported until starting July. Besides the banking contagion lowered the interest rates so thus actually eased financial conditions. The “tightening financial conditions” is just a FUD narrative. The large banks had been tightening lending conditions for the past few quarters.

No! What changed is the Fed implicitly ended QT and restarted QE in a deceptive manner. The markets are sniffing that out now and the bears will be crushed, including Ron Walker.🤦🤡

snapshot

snapshot
Note
19:03 Ron Walker’s detailed VIX and “credit market conditions” chart exemplifies that current is likely a mirror of 2019 with credit conditions easing now that the Fed has backstopped everything again. Yet Ron thinks a sudden contagion of credit crises is imminent next week. Lol. He who constantly berates the crowd for drinking the hopium Koolaid is himself drinking the FUD Koolaid.🤡 I’m berating him because he berates everyone constantly and allows no public comment nor replies on his social media postings. He deserves a taste of what he’s dishing out to others. I urge all readers to proceed to his YT account and down vote all his videos, so maybe he will receive the message.

Is Ron so stuck in a time warp that he doesn’t appreciate that what makes the Internet value is being a two-way medium, unlike media before the Internet was for one-way diatribes without feedback and interaction.🤦

youtu.be/QSNNB7U1J8U?t=1143 ← click for Ron’s chart
(Banking Crisis & Credit Crunch Coming: S&P500 At Levels Where Tops Develop In A Risk-Off Environment | Ron Walker)
Note
22:42, 25:11 Ron Walker has two more charts which lead him to believe there’s a looming breakout to the upside for tightening credit markets.

Looks like a repeat of 2006 and 2019 where there was an initial resurgence then relaxed back down until the actual recession hit. Ron’s posited bullish, declining wedge for the credit conditions has nearly been fulfilled and could drop down through the apex (perhaps after one more double-cat dead bounce test of top of wedge).

Fed has backstopped all deposits with BTFP. Some depositors are likely to move their funds to risk-on, before back to high yield money markets as yields dropped with the contagion. Ron’s FUD is too premature thus he will miss the bull trap, echo rally to 4700 - 5000. Recession doesn’t start now, duh.

youtu.be/QSNNB7U1J8U ← click for Ron’s two charts
(Banking Crisis & Credit Crunch Coming: S&P500 At Levels Where Tops Develop In A Risk-Off Environment | Ron Walker)
Note
43:18 Ron is citing 2018 when the Fed paused rate increases and the stock market dumped, but that was because the Fed didn’t stop QT until after the dump and didn’t restart QE until Oct 2019, both of which corresponded with surges in the stock markets. Whereas in 2006 - 2007 where the Fed wasn’t in QT, the pause corresponded with a rally. So since the Fed has restarted QE and the pause is looming, the markets are rally. The rally will continue until something else breaks and the Fed is forced to pivot and drop rates, which will correspond with the recession probably in Q4 2023 or Q1 2024. Ron is simply premature with his expectations for the next leg down in the markets. We are in the echo, bull trap rally now first.

youtu.be/QSNNB7U1J8U?t=2598 ← click for Ron’s chart
(Banking Crisis & Credit Crunch Coming: S&P500 At Levels Where Tops Develop In A Risk-Off Environment | Ron Walker)
Note
Note short covering will drive the markets this week, but after that may get a pullback at least.

youtu.be/zLcW-gJonVA
(The Bear Market Is Not Over | Mott Capital Management)
Note
0:18 Turtle T/A proves it!

youtu.be/qadWvRlkcKc?t=18 ← click for chart
(Retail Traders: Smart Money Is Up To Something.. | FX Evoution)
Note
GoT is premature and will entirely miss the echo rally to 4800 to 5000.

youtu.be/3KVHwkGa_eU
(This is the 4th Time the Banking System is Doing This | SP500 Rally Will Hit a Wall | Game of Trades)
Note
Breeakout on the massive bulllish, inverted H&S pattern on the monthly S&P chart.

snapshot
Note
[ Album ]
The bullish RSI divergence has (temporally at least) formed on time frames as high as the daily

If this holds, then BTC up before any retest of the 200WMA ~25.6k.

Note how the bullish RSI divergence formed on Mar 3 at 22k, was followed by further downside to Mar 10 to 19.6k that kept the bullish divergence which catapulted to 28k. So further downside to perhaps ~27.2k is possible before the posited catapult to $30.3 - 31.8k. After posited 200 WMA $25.3 - 25.8k back test by 5-day period starting Apr 16, then posited up to fill CME gap 35.3k by 5-day period starting May 6.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
I (Nostradamus) predicted last October 2022.

> Natural Gas has a Shark pattern projection to below $3:
>
> snapshot


Nailed that one.

Time to buy Natural gas. Probably headed back up to ~$5. Multiple drives of bullish RSI divergence.

snapshot

For U.S., UK and Aussie investors, perhaps the easiest way to buy this in UNG on Robinhood:

robinhood.com/stocks/UNG/

For outside the U.S.:

topratedfirms.com/articles/non-resident/robinhood-for-foreign-citizens.aspx

reddit.com/r/investing/comments/dy3htl/comment/f7y3qva/

quora.com/Are-there-any-alternatives-to-the-trading-app-Robinhood-for-those-who-live-outside-the-United-States/answer/Hitoshi-Harada-1
Note
13:33 Oil also. Yikes. Sell risk-on stocks in May and go away. Horrible risk-on crash ahead perhaps by Q1 2024.

youtu.be/ktGHQPnnYxM?t=813 ← click for Ron’s chart
Note
21:41 Ron thinks the market bottoms on Fed pause and crash on pivot.

The Fed skipped the pause and went direct back to QE with the BTFP bank centralization pogrom.
This is why Ron does not understand that the risk-on markets are already pricing in the looming Fed funds pause. Thus Ron will miss the entire rally to ~4700. He did say that if there is a close above 4200, “something else going on…maybe three drives to a high.” So ostensibly he read my emails, and/or he noticed that his posited DXY wedge/channel breakout failed today.

youtu.be/ktGHQPnnYxM?t=1301
(OPEC+ Oil Cut Is Bad News For Fed- S&P500, NASDAQ & AAPL get 9-9 Sell Signals on their Hourly Charts | Ron Walker)
Note
27.2k fulfilled as I predicted. I loaded all my bags. Let's see if drops lower to $25.6 - 26.3k before rally up to $30.8 - 31.8k. I am betting not.

The DXY collapsed but BTC dropped. I expect a reversion of that divergence this week. Unless the dollar suddenly rises again, possibly sending BTC down more.
Note
youtu.be/-NQu7AWVeak?t=845 ← click for Jason’s chart
(Late Bitcoin Investors Are Getting WIPED OUT with This Bullish SP500 Move. | What About Crypto? | Jason Pizzino)

14:05 Most likely up to $30.3 - 31.8k before back testing the 25.6k 200 WMA because as you said too many are waiting for that level, so need to trap them on the upside first. On the pull back today to 27.2k (which btw was the price I predicted which can be verified on my trading view updates), the bullish RSI divergences formed to send the price back up. But I am not ruling out a test of ~26.3k. After the posited 200 WMA back test, next up might be the ~35.3k CME gap fill. Note the one thing I disagree with you is that I do think there will be a nasty crash in 2024 and the ~9.6k CME gap might be filled. In other words, the repeat of the March 2020 crash in 2024 will make a lower low unlike in 2020 where it made a higher low.
Note
> Don’t know if I’d agree with the more upside then downside. At major resistance at 29k 32k… think that we will see 14% plus to the downside!

Think about the psychology. Everyone is waiting for that huge pullback so they can board the train they missed. Instead much better to send the price up to $30+k to make them FOMO the breakout of overhead resistance, then trap them with a back test of the 200 WMA ~25.6k (which is near the major horizontal support ~25.3k) Then trap them again to the upside to fill that 35.3k CME gap. Anyway, doesn’t have to play out that way, but the top won’t be at least until May so averaging back in long now is a wise strategy.

> > Not going to lie... I've been unsubscribing and cleaning up my subscription list lately, especially in the crypto space. Jason is a keeper, in my top 5.
>
> I did that in 2021 KROWN and mitch ray are the only TA guys i fw. No fundamentals content. would never unsub jason tho. Goal is to learn more to not need anyone.


Eric Krown Crypto is a keeper also. Crypto Crew U is worthwhile for broad confirmation but nothing for calling precise tops and bottoms. Mott Capital Markets is excellent. I also follow FX Evolution for his statistical data thoughts in the intros, but I critically analyze those on my trading view. Ron Walker (The Crypto Trader) I use as fodder for stimulating my rebuttals to those who try to apply myopic T/A to crypto (he has been wrong since Q4 2022). Game of Trades had the right theme that markets would rally on the pause but then totally changed his stance and has been wrong since October.
Note
> Or drive it down to 26 k for 5 minutes let everyone buy the pull back, then keep going . Same thing ain’t it. We are looking like we are for sure running out of steam. At massive resistance
>
> We have already wicked up into resistance a few times!


crypto AL agreed that 26.3k is another possible wick down on my charts. Which would be just shy of the $25.3 - 25.6k level most are waiting for (not to let everyone buy it but to trap the longs and shorts). Yes we did hit overhead resistance more than once but that resistance is a range from $29 - 32k. I have a more fine-grained analysis on my trading view wherein I compared to the precise correspondence of the breakout level from comparable resistance in 2019. We are not at the top of this 2023 rally yet. Will at least hit 35.3k by May and possibly as high as $41 - 48k by June. As Jason said in his previous video, we will be able to better ascertain the plausible top as we move into the May time frame.
Note
0:55 Ron Walker again insulting everyone and claiming everyone hates him because he is always correct. He is gloating about failing to tell everyone to buy the bottom and missing out on 88% gain from 15.4k. What a clown and prima donna arsehurl.🤡🤡🤡 What rock is he going to hide under when Bitcoin and the stock markets melt up after the back test? I wonder if he will delete some his video? Or ’backsplain as he has been attempting to do in recent videos, claiming that he never said the rally would fail at 19.6k at most. 🤦🤡

youtu.be/ws4HmJlN6MM?t=52
(Bitcoin Bull Trap -- Get Ready For MAX Pain! Next BTC CRASH is About to Happen - You've Been Warned! | The Crypto Trader)
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=-NQu7AWVeak&lc=UgyMRKiYlbkJrFZ1n1V4AaABAg.9o3cq_6j2pV9o4XPDm8g3M

joshua Cheng Bitcoin is its current incarnation before it is resurrected from the WW3 ashes as 1988 Rothchild Economist Magazine cover story Phoenix (with the looming "anyone can spend" attack which I have fully documented) is entirely dependent on fiat money printing. Keep that in mind when understanding why Bitcoin will make a lower low in 2024 when it only made a double-bottom in March 2020. It would behoove you to go to my About and find my writings on this subject matter lest all your Bitcoins are going to be donated to the miners. Yes I know things that very few people know. Sorry not to brag. I do not care if you lose your Bitcoins. Go ahead.
Note
I posited a model for the remainder of Bitcoin’s 2023 rally. I doubt the rally will continue into July— annotated that just to allow for the possibility that the first thrust in January didn’t correlate to the first one (or 3 total) in 2019, because not until the second thrust up in March did price get above the 5-day Gaussian channel, which only took one thrust in 2019.

From 4 in Feb, BTC was resisting the DXY (dollar) rise ostensibly bcz so much breakout FOMO. Whereas since recent 4, BTC is resisting DXY drop bcz market expects a pullback (taking profits at strong horizontal resistance). Thus I think capitulation to low 26000s on DXY up test (not all way to 25.3k) then back up to 7. After 7, DXY breakout in earnest to cause major pull back to 8 into next Fed rate decision. Oil breaking out. Worry about Q1 earnings reports starting April 15.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
My comments:

youtu.be/dLorwaF2MUs
(Kiss $18,000 Bitcoin & $800 ETH Goodbye! USD Collapsing & More SP500 PAIN Coming for Investors | Jason Pizzino)

Jason Pizzino nope. Altcoin season not until Q4 2024.

Jason Pizzino Bitcoin will revisit $9 to 13k in 2024 after topping this May or June. I am very bullish after that. Bitcoin is its current incarnation before it is resurrected from the WW3 ashes as 1988 Rothchild Economist Magazine cover story Phoenix (with the looming "anyone can spend" attack which I have fully documented) is entirely dependent on fiat money printing. Keep that in mind when understanding why Bitcoin will make a lower low in 2024 when it only made a double-bottom in March 2020. It would behoove you to go to my About and find my writings on this subject matter lest all your non-legacy protocol address Bitcoins are going to be donated to the miners. Yes I know things that very few people know. Sorry not to brag. I do not care if you lose your Bitcoins. Go ahead.

After watching the video, I can comment more directly to Jason's thoughts on why he (incorrectly) thinks there will not be another flash crash event in 2024. 16:35 the 2024 black swan will likely be the insane Neocons going to push WW3 in Ukraine so they can suspend the 2024 election. Do you not see what they are going to Trump? And it was a plandemic, not a pandemic. Also given the high interest rate environment Bitcoin is much weaker than it was in 2020, and will proceed to a lower low. I have charted this on my Trading view. Draw a trend line between the 2018 and 2020 wick down lows and note that the 9.6k CME gap can be filled in Q1 2024 when the flash crash repeats. The entire 2019 to 2020 pattern is repeating. I had predicted it would back in Sept 2021 on my public trading view ideas.
Note
My comments:

youtu.be/-NQu7AWVeak
(Late Bitcoin Investors Are Getting WIPED OUT with This Bullish SP500 Move. | What About Crypto? | Jason Pizzino)

> S. Moore So you're saying that BTC will capitulation to 12.4K next year before the atomic spike to 124K.............

joshua Cheng correct but note Steve Courtney's (Crypto Crew U. YT channel) 5.3 factor model, which would limit Bitcoin to multiple of 5.3 of the prior bull run, thus 400% gain from the bottom. Thus if the bottom is 10k, the top price will be only 50k.

youtu.be/kGQZE2-Duxg?t=283
Note
My comments:

youtu.be/EFSKt5y8Opw
(Turbulence Ahead: Brace Yourself for a Market Downturn? | FX Evolution)

Sell in May and go away until September or October.

Interestingly both the bond market and the stock market are wrong. Fed will be forced to pause for longer because inflation will spike up again. Paradoxically this will exacerbate the downturn in the economy as well as the movement of deposits out of banks thus increasing QE via the Fed's BTFP. So expect stocks to peak by June, then decline into Sept, then start climbing again from October. An exact copy of 2019. Then in 2020 expect all hell to break loose with the launch of WW3 by the neocons. Another March 2020 flash crash. Mark my words.
Note
I have been selling this anticipated small bounce as I expect down to point 6 as marked on my model. Note the declining volume pattern seems to concur with my model thesis. DXY is threatening to bounce as I expected and had drawn. I look at my indicators, including RSI divergences to help me ascertain my hypotheses.

snapshot
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/gl7QIgNuDh4
(WARNING: Bitcoin Will NOT REACH 100K In This Market Cycle | Crypto Crew University)

crypto Crew University Steve now apply your 5.3 factor model to a 9.6k CME gap fill in 2024. As you see Bitcoin is dying. But how can that be? Now go back to what I was explaining to you in email about the "anyone can spend" restoration of legacy protocol Bitcoin rising as the new world reserve currency ~2028.
Note
My comments:

youtu.be/MnP-LKuK44A
(The Stock Market Rally Looks Exactly Like These 3 Iconic Tops | Last Rally Before the Recession | Game of Trades)

In 1952, the stock market rallied for months following the signal GoT is citing. Also the prior 3 instances he cited are incomparable because the Fed wasn’t doing stealth QE! I keep emailing GoT’s research team about their numerous errors over the past several weeks with their premature bearishness. GoT subscribers will be REKTD by this rally.

> Usually the case! He called for ATH by end of 2022🤣🤣
>
> Now that that didn’t happen he’s going other direction.


Krusty indeed. GoT is always out-of-phase by about 6 - 9 months. The lower-low is coming in 2024 after this ~4700 rally into May/June.
Note
> > When this channel is so extremely bearish it´s time to go all in. :)
>
> Please do.


soloman747 I did at 15.4k on BTC and 3600 on the S&P when I identified the Wycoff and Shark harmonic pattern bottoms respectively. Up we go to 37k and ~4700.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/ITA5hRLtpIQ?t=660
(Epic Bitcoin Move Coming, Stocks Charts About To Explode, Gold Targets Revealed | Gareth Soloway)

11:00 that trend line on BTC from 64k through 48k loses its resistance because it forms the apex of a triangle with the major overhead horizontal resistance (ditto Nvidia also). This indicates that this is the juncture where Bitcoin will break out above that strong overhead horizontal resistance. Bitcoin will pullback a bit this week, then rocket next week to ~31.8k, then crash into first week of May. Then it will explode to fill that 35.3k CME gap. S&P going to break out headed to ~4700.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/qjDQW0X9HhU
(Trump shows Xi and Peng video clips of his granddaughter singing Chinese songs)

> I'm Chinese and I found this heartwarming, sadly reality won't let this happen forever

Malaysian Mapping sadly the power vacuum of the collective demands capture by the most ruthless. It's not Xi’s fault that ruling the power vacuum requires the capture of power. If we want to change humanity, we have to find a way to eliminate the power vacuum. That is why I delved deep into block chain technology starting with my conversations with the likes of Charles Hoskinson and Daniel Larimer on bitcointalk in 2013 before they became publicly well known. Unfortunately there's some deep flaws in the technology as it currently stands.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/bx34KlOl-vg
(This is Now Worse Than Before the 2008 Financial Crisis | SP500 Textbook Market Rally | Game of Trades)

This is wrong because in prior instances of recessionary crash, the Fed was easing but not dealing with the underlying contagion until after the eruption. Whereas now the Fed is preemptively backstopping the banks preventing the contagion. This backstop is flooding the market with liquidity, some of it into money markets and some into stonks. But as the unemployment rises the Fed will ease which will force money out of money markets into stonks. So this is a repeat of 2019 to 2020, where the rally will peak in June and then pullback until the Fed eases (in Sep 2019 it was a resumption of QE) then rally again until some blackswan (hint: WW3) slams us in 2024. Indeed there will be a pullback in the stonks after June as the tightening financial conditions impact employment, but this will not be a contagion into a recession. This recession can only come when inflation is triggered again with war, thus trapping the Fed.
Note
I should note that definitions of recession have been so perverted that’s not the correct term to use, although I use in that context because the vlogger did. Ostensibly been in a recession since 2022 given the much higher rate of inflation than the BLS admits with its hedonics. Essentially contagion drives the market crashes, e.g. unwinding the dotcom and financial system cum real estate bubbles in the prior two non-COVID recessions. Where is the bubble now with houses in undersupply and dotcom (e.g. Apple) flush with (53B in) cash? The only plausible contagion (other than commercial real estate) was in the banks but that has been backstopped. Inflation isn’t going to skyrocket with re-globalization underway. There has to be some shock to the system (e.g. COVID) to create a flash crash. There’s the sovereign debt bubble but that’s not yet near a crisis inflection, although WW3 could bring that to a head.
Note
My comments:

youtu.be/c6WUyvtpg-U
(Bitcoin How High Will This Rally Go? {330,000} | Eric Krown Crypto)

CORRECTION: 6:35 the bottom of first std dev price is ~31.85k not 32.3k as you claimed. 1:14, 6:50 you’re noting the typical “free ride” to the top of weekly CME Gaussian channel currently ~32.8k, but note the top is ~$31.85 on the weekly Gaussian channel for the (BTC index) spot price. I have on my chart the last level of strong horizontal resistance exactly $31.85. And I have the overhead trend line of this rally at $31.85 on Sunday. Sunday would be 7 days from the Monday start of your cited daily volatility expansion breakout signal. I computed from your data, the std dev of 9.29 mean days is 2.57, thus a 67% confidence range of ~7 to 12 days, and 95% confidence interval ~5 to 14 days. Thus price to possibly top over the weekend $31.85, then decline to test the ~25.3k level (200 WMA and breakout horizontal support), before making that thrust up to fill the 35.3k CME gap. Historically every time the top of the spot price weekly Gaussian band top was hit, there was a retest to the mid-band which will be ~25.3k on the first week of May date of the expected bottom of posited pullback.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
My follow-up reply to a reader who didn’t understand:

S. Moore I dont get your point, I didnt really try to get it, but if your going to pull wings off flies, did you compute or calculate?

Michael omega {Trading view does not allow inserting the symbol!} means standard deviation, mu is the symbol for the mean. I am explaining that the math for Krown’s daily volatility expansion signal data suggests that the top of the weekly Gaussian channel (which is ~31, 850 on Bitcoin index spot price chart as opposed to the CME chart) is likely to be the top of this move up, perhaps on Sunday. After that I am expecting a significant pullback to the median of the weekly Gaussian channel, which is ~25,300, as was historically ALWAYS the case. I am pointing out that Eric did not notice this. I doubt very much he will acknowledge my astute comment, because he is a jerk that way.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/Ug31FNpRiuQ
(BITCOIN MEGA-ALERT!!!!! THE MOTHER OF ALL SIGNALS JUST FLASHED!!!!!!! IT’S FINALLY HAPPENING!!!!! | Crypto Zombie)

Price historically always comes back down to retest the median of the weekly Gaussian channel (currently ~25,300) on the Bitcoin index chart, after testing the top of the channel. Top of channel for this week is ~31,850, which is also the highest level of the current strong overhead horizontal resistance. I expect this to top by Sunday and crash into first week of May before next leg up to fill that ~35300 CME gap. Note the weekly Super Guppy has not been as accurate in timing the retest of the median of the weekly Gaussian support, as the Gaussian channel itself.
Note
Just letting you guys know I personally am reloading some of the BTC I sold 30.2k, currently DCAing a portion ~29.9k. I had sold while I was checking my logic on whether BTC would likely hit 31.8k or top out lower perhaps 30.5k which was the first overhead target. There’s no guarantee BTC heads to 31.8k before any significant pullback, but there’s also no guarantee that BTC doesn’t breakout to 35.3k immediately (doubt it though). Eric Krown Crypto’s statistics on the daily volatility expansion signal call for a likely greater move with the minimum upside of the first std deviation (i.e. 67% confidence interval) being 31.85k. Thus I feel better having some skin in the game to the upside at least until ~31.5k, then take some profits on an expected severe pullback.
Note
I reloaded some more ~29.8k.

FYI, Eric Krown Crypto's latest confirms that he is now 100% in congruence with my expectation. I believe he read my comment. So maybe he is not as much of an intransigent jerk (Virgo) as I thought. Maybe it is a Millennial vs. Gen X thing. Anyway, I appreciate his channel and effort. Just rubs me a bit the wrong way with his intransigence at times (seems so set in his ways, e.g. "nobody can know a pattern in advance...there's only statistics and nothing else", etc).

He is closed-minded and arrogant about it at times. That is a trait I really despise. Nevertheless I appreciate his take on the markets.
Note
I’m taking profits if hit overhead trend line at ~30.7k. Expect it to come back down again before making the assault on ~31.8k Sunday or thereafter.

Note if there’s a breakout on my trend line on the S&P, I could flip to the stance that heading directly to 35.3k before a significant correction, but I’m still doubting this.
Note
Jason Pizzino liked my extensive 11 comments on the overall macro situation. This will become a new blog shortly.

youtube.com/watch?v=eds6U3eePSQ&lc=UgzAJaHpsLg9RFEoFBx4AaABAg
Note
Eric Krown completely adopts my 31.8k level.

youtu.be/BoMLn5w0NTI?t=551
Note
So far my model is working well. Probably heading up to 31.8k by Sunday or next week, if not sooner.

Indeed, but most of us should have other options soon…

snapshot
Note
Kevin Svenson clearly lined up the Parabolic Curve Pattern incorrectly for the current rally. Supposed to only ~double from current point, yet he has it tripling. which makes no sense along with consideration of the bullish wedge projection. I have fixed it. The Parabolic Curve pattern is targeting ~38 - 41k for next wave up and ~58k final blow-off top. This may not be the correct pattern though because the final drop from SWB:17K to 15k seems to have violated the pattern and thus this seems to be instead a Wycoff Accumulation.

youtu.be/SoIa_XMq6as?t=192 ← click for chart
(#Bitcoin's Trend is STRONG!!! MORE UPSIDE COMING??? | Kevin Svenson Crypto)

snapshot
Note
The prior posted Parabolic Curve pattern seems incorrect because base 3 should probably be below the media of the Gaussian channel. My edit seems much more sensible and realistic.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Crypto Crew U. put out a video noting that the red line needs to touch or get above the brown line on the TDIGM indicator before the price topped in 2019 (and 2015). But looks quite implausible that will happen in April. In fact, there appears to be a monthly pattern on this rally that is different from the 2019 rally in that one month up followed by a “spinning top” indecision month, then repeat. So April should be an indecision month and May another month up. Whether there is one more thrust up first to $31.3 - 31.8k, I think there will be a significant correction down to the median of the weekly Gaussian channel before the final blow-off top to ~38k.

April's spinning top would be a copy of February with a move up to 31.8k then a move down to 27k. And then May should start with a flush down to ~$25.5 before the rally to ~38k.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
All I see so far is Bitcoin heading down to ~$25.3 - 26k, right on schedule with the charts I had posted, with another up wave incoming in May as I predicted.

Someone replied to my comment wherein I was responding yet again to the typical argument that historically a massive crash is incoming as the Fed cuts rates. Also the clickbait headline is just Larry Fink of BlackRock selling 7% of this stock which only has one data point as preceding a crash. Larry Fink recently stated in an interview that he does not expect a crash.

youtube.com/watch?v=b5dU6CB-QrE&lc=UgytyOChCOuPOyxCgsZ4AaABAg
(Unbelievable! Insider Who Sold Stock Before the 2020 Crash Just Did It Again... | FX Evolution)

The mechanism is different than the 2008 GFC, bcz of the Fed's BTFP p(r)ogrom. These failures will force regional banks who lent heavily, to access the Fed for liquidity, thus driving the net Fed reserve liquidity back up again, all before the Fed ever cuts rates.

> "Thank you for the insights. It's interesting to consider how the Fed's BTFP program may impact the current economic situation differently than the 2008 GFC. It will be important to monitor regional banks' access to Fed liquidity in the coming months."

AS hjhj Larry Fink recently stated in an interview that he does not expect a crash.
Note
> "S. Moore This is just a prediction. Do you have a better insight? Dear Friend"

AS hjhj Since October I have a Shark harmonic pattern bottom on the S&P and Nasdaq. S&P must hit at least 4650 probably by June. Also I have Bitcoin hitting at least 335 - 41k, before I sell in summer and go away. I had predicted a correction into the first week of May. I sold recently and will be buying the correction. I publicly said to buy in Oct, I predicted NatGas to decline from 5 to 2, and I publicly stated to buy Bitcoin at 15.4k due to the Wycoff accumulation bottoming pattern. You should find my trading view.

AS hjhj my long-term outlook concurs with Jason Pizzino. We are in a bull market now until 2026 because the Fed will monetize the centralization of the banking system (it is part of the master plan to enslave us). There will be a pullback into Sept. Then perhaps another flash crash in Q1 2024 similar to 2020. From there up, up into 2025. I prefer less drama, make only a few trades per year or every other year at major inflection points.
Note
Inflation FUD. Meet Kevin explains well. B.T.F.D.!

youtu.be/buoP5JNDhT8
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=KpFHfhIbovI&lc=Ugx67hJcANFKcMW1o394AaABAg
(Confronting Legendary Hedge Fund Trader on Coming Crash | Bob Kendall & Meet Kevin)

I am 32 minutes in and so far I think the generative essence hasn't been articulated. Essentially the Fed can backstop everything (because banks hold Tbonds instead of the toxic waste derivatives) thus fighting the deflation of the Minsky Moment thus keeping inflation and interest rates both high. What this is doing is centralizing the entire system (including the banking system), in that only those who can invest money will keep afloat and everyone else will be nourished by peak socialism of govt. He says there will not be any banking crisis, but that is because the BTFP discount window is open to backstop everything. But those regional banks (hit by C.R.E. implosion) will essentially become zombie banks depending on the Fed's liquification of hold to maturity. This is why I say this is all a master plan program (remove the first r and replace the a with an o) of ubiquitous serfdom. The CBDC plays into this. Of course they want to restructure the debt to, "you will own nothing, you rent everything, and you will still be happy receiving UBI from the government doled out by CBDC." Essentially peak socialism is attempting to find a way to permanent utopia, but of course this will ultimately fail. This is not good. Read Arthur Hayes' *Kaiseki*.

entrepreneurshandbook.co/kaiseki-b15230bdd09e
Note
In short, this guy doesn't piece together the big picture. He seems to think that we are in some form of normalization. Which is impossible with the level of debt. Instead the only way to rescue peak socialism is to centralize everything. Thus this is not comparable to the Volker era, when the U.S. was still able to expand debt in a more free market system. No we are now at the end game of the failure of the govt itself, but this will be pushed until aftermath of the incoming WW3.
Note
I do not profess to know for sure what is causing the wild volatility on Bitcoin, but I think it was Jason Pizzino who noted in a video I viewed yesterday that First Republic Bank stock plummet another 43% thus perhaps heightened expectations of more banks heading to the Fed’s discount window increasing the net balance sheet and/or that Fed might pause in May. Anyway, I stick to the thesis that any pullback into early May is the precursor for another move higher to at least fill the long-standing 35.3k CME gap.
Note
Martin Armstrong wrote in his latest private blogs that he expects the uniparty NEOCONS to employ a false-flag to the launch WW3 with Russia before the 2024 elections. They ostensibly need this pretext to essentially cancel or rig the 2024 election with Biden the winner despite his never-be-seen-in-history 70% disapproval ratings. Biden of course is drugged on adrenochrome. Expect the CBDCs to be coming to trap everyone in Hotel Commiefornia-esque 666 centralized digital currencies as Arthur Hayes had explained in his *Kaiseki* blog.

entrepreneurshandbook.co/kaiseki-b15230bdd09e

“You can check in any time you like, but you can never leave.”

The door on freedom in the West is closing. GTFO to a Non-Aligned Movement country asap. Get your assets out of the West asap. That is unless someone figures out how to game the incoming CBDCs and make them convertible to fully decentralized cryptocurrencies such as legacy protocol Bitcoin. The capital controls preventing this will be intense, remember Yanet Jellan was even proposing that every transaction below $ 600 would need to be reported to the IRS.

en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Non-Aligned_Movement

Note Armstrong is entirely incorrect on the eventual outcome of Bitcoin, which will of course slay the NEOCONS and rise to be the new international reserve asset. Armstrong with his silly nonsense about Bitcoin relying on the grid which I have written to him many times to tell him that is not correct. Bitcoin has 10 minute block periods and only needs to transmit a hash of the block solution, which can easily be transmitted by short-wave radio. And Bitcoin mining can be performed off-grid with battery-backed solar or micro-hydro power. Also many Non-Aligned Movement countries are allowing Bitcoin mining and will refuse to genuflect to NEOCONs when push comes to shove in the incoming WW3.

Armstrong almost understands everything but has a huge blindspot w.r.t. Bitcoin.

Of course Armstrong is correct that many people will be trapped by the CBDCs and capital controls, thus unable to access Bitcoin (except via capital controlled ETFs). But the big money that survives will have exited to Bitcoin and will continue to game the system siphoning off assets into Bitcoin. Armstrong is going to witness this over the coming years and be entirely flabbergast. It will be a sight to behold when he finally admits he was blind as a bat.
Note
Doug Casey has a new blog article pondering if the NEOCONS are about to make a mess of our relationship with Mexico and essentially create a DMZ along the southern border. Remember Mexico was defying all that COVID crap and many Americans were traveling to Mexico to escape the diktats. So maybe the NEOCONS need (a low-level perhaps even undeclared along the border?) war with Mexico also!

internationalman.com/articles/doug-casey-on-the-us-government-declaring-war-on-mexican-drug-cartels/

To elaborate just a bit. Of course tangible assets are a threat to capital controls which might be another reason they need to make the southern border highly monitored so no one can escape to Latin America with their gold. Which is of course why Bitcoin is rising to be the new digital gold. Physical gold and real estate are dying as stores of wealth. Bitcoin is rising to replace them, and Armstrong is going to destroy his subscribers by giving them myopic advice suggesting they avoid Bitcoin as a store of wealth and instead buy precious metals. Duh!

The problem with fungible tangible assets like gold is that all the liquidity is provided by the market makers (aka dealers and their dealers), which can be easily regulated and forced to enforce capital controls. A black market in gold is nonsense because the warlords will know you have it, because you must exchange it in person because it is physical crap. Physical assets will become entirely immovable in this digital panopticon world we have entered by now with a camera in every device and on every lamppost. This is why it will only be Bitcoin that survives. Sorry Armstrong is on the wrong side of history on this one.
Note
BTC skyrocketed from $ 27k to $ 30k when First Republic Bank's stock cratered anew. It only takes one more news of contagion to send BTC back up again. That net Fed liquidity chart hasn't predicted anything since 2021. It has been entirely useless, except as a short-term moves indicator. We knew BTC would be under a bit of pressure here at ~$ 31k because of strong horizontal resistance and because of the net Fed liquidity had declined.

Wall of Worry all the way up to the targeted top no less than ~35.3k.

One thing that has been driving the markets up are short squeezes, because everyone is bearish and expecting a recession now, yet there is still no sign of a recession. Credit crunch does not matter when it does not affect those investors flush with cash. The credit crunch is affecting breadth of stocks because investors are very cautious, but this rally can not end until the herd piles into meme stocks.

The credit crunch will affect the office space sector which will affect the regional banks which will lead to more contagion fears which can propel BTC up to our targets. But this will not be a contagion that takes down the entire economy because the impasse over the debt limit will be solved and the govt will be handing out candy again .

The flash crash will not be until Q1 or Q2 2024 when the NEOCONS launch a false-flag to justify NATO directly engaging Russia in WW3.

This rally is not finished until the S&P hits at least 4650 which is the minimum harmonic projection I have had since the Oct bottom. Too many people bearish, short covering will propel it up.

Fed will pause soon. Pauses always correspond to a final rally in the stock market. Insiders do not try to exactly time the top or bottom, so they are selling now into what appears to be illogical strength in the markets.

After this summer peak, the markets will decline into Sept or Oct, then they will rally again as they did in 2019 and 2020, before the flash crash in Q1 or Q2 2024.

They will rally because there will some easing in financial conditions.
Note
Minor Distribution within Larger Accum.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=LBsMn-PTqUo&lc=UgzcJ5MeLp9qvNEyPdN4AaABAg.9pIYBLDTRBx9pLCDOF_oa7
(NOBODY is Paying Attention to This UNDERVALUED and Cheap Market)

Alessio Rastani Silver is almost duplicating Bitcoin's gains. I see no reason to prefer it over Bitcoin. Either I have to hold tonnes of physical metal or all I will own is an IOU. With CBDCs coming, all IOUs will become trapped in looming WW3 capital controls. No doubt it is a decent speculation, but I do not have time for speculation. It is how I escape out the other side of the crap coming with my wealth intact that is more critical at this juncture. I had written publicly in 2010 predicting silver to go from ~$26 to ~$50 by summer 2011 and back down to ~$25 again. Nailed that one.
Note
Game of Trades put out a video suggesting that based on numerous instances of the parallel channel on the non-log (i.e. linear) scaled S&P 500 chart, that S&P is about to crash. However, those prior instances did not exhibit a mega-bullish Shark harmonic pattern, which bottomed in October 2022. Also the overlayed FedFunds rate on my chart below clearly shows that never did the S&P crash as the Fed entered a pause. GoT is ignoring that fact that the Fed has backstopped everything already with their BTFP (“buy the friggin pause”) program.

Also Fed net liqudity is increasing again with the recent bank failures with PacWest about to fail also. Also FX Evolution pointed out that the smart money has started reaccumulating again after selling off significantly since March.

snapshot

P.S. THIS WORK IS WHAT YOU GUYS ARE REALLY HERE READING MY POSTS FOR. I JUST SO HAPPENED TO ASSIMILATE MULTIPLE REPEATING FACTORS, NOT JUST FOCUS ON ONE REPEATING PATTERN.
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


"shelby3, We are now in a prime location above the confirmed critical support zone of 28,650-28,350 to make a jump above 30,000 and then we can start looking for a distribution box. This box would be perhaps with a range of about $15,000, which gives us a zone of approx. 31,000-46,000. The best thing for me would be to close the core long position and have a chance to sell short over the box, somewhere in the low-risk zone between 49,000-58,000. This should play out by the end of August. If BTC goes below 28,650-28,350 and does not return with strong momentum (like yesterday) above this zone, then we can dive in May somewhere between 26,010-24,700.

Looking at the fundamentals, I think everyone can see that BTC is going up thanks to the fuel from the QE pump."


goodblackcat, whether BTC has one final shakeout to bottom of the Weekly Gaussian channel at ~25.3k (which is also near the 200 WMA) is the only remaining question. But for sure Bitcoin is headed to 35.3k or higher no later than end of June, probably in May.

2023 - Year From Hell


"shelby3, Even if $20,000 proves to be a very strong support over the next 12 months, playing the short side of the market around 43,000-58,000 is likely to be very fruitful.

Overall, at this point, I'm assuming it's reasonable to assume that BTC will drop again by $50,000 before it hits $100,000. Even if BTC breaks ATH by $10,000-15,000, I will still bet on a pullback of at least $50,000."


goodblackcat, historically as Eric Krown Crypto has shown that Bitcoin should rally above the Weeky Gaussian channel, then it should come back down to test the top of it or back to the bottom of it as was the case in 2020. As for the next ATH in 2025, refer to Steve Courtney’s (aka Crypto Crew U.) 5.3 factor model which says the next high will be 398% higher than the bottom. Thus if 15.4k was the bottom (i.e. no lower-low in 2024) then the next ATH in 2025 will be ~77k. Whereas if Bitcoin drops with another flash crash in 2024 to perhaps fill that long-standing CME gap 9.6k, then Bitcoin will rally to ~38k and never again make a new ATH. The reason for a flash crash could be that the uniparty mafia NEOCONs who have usurped control of the U.S. and NATO are pushing for WW3 with Russia to begin before the 2024 U.S. POTUS election so they can steal the election again. Also appears they are going to blame the horrific side-effects of the C19 jabs (my formerly healthy mother has ostensibly acquired Parkinson’s disease from taking 4 jabs) on another p(L)andemic with for example the new alleged leak from the bioweapon lab in Sudan. They blamed the first p(L)andemic on China and ostensible blame the second one on Russia. If Bitcoin never makes another ATH that would be the impostor Bitcoin 2017 softfork protocol that I oft write about in great detail, and the legacy protocol would eventually bifurcate (aka hark fork off) and go on to astronomical highs as legacy protocol Bitcoin becomes the world reserve currency in this emerging multipolar world. That said, I am more inclined to believe that Bitcoin might not fill that 9.6k gap until 2026 or 2028, when the impostor Bitcoin dies in the ANYONECANSPEND restoration event that often write about.
Note
Additionally if we draw the parallel channel on the log-scaled chart, the S&P 500 has already broken out and has two weekly bullish candles off the top of the parallel channel!!

snapshot
Note
Eric Krown Crypto has posted a near-term bullish video on Ethereum. He points out a bullish ascending triangle, regular bullish RSI divergence on the-day chart. Also I have my long-standing identified BAT harmonic pattern projecting to 3200.

E.K.C. thinks ETH:BTC can only rally to 0.07 and possibly only ~2600-2700, but I have that level and also possibly 0.073, 0.077 and 0.085 if that diagrammed bullish, declining wedge is fulfilled to the upside. Thus potentially ETH to 3200 and BTC to $37 - 45k.

Also note that in 2019, ETH was below the median of the weekly Gaussian channel in May but this May it is above it. Thus ETH is becoming more of a blue-chip like Bitcoin and should rally above the Gaussian channel along with Bitcoin.

Additionally my thesis is that this final move up will coincide with all those greater fools FOMOing in as they realize they were wrong expecting a lower-low in the S&P and crypto. PEPE memecoin skyrocketed on launch past week. N00bs are asking me about crypto again. FOMO will peek-a-boo into June then fail until late 2024ish.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Also the Shark harmonic pattern requires the extension of 1.618 with a range of 0.886 to 1.13, thus the minimum price target is ostensibly my long-stated 4800 at 1.0 and 1.618. Also (unlike when I first identified it Oct 2022) it is no longer mathematically possible to decline to a lower-low at the bottom of the posited parallel channel and still form a bullish harmonic thus I think this Shark harmonic is definitely in play. Yet note harmonic patterns project to price targets but not timing. Thus the 4800 target could be fulfilled perhaps later in the year or Q1 2024, as was the case in 2019 to 2020, where the summer rally fizzled out but there was another push higher into Q4 and Q1 before the C19 crash.

snapshot
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=zC0CyVytG98&lc=UgxJeFAyYvJhLqtk3uR4AaABAg.9pFv6WnNkV69pQP9Osh-OA

> > {my comment} This is incorrect. If drawn the log-scaled chart, the price has currently already broken up above the parallel channel, and have two weekly closed with bullish hammers off the top of the channel, which has now become support. Also there was no harmonic pattern bottom on the prior instances unlike the one now projecting to at least 4650.
>
> "S. Moore has it been backtested against impending recessions at other points in time?"

SamUel Chan back testing is Lies, Statistics and Damned Lies, because it assumes that the expected variable is independent. It would help if you actually studied Probability and Statistics theory, which btw I aced at the university in 1985. The fact that I pointed out that the prior instances didn’t exhibit a bullish (in this case Shark) harmonic bottom is an indication that the posited back test is not independent of other factors, e.g. the macro economic environment is different because for example the Fed already backstopped everything with their BTFP program. Also superimpose a FedFunds rate chart and you see those prior instances were after a pause. Never has the rally not continued into the pause. Duh.
Note
Armstrong's machine learning Socrates is expecting some volatility on gold this coming week. We also have the possible failure of May 9 meeting on the debt ceiling and the possibility of Brandon ordering the Treasury to use some interpretation of the 14th amendment to circumvent the U.S. Congress! Of course that would not stand up to Constitutionality if our courts are still sane. It is possible that markets drop into this coming week before blasting through resistance?

axios.com/2023/05/02/debt-ceiling-14th-amendment-mint-coin
Note
My rebuttal:

youtube.com/watch?v=eoE-szu1F0I&lc=UgwfyNuj-14c0ePNv9J4AaABAg
(More Evidence Points to Stocks Pricing In a Recession in 2023 | History Likes to Repeat | Game of Trades)

It is mostly incorrect to compare 1968 and 2022. Price inflation in 1968 was driven by the demand side, because the largest demographic bulge ever Boomers were coming into their prime earning and spending years. Even silver had to be removed from U.S. coins in 1965. Thus the only way to bring demand down was to raise Fed Funds north of 8%! But note that inflation did not come down, whereas it has been coming down currently as the supply chain has been recovering. That is why you need to understand that the current cycle hinges more on the resumption of the looming world war and the second pandemic has already been scheduled for 2025. The first, recently concluded pandemic was scheduled back in 2017 for those who were paying attention. Whereas currently the price inflation is driven by money stimulus (i.e. debt-based and pumping money into Ukraine) and supply destruction from COVID and the war. Thus Fed fund rates topping out just above only 5%.

Also the Boomers in 1968 were not stock investors, whereas nearly everyone is in the stock market now and there is a huge amount of cash on the sidelines that can slosh around running from investment theme to theme as the winds shift. Heck who was going to invest in the S&P back in 1969 when they could get greater than 8% risk-free. Even you have admitted that the markets were not pricing in a recession in 1968, whereas currently everyone is hedging short at various moments (e.g. the recent bank failures) which is driving the markets up in a stair-case pattern. Was there even pervasive short selling in 1968?

You have charted that the bear market rallied during the Fed's pausing and did not decline anew until the Fed starting cutting. The Fed has not even paused yet. Historically inverted yield curves precede a recession by anywhere from 6 to 18 months. That fact alone will not dictate the bear market rally must terminate now as the Fed is nearing a pause. You are overplaying that posited downtrending parallel channel, as it is an independent variable (in Probability and Statistics theory) but it is not (proven to be so). For one thing, if you zoom out then the scale of the current, posited parallel channel only looks comparable to the past ones if on the log-scaled chart. On the log-scaled chart, the price has already broken above the top of the posited parallel channel and has two bullish, weekly doji candles which have tagged the top the posited channel.

Looks to me it is basing preparing for a move higher to ~4800 to fill the Shark pattern harmonic October bottom which none of the prior instances of the posited parallel channel had any harmonic bottom, meaning each down wave was much more severe than 1.1618. That is major clue which you are entirely ignoring even though I been telling you this for months. Sheesh. How can the future Fed pause be priced already into stocks when the majority of the market is bearish and cautious as evident by none of the meme stocks participating and only a few stocks leading the market higher. Everyone is positioned cautiously with a hedge against a crash. The majority of the market is usually wrong. They will come rushing in as S&P breaks above 4300 and you will have egg all over your face. Mark my word. We may still have one final washout this week tied up with the U.S. debt ceiling and then the melt up. Note plausibly the 4800 target is for later in 2023 or early 2024, and perhaps top out ~4650 this June or July and decline first.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=zC0CyVytG98&lc=UgxJeFAyYvJhLqtk3uR4AaABAg.9pFv6WnNkV69pTT0DK0goC

> "I'm a contrarían trader myself but even I can't deny the strength and market structure being built the past several months. While these channels looks beautiful, the big difference between now and those past events is that the smaller Moving Averages (MA) have already crossed well above the 50 week SMA while the past bear markets never rebuilt this structure and pushed well below their 200 SMA. Don't fight the current trend. Wait a few months to look to the downside...it'll come for sure."

Ethan Cervantes ty for the follow-up to my comments. Well done for finding other metrics of building structure that were not correlated by GoT.
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


goodblackcat, not clear to me if going to break down lower first. I will pile on leveraged long if it comes down to the 200 WMA. Ron Walker still calling for sub-20k. Thinks this is a bearish H&S pattern possibly projecting 24.4k?

snapshot
Note
Bitoin is not going below $ 25k before breaking through to $ 35.3+k.. I will be piling on leveraged long if prices come back down to the media of the weekly Gaussian channel.

snapshot
Note
BTC has hit the 200 WMA but there is only bullish RSI divergence on the 4 and 6 hourly. Would need to come down more to regain bullish RSI divergence on the 12 hourly and possibly daily.

So I am cautious here only nibbling on long leverage. Might bounce here to retest the H&S neckline as overhead resistance then come back down again. Or might head directly down from here.
Note
Blowoff top signals are forming. BTFD!

youtu.be/HIyP1YIfCTk
(Rare Market Pattern Sets Stage For Melt Up & Blow Off Top)
Note
Bitcoin is finding a low soon, if not already. My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=RMXngeAIHSI&lc=UgzkikiqZbAhq4BS5y54AaABAg
(Bitcoin last chance for hopium | Eric Krown Crypto)

I completely agree. Well go to my comments from weeks ago and I told you it would retest the mean band in second week of May, lol. Wrote that numerous times.
Note
Hit my first target exactly.

snapshot
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=5gU3xP2R7nQ&lc=Ugws-JQxBKczbOtv19x4AaABAg.9peKWuHRoAg9pfyztLZvM1
(Is an EARTHQUAKE Coming to the Markets (or has a bull market started)? | Gareth Soloway)

5:04 as I have pointed out numerous times to Game of Trades since the bottom I called in October on the S&P and Nasdaq, that the prior instances of crashes being cited as comparative are not at all similar despite the superficial visual similarity. The current Oct 2022 bottom has a very well defined Shark harmonic pattern bottom projecting to 4800+. It does not have to go all the 4800 in one swoop. Could break out of this range, then pullback into Q3 before rally again, as was the case in 2019. The prior instances such as the 2000/2001 crash not only did not have any harmonic bottom, the comparative period was only 11 weeks to the second lower-low and 25 weeks to the comparative juncture before the crash. Whereas, the current October bottom was ~46 weeks and currently at 77 weeks out from the top. Gareth Soloway is exhibiting extreme blindness in this case.
Note
Once the U.S. debt ceiling passes or it’s clear it will be, the Bitcoin rally is finished (or near to) until the Fed is forced to stop QT later. The dollar has been bouncing presumably because of expectations the debt ceiling will be raised.

cointelegraph.com/news/bitcoin-price-risk-us-debt-deal-to-trigger-1t-liquidity-crunch-analyst-warns

The wrangling over the debt ceiling could send Bitcoin up again, especially if the Fed pauses in June before debt ceiling is raised.

archive.is/https://fortune.com/crypto/2023/04/21/bitcoin-the-debt-ceiling-and-the-revolt-against-the-u-s-dollar/

cointelegraph.com/news/analysts-at-odds-over-fed-us-debt-ceiling-impact-on-bitcoin-price
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=Dnf4iisL5Qc&lc=Ugza16RR0S6BXQyrxfV4AaABAg
(Huge Signal!!! 🚨 Daily MACD flipping bullish | Kevin Svenson)

Yes one last pump. Make sure you sell in June. Kevin make sure you get your followers out at the high. At least should fill the 35.3k CME gap.
Note
At least a 15% drop coming (maybe more)


JerryManders, since I do not have access to and thus can't evaluate your data mining and applied math methodology, I can only reference the combination of techniques I have been employing. I am paying attention to the idea that if the debt ceiling passes, the reloading of the U.S. Treasury’s coffers will drain liquidity from the markets and also push interest rates up. Yet has this Fed pause, BTFP and short covering (too many have been hedging at every juncture) rally exhausted itself yet? Dollar is rallying ostensibly on either a fear of govt shutdown and/or interest rise when Treasury sells again into bond market. Yet initially the former would be relieved by any debt ceiling optimism before the latter. Also Bitcoin and Ethereum look like that want to make one more push to higher highs before this rally is completed. NDX looks to me like it is back testing significant resistance which it has flipped as support. The final blowoff peak could be this week perhaps? Or could your cutoff date of May 30 be a bit premature? I definitely agree on shorts heading into July. Just not sure about the imminent timing of incoming correction. My 'looks like' incorporates many factors such as for example bullish MACD cross curling back up on BTC.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=b0_SzaNFncE&lc=Ugw4tCkvThVaTx8rsyx4AaABAg
(Wow - Short Positioning In This Hasn't Been At This Level Since 2007, Plus These Stocks Are... | Mike Jones Investing)

Mike just remember that when the debt ceiling deal is completed, the Treasury will reload their account, thus draining liquidity and driving interest rates up. Expect the correction then and the rally to continue until. Those massive short positions keep driving the market higher. When the shorts give up, the top will be in. I expected we would see a rotation into the Russell 2000 before this rally tops out. Looks like it is ready to run up finally.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=SqWxLjp2n1U&lc=UgzjZbGU95xjtcJuSBF4AaABAg
(This Was A Major Reason For The Selloff Today, Plus Tesla Finally Did This! | Mike Jones Investing)

We already had the recession in 2022 but the stats were manipulated to hide it, because we live in a Communist regime now. We did not have an unemployment recession because people have been paid to not work. Double-dip recession in 2024 is highly likely. Note that 2001 chart structure does not have the Shark Harmonic bottom pattern that was established in October 2022. The Shark harmonic is projecting to ~4800+. It is possible to have a decline into Q3 before reaching that target by Q4 or Q1 which would repeat the 2019/20 pattern. Another flash crash coming in 2024? WW3 instead of C19? Also superimpose the Fed funds rate on the S&P chart. You will see there were always rallies into the pauses often to new ATHs.
Note
Market has to go up.

youtu.be/prF2-OccVrE?t=630 ← click for the chart
(SP500 At Tipping | Big Moving Coming | Jason McIntosh __ Motion Trader)
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=5iMLIEvSB8k&lc=UgyuQ9RkWzSkd0hqYRp4AaABAg
(This Won't End Well... | Euphoric Stock Market is On the Brink of a Massive Revaluation. | Game of Trades)

Russell 2000 is forming a mini-breakout to retest top of range as tech stocks take a breather and rotation is to lesser stocks instead of to prior defensive. Note in 2019 (which the 2023 is a copy of) the Russell 2000 was range bound while the S&P rallied into summer and then again into Q4/Q1. This pattern is repeating. Much of this rally has been about short squeezing as the FUD has everyone hedged. Until the majority stop expecting a crash, stocks will climb higher until the debt ceiling is resolved and Treasury starts to refill their account which will drain liquidity. Your mistake has been since the October bottom or at least in the past few months, is that you think a rally is not possible without breadth. Yes this rally will eventually top out, but only when you capitulate, hahaha.
Note
At least a 15% drop coming (maybe more)


> "shelby3, very good points, however, I trust my method here. Take a look at SPY in July 2011 going into the July 31st X date. Same setup on chart as current - the market will attempt to force the hand of policy makers by tanking the market going into the decision, which will cause them to raise the ceiling. I'm not basing my prediction on that, only the math/chart. Look out below."

JerryManders, I think the debt ceiling is FUD. Not likely to run out of funding until July 15 or even August, yet in any case not June 1. Also the spending they’re allegedly squabbling about is minuscule and mostly irrelevant. The macro economic situation and chart currently does not resemble July 2011. I think the pullback is almost complete as well the bounce in the dollar. Divergences are forming. Bitcoin may make one more plunge to ~25k. I highly doubt you’ll get -10% on the SPY, maybe at most -4%.

archive.is/https://www.nytimes.com/2023/05/24/us/politics/debt-ceiling-deal-federal-spending.html

EDIT: Lol, I just checked the Nvidia chart and it has exploded up +24%.
Note
When the yellow MA crosses above the cyan MA on the Pi Cycle Bottom indicator, Bitcoin surges. Then it comes back down to retest the yellow one more time before making a top. This second retest also corresponds to either a test of the median band, or top of, the weekly Gaussian channel.

Both conditions are met ~25K, thus Bitcoin preparing to surge soon to at least ~35.3k. When closing back below the yellow MA, the local top is in.

snapshot
Note
2023 - Year From Hell


goodblackcat, BTC must come below prior 25.8k low in order to establish bearish RSI divergence on the daily chart. I am expecting one more sweep down there.
Note
Typo: I meant bullish RSI divergence.

Also here is the corrected link: https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10177223
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=F0jBKB_ueGM&lc=UgzffKV_WzJs0m3OSS54AaABAg
(WARNING: Everyone Is WRONG About Bitcoin NEXT MAJOR MOVE – This Will Happen Instead | Crypto Crew U.)

Steve, hi Shelby from email here. Your involvement of the stochastic RSI has really aided my insight further than my comment on your prior video suggesting to you to overlay the weekly Gaussian channel on your Pi Cycle Bottom chart. I added the stoch-rsi along with SPX and NDX. This provided another cheat code (a hint) that every time the NDX diverges from the SPX to the upside, BTC's stoch-rsi quickly bullish crosses within ~3 weeks. The instances where the stoch-rise languishes below the 20 for a long time are when the NDX is also languishing relative to the SPX, i.e. that being an advance indicator of whether BTC's stoch-rsi will quickly turn back up. I have some very detailed elaboration on the charted update I just posted to my trading view.
Note
Re: my prior comment, BTC does not absolutely need to drop below 25.8k to form bullish RSI divergence on the daily, which has arguably already formed with BTC declining to double bottom ~25.8k while RSI remained above the level of the prior drop to 25.8k. Thus the rally may already be underway!

Thanks to another excellent insight from Steve Courtney @ Crypto Crew U., I added some more elements to my prior published chart. Steve points out that whenever BTC's weekly stochastic RSI bullish crosses, then BTC rallies. So this is interesting firstly because in the prior instances where BTC rallied for the final leg to the top after the bullish cross of the blue over the yellow MAs of Pi Cycle Bottom indicator, those were with the stoch-RSI rallying back up from a high level. Whereas currently said stoch-RSI is diving below 20 and could either quickly bullish cross back up or languish below.

Note the following facts on my chart (complex, high IQ analyses):

1. When said stock-RSI quickly bullish crosses back up, BTC has already bottomed when the blue line of said stoch-RSI has hit 20 (which it has currently) and the rally starts in the next week and runs for a total of ~3 weeks but not more than ~6 weeks.

2. BTC could still rally from a bullish stock-RSI cross below 20 as it did from above 70 as it did in the prior two aforementioned last leg of the top, e.g. the month of Feb 2016.

3. BTC has never failed to break at least slightly above the top of the weekly Gaussian channel after testing its median as it’s positioned now.

4. BTC rallies near the end of NDX outperforming SPX, whether it’s followed by a crash or just a bullish pullback. Also to reiterate from my prior comments on the prior variant of this chart, BTC never fails to make one more leg up after testing the yellow MA of the Pi Cycle Bottom indicator, after the said bullish cross of the blue over the yellow (Note: Steve employs red & green colors instead of blue & yellow respectively).

5. Uncertain whether BTC will remain above an uptrending yellow MA (Pi Cycle Bottom indicator) as in 2016 or crash down below it (cause said MA to rollover bearish) as it did in 2019 and again 2020 (median of weekly Gaussian channel is still angled down as of now). In either case, #1 - #4 seem to imply that BTC will rally at least to slightly above the top of said Gaussian channel first.

6. Rallying into expected Fed pause and resolution of debt ceiling but actual refilling of Treasury account by July will drain liquidity and pull markets back down. But note markets rally into the end of the year (2015 & 2019) before a POTUS election year (2016 & 2020) and there has been a crash in Q1/Q2 of election year prior two instances. Thus a flash crash coming in H1 2024 (false-flag nuke attack in Ukraine)? Expect rally out of Q3 due to Fed yield curve control— de facto QE as Zoltan Poszar expects.

snapshot
Note
Looks like the DXY (dollar) is temporary topping and may pullback to ~102.7 - 103.5, which would allow BTC to make one more move to the ~29.8k (or maybe overshooting it slightly with my median band target from ETH:BTC weekly Gaussian corresponding to ~30.7k if ETH to ~2171) top of its weekly Gaussian channel. Doesn’t look like BTC:USD will fill that 35.3k CME gap in June before declining back down to its weekly Gaussian mean band ~24.5k. BTC could possibly drop to the bottom of its weekly Gaussian band below 22k by then but I favor the median holding as support.

ETH:BTC is bullish and ETH:USD has horizontal level targets will match its ~$ 2171 weekly Gaussian top, although could overshoot it into the band at most ~$ 2500 but probably not that high. Both look to decline back down to the bottoms of their declining weekly Gaussian channel median band ~$ 24.5k and $ 1600ish.

Coming (rising) out of expected/posited Q2/Q3 decline, expecting ETH to outperform again with a harmonic pattern top projection ~3200 (as it also did from Q3 2019 to Q1 2020 which appears to be a repeating pattern of pre-election year and election year). BTC should then fill that CME gap and perhaps overshoot it into the ~38 - 44k range (with top of ETH:BTC weekly Gaussian band corresponding to ~41k for BTC if ETH ~3200).

Ditto then SPY will fulfill its ~4800+ Shark harmonic target from the October 2022 bottom. Subsequently perhaps the posited repeating flash crash pattern in H1 2024, probably the breakout of kinetic war directly between NATO and Russia (because the unelected mafia NEOCONs running the West are getting more and more totalitarian desperate after their C19 false-flag blew up in their faces and Russia did not collapse as they had hoped)— not just through the current puppet Ukrainian proxies.
Note
Meet Kevin pointed out that with the U.S. debt ceiling deal reached, and market already pricing in a 25 basis points hike at the Fed meeting on June 14, the market has no more negative news and is likely to rally. If the Fed surprises with a pause in June, the market may skyrocket.

So I will not conclude that Bitcoin will not fill that ~35.3k CME gap. Maybe yes, maybe no. Eric Krown Crypto's latest pointed out that historically BTC pulls back ~40% after the initial rally. Unlikely to pull back 40% from 31K, so maybe the gap fill is incoming.
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/NVDA/ijWLo9M3-At-least-a-15-drop-coming-maybe-more/#tc10189745

JerryManders, I agree the summer peak is likely this week or next. I disagree with your crash predictions. I agree with the possible 29K top and the first level of 23- 25k pullback on your recently published BTC update. I do not agree with a lower-low for the markets in 2023-- that will be in H1 2024 after first another rally back up into Q4/Q1 when the Fed reinflates and/or Treasury slows their issuance of sovereign debt. The incoming decline will be due to the liquidity drained as the Treasury reloads their account but I do not think this will be sufficient to instigate your crash to lower-low scenarios. I will be significantly in cash after this week and next, thus I do hope Bitcoin declines to 11k but that is not happening until maybe some WW3-induced flash crash in 2024. Thanks for the concern for my financial well being.

I have the summer blow off top on the QQQ between 350 - 361 possibly as high as 369. My long-term projection is 390+ for the harmonic pattern Oct 22 bottom. Pullback into Q3 then back up to 390+ by Q1.

snapshot
Note
Fed has been increasing liquidity again. Not yet the time to go bearish. Probably very close though to the top.

youtu.be/1tg4M0FELis?t=595
(Stock Market Volatility Is Set To EXPLODE Again Soon, BIG TIME! | FX Evolution)
Note
If Bitcoin does not close the month of May above 29k then the top is probably already in and no move to 35.3k this summer.

youtu.be/WPB-jtETP-Q
(BITCOIN: THIS IS HOW IT ENDS!!!!!!! (btc holders ALERT!!!!!!🚨) | Crypto Anup)
Note
Bitcoin is likely headed up for a new summer high, thus per Crypto Anup expecting a further rally tomorrow to close the month above 29k.

youtu.be/40U3XZcYKtU
(Bitcoin Daily RSI Signalling Potential Upside??? | Kevin Svenson Crypto)
Note
I had sold my leveraged position earlier on Tuesday on the move to 1915 ETH, now I just reloaded 1865. Bitcoin looks like it is about flip the EMA ribbons as it did in 2019 before the final leg up. I think there may a huge bullish move tomorrow with the vote on the debt ceiling.

youtu.be/WVwmxIbkFQA
(🚨 BITCOIN ALERT!!!! HISTORY IS ABOUT TO BE MADE!!!! THIS HAS NEVER HAPPENED!!!!! {COLOSSAL SIGNAL} 🚨| Crypto Zombie)
Note
Do or die today for Bitcoin.

youtu.be/WbumdiR8fpY
(Can Bitcoin prevail through the Debt Ceiling Dump!? | Eric Krown Crypto)

If Bitcoin does not close the month over 29K today, then the top is in. I believe it will skyrocket today on the debt ceiling vote. The debt ceiling agreement is a farce that allows unlimited spending for next 2 years, projected to be ~$4+ trillion. Bitcoin reacts positively to money printing.
Note
Strictly speaking there have been a couple outliers where the BTC price closed the month below the CPR indicator and still rocketed higher over next several days. So this is still plausible, albeit the risk that we do not get a blowoff top is increasing.

Overnight Fed just leaked that they will pause in June. Let's see if the markets rebound on repricing of Fed futures for June 14 rate hike to reflect a high probability of a pause. But also note in the latest reading the Fed liquidity ticked down again, although that might have been priced in by the pullback.
Note
This says everything I would want to write.

youtu.be/KaFghFAPPRk
(BITCOIN: THE WORST HAS HAPPENED!!!!!!? {get ready!!!!🚨} | Crypto Anup)
Note
S&P is pumping because the inflation expectations have dropped to 2.09% and ADP jobs report although hot, is really just the NE catching up on hiring from the C19 lockdowns, while the South is shedding jobs. Wage inflation continues to drop in the ADP report.

This all appears consistent with a Fed pause on June 14, which was telegraphed by the Fed's favorite leaker last night.

Thus folks there could be yet another leg up or at least one more rebound to lower highs.

youtu.be/7fge92a6hl4
(shocking... THIS now the LOWEST in 28 months! | Meet Kevin)
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10200556

> "After BTC closed in May above $26,010, everything is still set for new peaks in this several-month trend. My max target level for June is $39,414."

goodblackcat, looks like a diamond reversal pattern to me. Diamond patterns can also be continuations though which would test between the $ 25.4 - 26.3k 200 WMA level again.

snapshot
Note
youtu.be/sgvTfiX5mks
(Breaking: FED's U-turn Jolts Tech Stocks📈 | Felix & Friends (Goat Academy))
Note
youtu.be/SMorfH17fTA?t=328 ← click for chart
(Bitcoin Wyckoff: Was I Wrong To Buy? CAUTION, Crypto Is Telling a VERY Different Story… | Jason Pizzino)

16:00 if Phase E included the pump from the banking crisis then the price action since then would be distribution, not accumulation. So you better be correct about Phase E starting now, else Bitcoin is going to decline ~40% from ~31k. I happen to agree with you bullishly that Phase is imminent.
Note
youtu.be/KEd0SNSiKJI
(Bitcoin About To Have LARGEST MOVE OF YEAR | Crypto Crew University)
Note
Ron Walker points out that the weekly MACD is about to bearish cross if BTC does not rally. This is concerning because Sep 2015 was the only time where the MACD was in this situation, the monthly was also in red (as is now) and this did not result in a significant decline (“dramatic plunge”) in price.

youtu.be/DCH8juqSMYc?t=948
(Bitcoin Gets a Fake Rally on Debt Ceiling Deal that Reversed off the 50 Day MA - Big BTC Drop Coming | The Crypto Trader)
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10204583

> "shelby3, Yes, I agree. After this current stage of cross market reactions after the NFP, we will break out above the almost 5-day downtrend line on hourly data. This could be immediate at any time now."

goodblackcat, zooming out, Bitcoin appears to be in a Wycoff distribution after the Phase E of the Wycoff accumulation coming off the bottom. This along with the bearish H&S pattern on the 2-day chart is projecting down to ~24.5 - 24.8k. As well, ETH appears to be repeating a bearish repeating pattern since March that previously occurred from June 22 to Nov 22, which projects ETH back down to ~1700. That posited pullback corresponds to ~0.0685 ETHBTC which is what my chart shows it should pullback to after hitting the first, bullish ~0.07085 target. Given I think BTC may top out today or tomorrow ~27.5k thus ETH would top ~1950 - 1985. I hope I am wrong but it’s bearish that crypto is not making new highs while the stonks are. We have bearish divergences all over the place. I think stonks will need to pullback before they can rally with more breadth possibly after the Fed pause on June 14. Additionally BTC almost has a bearish Gartley pattern projecting down to 21k, although it is just slightly malformed but only by a few hundred dollars.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=nmtjsBgQiZU&lc=Ugz-3cEEh6nWDKkpnLF4AaABAg
(It's Over: The US Economy WILL BREAK in June! Bitcoin's biggest moment has arrived | EllioTrades)

If you weren't so clueless you would realize that the Fed will not start yield curve control (YCC) until the incoming massive Treasury issuance drives up interest rates so much that banks holding long-term Treasuries and/or the real estate (especially commercial) and other sectors of the economy plummet, because YCC as it was also for the recent BTFP is a pogrom for centralizing the banking and financial system as they prepare to enslave us with CBDCs. Thus first likely a pullback and correction in the markets and crypto.

twitter.com/xBitcoinerx/status/1638210186027433985 ← click for ChatGPT summary.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=pOw-BREisg4&lc=UgxxM6pC9NFzbF9XjaJ4AaABAg
(**US DEBT CEILING CRISIS OVER!!!!!** BITCOIN & S&P 500 SET TO EXPLODE!!!!? | Crypto Anup)

8:01 it is not a bullish descending wedge. Rather it is both a bearish head & shoulder and also a descending parallel channel, both are indicating a decline to 24.5 - 24.8k. Treasury will issue $1 trillion in June! This will crash the markets.
Note
youtu.be/M_KnC4oIqmU?t=331
(Brace For The $1 Trillion Aftershock From Debt Deal | Mark Moss)
Note
Found others with the same thesis as myself.

cointelegraph.com/news/bitcoin-wicks-down-to-26-5k-but-trader-eyes-chance-for-bullish-surprise
(Bitcoin wicks down to 26.5K, but trader eyes chance for ‘bullish surprise’)

Analyzing the current setup, popular trader Crypto Ed considered the potential for upside topping out at $27,500.

“I do think we go down, but as long as we do not break that $26,000, there is a chance for a bullish surprise,” he said in a YouTube update on the day.

To break the current impasse, Crypto Ed continued, Bitcoin would nonetheless need to tackle the area above $27,600.

“Now I think we bounce back toward $27,500 — resistance of the previous range high — and from there I will be looking for, possibly, shorts toward $25,000,” he confirmed.


twitter.com/CryptoTony__/status/1664530537128640513

I remain short while we are below $27,500 legends. No change in my play here, as only ETH is taking the stage right now.
Note
Two excellent videos. Covering everything I have written yesterday and explaining this could go either direction. There is a slightly perhaps bullish bias in these videos.

youtu.be/_hI7jLXf4ks?t=155
(Ethereum vs. Bitcoin short and longterm analysis | Eric Krown Crypto)

youtu.be/N8afroYDYYI
(❌ BITCOIN: IS THIS WHAT WE THINK IT IS????❌ {this could be HUGE!!!!} | Crypto Anup)
Note
I think it is time to give Ron Walker attention again. Strangely do you think maybe the pLandemic was by design so the Treasury could refill their TGA account at low interest rates? 🧐

youtu.be/GmaYZr9UI3g
(Default Crisis Over! Now the Treasury will Suck Liquidity Out of the Stock Market Causing a CRASH | Ron Walker)
Note
Strangely I think Bitcoin is preparing for a bullish breakout even though the Treasury will issue 123B in bonds on Monday. I wonder if the Fed is (somewhat surreptitiously?) feeding some liquidity into the system to prep for Treasury issuance? Not only are the following (and also yesterday’s prior videos from these two vloggers) leaning somewhat bullish, I also see bullish RSI divergences forming. Also some bullish volume surges on Ethereum.

youtu.be/i_mHCEO2TO0
(BITCOIN: GIGA ALERT IT'S NOW OR NEVER!!!!!! | Crypto Anup)

youtu.be/W2S6xCtoLKM
(Bitcoin Macro Sunday - Do we see a crash at the end of June? | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
Sector rotation usually means the final blow-off top is incoming. Smart money has been rotating this past week out of defensive into risk-on sector funds!

youtu.be/Ah7jSKCxrbc?t=337
(Smart Money Is Rotating Money Into These Stocks, Plus We Haven't Seen This Since 2006! | Mike Jones Investing)

Blow-off top underway with risk-on sector rotation. Buy rumor of Fed pause, sell the news as 1T of Treasury issuance incoming in June. Interesting that maybe some Chinese stimulus might be the boost to blowoff top in U.S. markets?
Note
Ah the Treasury issuance this week will be 44-day, 13-week and 26-week bonds. This will not uninvert the yield curve. No long-term debt issuance. Interesting.

13:50 Ah there is the Fed liquidity I was expecting! Ok up we go with crypto! Yeah.

youtu.be/LUQckuyuxFc?t=312 ← click for the chart
(Nobody Is Talking About This... | FX Evolution)
Note
[ Album ]
I’m nearly certain now that crypto is going down. I will sell after the slightly higher high than the May high this week. First week of November is repeating. Ethereum is clearly in Livermore’s speculation pattern. My previously mentioned downside price targets will be hit.

youtu.be/xSxiB4k-WDw ← click for chart
(🚨ETHEREUM: MY NEXT ALL IN COIN!!!!!!!! {don't be left out!!!!}| Crypto Anup)

snapshot
Note
Well done.

youtu.be/_urZ8Z1O_vM
(Public, political resistance to CBDCs won't matter, government will sneak them in - Moss & Breedlove)

Many correct points made in this video, but there’s also several mistakes. Bitcoin did not fork into BCH/BSV and BTC, rather into the former two, plus a yet to be resolved soft-fork of legacy and non-legacy BTC, which has ginormous implications which the two interviewees aren’t aware of. Bitcoin and derivative crypto are a Trojan horse that forces CBDCs because stable coins compete with national fiats. Given that the surviving legacy BTC will only support 1 MiB blocks with ~7 transactions per second, there is no way that BTC will be the unit-of-account for the masses. BTC will be used by and the unit-of-account for the elite and central banks, whilst the rest of us will be enslaved with CBDCs. This is known historically as a two-tiered global monetary system, e.g. trade silver dollars and internal silver dollars. The economic implications model of Bitcoin is based on the late, famed mathematical genius John Nash’s Ideal Money proposal published on Jstor. Nash described how the Ideal Money would enslave the nation-states, who then enslave their citizens. Bitcoin is a diabolical weapon that eventually ends up entirely centralized with 50+% of the hash rate to be controlled by its creators (the Rockefellers, Vanderbilts, etc). John Nash was assassinated on the same EZ Pass that he had mentioned in the abstract of said paper.
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10235112

goodblackcat, you wrote “It seems that Shelby is taking a break from the markets”.

Indeed I will stop any form of short-term trading, because I want to focus on programming work. I will from now only comment on the major inflection points spanning months.

> “When BTC's value doubles and subsequently, after a span of at least 55 days following the doubling (or after a rise of at least 90%), the price fails to surpass its initial level at the time of doubling, the likelihood of further upward movement over the subsequent months diminishes significantly. Consequently, this creates an impetus for the bears to exhibit more audacious behavior.
The consequence of this situation is a substantial decline in BTC's price or an extended period of fluctuation characterized by sideways movements lasting several months.“


Indeed. There is still that Livermore speculation pattern on ETHUSD which portends another leg down below $1700. Not significantly lower unless that morphs into a Bump and Run reversal.

snapshot

As Crypto Anup also pointed out that Bitcoin appears to be in a Bump and Run reversal, which portends a drop to 20k or below. Depending on how long it takes to drop down to the secondary support line on my chart below, I have it ~$19.5 - 21.5k. If that lowest support line to break because that would portend egregiously lower lows of a much larger (but ill-formed because the angle/slope is too low) Bump and Run spanning years. Appears instead we simply have the 2019 - 2020 repeating as I have been predicting since summer of 2021. Treasury and Fed are draining liquidity from the markets for until Q4. The June 14 Fed pause is already priced in.

snapshot

Eric Krown Crypto also has a statistical setup in play on his latest video portending the imminent and looming drop to the $22 - 24k region before probably a late summer bounce.
Note
ETH could drop to the 1450 - 1600 range. I still have that harmonic pattern bottom projecting to 3200 to probably be fulfilled by Q4/Q1. Thus I expect a bounce for Bitcoin also later in the year when the Fed is forced to start releasing more liquidity. But that ominous crash is looming in 2024. Again it will be some “black swan” false-flag to launch WW3 involving NATO and Russia directly. Note it is not a “black swan” because we know it is looming as we understand from Martin Armstrong what the uniparty Neocons want.

snapshot
Note
Okay here is the confirmation we need that Bitcoin has not yet bottomed. Crypto Anup has been nailing it.

Thus we surely have another crash coming for Bitcoin, but I don’t think it will be in 2023. Looks like Bitcoin is likely to bounce from the ~23.6k level initially. Ron Walker (The Crypto Trader) also concurs for an initial bounce from that level. Then the Q3 bottom likely to be just slightly above or below 20k. Then a rally into Q4/Q1, then the flash crash in 2024. This is what I have been publicly predicting since at least October 2021 and privately I identified my posited repeating megaphone pattern in May 2021.

youtube.com/watch?v=L5ydYWS-rFU
(BITCOIN: BOTTOM NOT IN YET!!!!!!!??? {OMG!!!! 😱} | Crypto Anup)

ATR_Normalized & WPR
Note
Mathematician agrees Bitcoin will be going sub-$ 13k eventually.

https://www.tradingview.com/chart/NVDA/ijWLo9M3-At-least-a-15-drop-coming-maybe-more/#tc10235455

shelby3, honestly appreciate your comments. Not trying to sound confrontational in my replies I just know for near certain market is about to bleed this coming week. It was your warning of flash crashes after all that prompted me to look into historic cases and map out the structural break necessary for one... and now we are here. SPY and BTC both meet my criteria to crash here, obviously a lot more that goes into it than what I show on my charts.

shelby3, also agree that the bigger crash is yet to come, probably 2024. This crash will be more short lived, probably a week or 2 of straight selling.

June 16th and June 21st are very important dates if you are familiar with Gann... watch out for that 5-planet conjunction nearing the solstice.

shelby3, theres no chance BTC will hodl 25k with that kind of move down. Sure, if it was a controlled move over the course of a few trading days it would have bounced.

Watch out below when this breaks, SEC drama only getting started.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/ZjLGyWsgbTA
(Coinbase CEO on Crypto's Regulatory Challenges: An In-Depth Conversation | WSJ)

The law is the law. Coinbase will ultimately lose. The argument that Ethereum is decentralized is dubious. The downgrade to proof-of-stake was entirely designed and coordinated by the devs under their supreme leader and public-facing spokesman Vitalik Buterin. Also the power-law distribution of stake is an invariant that is never not the case. Thus even though we may not know the names behind the curtain, there are small number of individuals who control every proof-of-stake blockchain. Thus it certainly appears to be an obfuscated enterprise, which I think what the courts will ultimately conclude. Thus everything not Bitcoin will end up as a security, unless there can be any other surviving proof-of-work altcoins and/or someone can invent an alternative to the current status quo of proof-of-work and proof-of-stake. Yes I am implying that every proof-of-stake blockchain based cryptocurrency is probably a security under the Howey test.
Note
USDT dominance breakouts correspond to Bitcoin crashes. USDT has a small breakout underway. The major USDT breakout is not going to be this summer. Probably come back down and test support again later in 2023 first which will offer a rally from looming summer or Q3 lows.

youtu.be/U5uWNdOAAkU?t=130
(Bitcoin Macro Sunday - Dominance Analysis | E.K.C.)

Eric the macro low for Bitcoin will be a worse flash crash in 2024 than the 2020 rona dump. It will bring Bitcoin below $ 13k. But Bitcoin will rally into Q4 or Q1 first. Bitcoin will form a low incoming this summer or Q3 probably ~$ 21k or so. The down sloping weekly Gaussian channel median band will decline to said target level by then. Bitcoin may still rally to $35+k but not until Q4 or Q1 after the summer and Q3 low, and before the flash crash I expect in 2024 after the final rally. Really 2019 and 2020 are repeating in 2023 and 2024 which is what I was predicting publicly since Oct 2021 when I first identified a posited, repeating megaphone pattern.

To confirm the macro low is not in, c.f. the ATR normalized and WPR indicator.
Note
youtu.be/PkO_PPw3A9Y
(Bitcoin & SP500 Can’t Hide It Anymore: This Major Signal is 3 Weeks Away | Jason Pizzino)

Yes WW3 starts in 2024. We know what the uniparty Neocons are up to in Ukraine and what their false-flag plans are to launch the war and also to help them to distract the public when they rig the 2024 POTUS election. To confirm the macro low for Bitcoin is not in, c.f. the ATR normalized and WPR. I agree that a looming scary June pullback is likely going to get a nice bounce into July and then grind lower into Q3 but then the rally will resume and Bitcoin will likely finally hit those 35+k levels. But there will be a nasty crash in 2024, much worse than 2020 for Bitcoin taking it to lower lows sub 13k. Bitcoin is much weaker than it was in 2019 as it bottomed below the 200 WMA. Thus the black swan crash will take it to lower lows. This can also be seen in the multiple (fractal smaller inside of larger) Bump and Run reversal pattern that is forming on Bitcoin. Pay attention or you may end up with egg on your face, which you do not want for your channel and investment service. I have been publicly predicting since Oct 2021 that 2019 and 2020 was repeating in 2023 and 2024.

You really should read Martin Armstrong. We know for a fact that WW3 will be escalated with a false-flag in 2024. You are correct there will be a bull market into 2025 or 2026, but what you are missing is that 2020 flash crash will repeat and it will be worse.
Note
youtu.be/NpZW3v2yUZQ?t=376
(Explaining the Crypto Crash In Full Detail. Is The Bitcoin Bull Market Over? {Are Altcoins Dead?} | Jason Pizzino)

6:16 excellent. Yes total altcoin market cap is heading into the Spring capitulation on the Wycoff accumulation schematic. This portends a huge rally into Q4/Q1. But this will be the eye of the hurricane as there will be massive crash in 2024 when WW3 is launched between NATO and Russia. That Wycoff rally will end up being wave B on an A-B-C elliot wave correction that brings crypto to new lows in 2024. Mark my word. Bitcoin is much weaker than it was in 2019 as it bottomed below the 200 WMA. Thus the black swan crash will take it to lower lows. This can also be seen in the multiple (fractal smaller inside of larger) Bump and Run reversal pattern that is forming on Bitcoin.
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10250759

I am not seeing a significant further crash here. Possibly as low as $1550 because there are multiple ways to draw the support. I think what you are missing is a rotation into breadth incoming. Look at Intel.

ETHBTC had hit my target then declined back to retest the breakout. Looks like it has bottomed for now. And will have +15% leverage over BTC on the way back up. The pullback in crypto may be nearing a bottom for a July rally, possibly even higher highs.

snapshot
Note
Hawkish Fed looking out to Sept but who cares as leading indicators of inflation are dropping rapidly. But Treasury account has not affected liquidity as RRepos declined. I would be careful calling for anything more than a pullback here. Congress is pushing back intensely against SEC. SEC’s court cases have floundered and they have been reprimanded thus far.

Different ways to draw support, but looks like crypto has bottomed or nearly so. This is forming a bullish Cup&Handle on Bitcoin and there are bullish RSI divergences on up to a weekly timeframe.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=zJ42sbF4HNs&lc=UgynYknNeVqGi2ajZRV4AaABAg
(Support broken - What happens next for Bitcoin? | Eric Krown Crypto)

Crypto is near a bottom. Hidden (aka phantom) bullish RSI divergence on nearly all time frames, including the 5D. You did not even point out that ~29% to the upside from volatility expansion would be a new high for 2023. You were bullish at the top and now turning bearish at the bottom. I told you many weeks ago when Bitcoin was first hitting $ 29k, that it would come back to test the median of the weekly Gaussian band and that median was declining. We knew it would retest strong horizontal support $ 24.3 - 25.4k, which it has now more or less completed. Look at ETHBTC which has bottom at the retest, headed up to 0.075 - 0.077 with two bullish patterns also with bullish RSI divergence.
Note
youtu.be/BwEy4rqRgP0
(Start of Bitcoin Apocalypse now only Days Away! Next Long entry | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

I had a long at the same $24.3 - 24.5k level as you. But I see a rally to a new 2023 high. I think the price will ride up your red ring, not down. Look at the ETHBTC, it back tested and is ready to rally again. The Fed will be paused until at least Sept. Leading indicators of inflation are dropping. The expected liquidity drain from the Treasury reloading their account, but Reverse Repos declined so Fed balance sheet liquidity increased. Thus I expect stock markets to shift to breadth and meet my harmonic targets from the Oct lows of ~4800 S&P and ~3200 for ETH. Bitcoin appears about to get a massive pump to $35 - 42k.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=taOu5OsxkNQ&lc=UgwmC9KbD6lrObxak-V4AaABAg
(History Tells Us Altcoins Are About To COLLAPSE!)

Look at CRYPTOCAP:BTC/(TOTAL2-CRYPTOCAP:USDT-CRYPTOCAP:USDC) instead of BTC.D. Notice that it has not broken out yet. Thus altcoins might rally one more time. Look at the ETH:BTC chart, appears to be in declining wedge that might break out to the upside to as much as 0.085 short-term, also bullish hidden RSI divergence on the weekly. I have had a long-standing harmonic pattern on ETH:USD since the October bottom projecting to 3200. Also note altcoins total market cap broke up out of the declining wedge from the bottom in the crypto market at end of 2018. The bottom of this market was October 2022.

Excluding the stablecoins is important because dominance can otherwise simply mean cash flowing into the cryptos in general.

snapshot
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=DGyBFM3_7fg&lc=UgzAql_cIWzAdsip-8p4AaABAg
(Beginning of the Bitcoin Bullmarket? | Eric Krown Crypto)

Basically putting your last few videos together and the fact that you ignored the bullish hidden RSI divergence on the ETHBTC weekly chart, coupled with my long-standing harmonic projection for ETH off the October bottom to 3200, I have ETH going to 3200 and BTC to 37 - 42k roughly.
Note
youtu.be/Gr-LGTE8XKo
(The Bitcoin Short of a Lifetime! This was an epic bull trap! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

I told you it would ride up the ring. It is going much higher before crossing your ring.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=Gr-LGTE8XKo&lc=UgxxmJGv7JRIRBIe2mN4AaABAg
(The Bitcoin Short of a Lifetime! This was an epic bull trap! | OPTICALARTdotCOM)

I told you it would ride up the ring. It is going much higher before crossing your ring. The Dow can come back up again for a double top on your Fib line as it did previously. All of you shorting at 31k is what will propel it higher with short covering.
Note
Crypto Anup is predicting 35 - 37k top for Bitcoin over the next month or so. Could pull back first to ~28k. Many will now pile on short now since hit 31k, so short covering will help propel this up.

youtu.be/Yz0ANZqAbZg?t=189
(❌ BITCOIN: IT'S URGENT!!!!!! ❌ {this changes everything for btc!!!!!})

3:15 Look at Bitcoin Dominance without the stable coins instead of BTC D. Notice that it has not broken out yet. Also the BTC D might back test former resistance as support before moving higher. Thus altcoins might rally one more time. Look at the ETHBTC chart, appears to be in declining wedge that might break out to the upside to as high as 0.085 short-term, also bullish hidden RSI divergence on the weekly. I have had a long-standing harmonic pattern on ETHUSD since the October bottom projecting to 3200. Also note altcoins total market cap broke up out of the declining wedge from the bottom in the crypto market at end of 2018. The bottom of this market was October 2022. Excluding the stablecoins is important because dominance can otherwise simply mean cash flowing into the cryptos in general.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=Qp7XSc93u30&lc=Ugyc2tlvQTLghskLv254AaABAg
(Why the Stock Market *just* FREAKED ... core inflation skyrocketed back up in the UK | Meet Kevin)

Core inflation will remain sticky because the governments actually increased spending since the pLandemic (note the accurate capital L which you still have not caught yourself up to speed on which impairs your fiduciary duty). Do I need to invest in House Hack and then send you a shareholder letter reprimanding you for refusing to do your fiduciary duty because you prefer to remain in some blind snowflake delusion about reality? The uniparty Neocons created the war with Russia intentionally and are pushing it to nuclear war intentionally. They pushed Putin into the lap of China intentionally. You really need to take off those rose colored blinders and wake up to the fact that inflation will not decline as much as you think and will come roaring back with a vengeance after 2024. You must factor this into your House Hack strategy.

Note I am not expecting core inflation to spike in the U.S. this year. And the shorting to hedge will help propel the markets up to the harmonic targets I have had since the October bottom. Nothing changes in my thesis. I am just saying that I do not expect interest rates to remain lower going past 2024/5.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=cyUSFET0hMM&lc=Ugz_Jy311d6rUxFNE2l4AaABAg
(The Disconnect Between Stocks and Bonds Grows Wider | Mott Capital Management)

Stocks are wrong and the TIPs interest rate is correct. Stocks have been pushed up by a combination of front running the Fed pause and short covering. The market was overly bearish all the way up, which provided the short covering fuel. And now with the Fed signaling a skip and UK core inflation skyrocketing unexpectedly, the shorts will pile on which will fuel the final leg up to the Gartley and Shark harmonic pattern targets I have had on all the markets (S&P, Nasdaq, Ethereum) since the October 2022 bottom. The markets will need to correct significantly after the harmonic targets are hit. An unexpected Fed pause at the live July meeting could be the catalyst for the final push up.
Note
youtu.be/mwloMwftLtg
(These TINY Meta Crypto Coins Will 50x By 2024 (Guide To Metaverse Investing) | Alex Becker's Channel)
Note
VERY IMPORTANT.

youtu.be/mwloMwftLtg
(These TINY Meta Crypto Coins Will 50x By 2024 (Guide To Metaverse Investing) | Alex Becker's Channel)

16:43 yes we need a new layer 1. I am working on it.
Note
Anyone not convinced Bitcoin is going to 35+k before a nasty correction, watch this. Months ago I was saying Bitcoin would backtest the median of the weekly Gaussian band and that it would eventually decline to back fill the 25k horizontal support level before breaking out above the weekly Gaussian channel and now the statistics apply as explained...

youtu.be/CaLW7S5wd90
(Last Time this happened Bitcoin + 26,32% | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10281757

> "16:43 yes we need a new layer 1. I am working on it."
>
> Do you mean "THESE" things I know about from you when I was on Telegram?
>
> Are things coming at the speed of light now, thanks to the help of AI tools, or have you increased the number of programmers/coders?
I remember you wrote that it can't be straightforward to delegate it to others to do, has AI changed anything in this?
>
> A friend of mine just cut the number of programmers/coders in his team, thanks to the fact that he can use the others much more efficiently.
>
> BTW, I'm betting on a very hot end to June, somewhere between an absolute minimum of $32,000 and a maximum of $40,000.


goodblackcat, June may cap off with a move to 33 - 36k or not, with the remainder of the final topping of this bear market rally to end before the 3rd week of July, including stonks.

As for any altcoin development, I prefer to not talk too much. Thanks. I will just say A.I. is an unsupervised and sketchy approach to coding, and should probably not be used for any mission critical software. An extremely talented programmer probably spends more time writing the spec for and then checking the coding of the A.I. than if they just wrote it themselves.

ADD: for coding up something someone is not familiar with, A.I. could teach one the skeleton of what one wants to code up, which could be helpful and accelerate learning.
Note
Looks like in near-term there is possibly a bump & run reversal and Bitcoin may need to retest its 200 WMA below 27k one more time.

youtu.be/ZbjUXmhGWQ0?t=436
Note
I'm more skeptical of the large pullback scenario. Might only be a slight pullback before next leg up.

There is a bullish engulfing candle on the monthly if June closes above ~29.8k.
Note
Well put...

youtu.be/i89ZSKMIdpo
(Bitcoin REJECTS the Kiss of Death and RECONFIRMS This Signal | Alessio Ranstani)
Note
Another excellent observation...

youtu.be/2I8AX_fIL5o
(🚨 BITCOIN: A TRAP IS BEING SET!! | Crypto Anup)
Note
This is spot on.

youtu.be/HdHTvIyj-vE
(WARNING: EVERYONE IS WRONG About Bitcoin Right Now – This Will Happen Instead | Crypto Crew U,)
Note
Another excellent video:

youtu.be/YFIkxZXUJUA
(Warning: Bitcoin Historic Data Confirms NO PULLBACK | Bitcoin WON'T Be This Price in 6 Months | Jason Pizzino)
Note
Important:

youtu.be/c97bf3jaHpY
(ITCOIN IS ABOUT TO HAVE THE LARGEST MOVE OF 2023 – Do This Now | Crypto Crew U.)
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10351425

goodblackcat, coiling up for a big move. And I think it is to the upside. I am locked and loaded. I will be selling BTC 32.8k and ETH 2178.
Note
BTFD:

youtu.be/TSJO4vmaOI8
(Inflation is NOT about to EXPLODE | Meet Kevin)

Market overreacted today.

China stimulus, UK Bitcoin ETH coming. Any news can send crypto skyrocketing again. We have bullish RSI divergence on the daily chart if Bitcoin remains above 29.7k.
Note
Let’s not forget that I’ve had a Shark harmonic pattern bottom on the SPX since October 2022 that projects to a minimum of 4660 and a maximum of 4940. Ditto for the Nasdaq minimum projection 15950 and maximum 17290.

Everyone ignored the harmonic pattern I used to predict Natural Gas at the top would decline to ~$2. Scroll back through my Trading view updates.
Note
youtu.be/o7z7pYQG-lw?t=59 ← click for the chart
(BITCOIN: 99% WILL GET THIS WRONG!!!!!! {you've been warned!!!!} | Crypto Anup)
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=LJs65Mpi48Q&lc=UgzqGdc8TUDkFJid1Qp4AaABAg.9sDVhG55wGN9sFcHlcS5nW
(Comments on "BITCOIN: IT'S A FALSE FLAG! | Crypto Anup)

@pwll1 I want to amend my comments because bullish RSI divergence would form again on all time frames daily and below with a drop to ~28k. So there could be a Bart Simpson move before the next leg up. Again the weekly RSI bullish divergence is still possibly in play as it was first weeks of April 2019.
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10436294

JerryManders, no crash. 2016 to 2017 is repeating. Weekly Gaussian channel will turn green again soon. Top will be summer 2025. In the next month or two, likely to get back up to $ 31k again. To challenge $ 35+k by end of year. Probably crash back down to ~$ 30k again in Q1. Then off to the races until mid-2025.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=Og8t7g7d9q0&lc=Ugw5k6V00kHM0fINAct4AaABAg
(10 YEAR CHART COULD COLLAPSE BITCOIN | Crypto Crew U.)

As told you in email more than year or two ago Steve, that when the imposter Bitcoin is destroyed as the miners donate to themselves all the non-legacy protocol BTC with an address that does not begin with a 1, then Bitcoin as everyone knows it will die. This is why the volatility will go so low, because the impostor Bitcoin will actually die, not just for 10 years. But the real Bitcoin (aka legacy protocol) will continue up towards 500k or million, although this could possibly require 10 years of sideways consolidation. We will see.
Note
My comment:

youtu.be/T2w_C_RGGT8
(Bitcoin will be spanked?)

Bear trap low 28000s with a wick low to 27.5k incoming.
Note
[ Album ]
XRP will breakout within the next 6 - 7 months or less.

youtu.be/VsAeAhrITG8
(XRP: A Realistic Prediction For this Market Cycle | Crypto Crew U.)

I confirmed this along with bullish divergence on XRPBTC. XRP below $0.60 (maybe as low as possibly $0.51) is a buy. Expecting at least $2 but more likely above $2.50 with (but less likely) the highest $4. This is also confirming that Bitcoin is going to rally above 35k within the next 6 - 7 months or less. Presumably XRP will entirely win their case against the SEC.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Ditto ETHBTC still projecting to 0.08. With the harmonic pattern (which I correctly predicted the drop of NatGas and the rise of S&P and Nasdaq since I published the finding in October) projecting to 3200ish, that means Bitcoin is headed to ~40k— both presumably by or before approximately the end of the year.

snapshot
Note
Either the 2015 or 2019 scenarios indicate there’s a breakout to ~$ 35+k coming Q4. The current pullback shouldn’t push much below ~$ 28k— maybe a wick to $ 27.6k.

2019 formed bearish divergence on the weekly on that Q4 rally (also volume didn’t breakout) in contrast to 2015— thus 2020 involved a severe crash whereas 2016 only wicked back down to support.

All 3 cases had (hidden/phantom or regular) bearish RSI divergence before the Q3 pullback-; however, it’s not yet confirmed currently (with a price collapse bar) thus possibly to Q4 breakout and void the divergence or form double divergence. IOW, currently could be in an accumulation phase in Q3— there was a small Wycoff distribution at June/July top. Note a horrific WXY pattern is still plausible but that crash would come later in late Q4 or Q1.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
S&P500 hasn’t even hit the first Shark harmonic pattern (ig.com/en/trading-strategies/top-7-harmonic-patterns-every-trader-should-know-210608 target I PUBLICLY identified back in October. And the highest target is ~4950. Nasdaq hit the first target I PUBLICLY identified back in October, yet the highest target is above 17k. After this Q3 pullback, the markets will continue up into Q4 to these levels and Bitcoin will break out to 35+k.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
This entirely supports the thesis that no crash until 2025.

youtu.be/HdY23-ZDwIQ
(Click bait title: DANGER: The Trillion Dollar Credit COLLAPSE | Meet Kevin)
Note
I may have unlocked a secret code.

The MACD crosses on the monthly demarcate start/end of bull runs, but the actual turn is when the DXY peaks/bottoms. After a cross down the bull run has officially started, dollar has peaked until end of bull run, which explains why 2019 wasn’t a bull run but 2023 is! Ron Walker’s nonsense DXY will soon breakout to upside (even has bearish weekly RSI divergence).

Pointedly note the correlation indicated by the blue arrows and the measurements shown!

My calc is BTC may hit 45k in November, pullback significantly into the halving. Projected halving might be accelerated a bit if price accelerates.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Also a bullish monthly MACD cross on Bitcoin at corresponding juncture of said blue arrows. The peak in summer 2019 also had a bullish monthly MACD cross, but both the monthly and weekly RSI had bearish divergence, with the weekly overbought. That was/is not the case at said blue arrows (in addition to the previous point I made that monthly MACD on DXY had not crossed for a bull market in 2019).

[url=Also a bullish monthly MACD cross on Bitcoin at corresponding juncture of said blue arrows. The peak in summer 2019 also had a bullish monthly MACD cross, but both the monthly and weekly RSI had bearish divergence, with the weekly overbought. That was/is not the case at said blue arrows (in addition to the previous point I made that monthly MACD on DXY had not crossed for a bull market in 2019).

Link to chart below.

snapshot
Note
There even appears to be a bullish ascending triangle with breakout to the upside projections $ 39 - 43k. Additionally I do not see any bearish RSI divergence on weekly and daily. Ron Walker (aka Crypto Trader) is blind. The daily just reset bullish and the weekly never formed bearish, if you look the body of the red candle in April was as high as the green candle before it and it had a lower weekly RSI than the higher peak in June.

There even appears to be a bullish ascending triangle with breakout to the upside projections $ 39 - 43k. Additionally I do not see any bearish RSI divergence on weekly and daily. Ron Walker (aka Crypto Trader) is blind. The daily just reset bullish and the weekly never formed bearish, if you look the body of the red candle in April was as high as the green candle before it and it had a lower weekly RSI than the higher peak in June.

Link to chart below.

snapshot
Note
Found my old chart on ETH. Amazing ETH had been following my projected moves almost exactly. The BAT harmonic pattern projects $3200. Bullish RSI divergence on both daily and weekly.

snapshot
Note
Appears Fed will pause at Sept, Oct, Nov meetings which can lead to this final rally I am expecting. But then the “higher for longer” interest rates are likely to lead to a significant slow down (and recession scare FUD) in the economy and a significantly pullback. As the Fed starts cutting rates by summer 2024 markets will boom. Normally markets crash when Fed starts cutting entering a recession, but the U.S. will not be entering a recession.

youtu.be/YxkSV6VTu8c
(Another Clickbait Title: The Federal Reserve is Blind as F: The Coming Mega Crash | Meet Kevin)

c.f. 16:50 chart
Note
Excellent! Important!

Inverted yield curve isn’t predicting a recession bcz govt stimulus. As investors figure this out govts will be forced to totalitarianism in form of financial repression. Europe, UK, Japan first. U.S. will be last.

youtu.be/Avvv7c8xEok
(This Man Predicted EVERYTHING!! What Comes NEXT!? | Coin Bureau)

Government debt-to-GDP ratio (i.e. low in Australia) is not the only factor that can drive a country to financial repression. Very high consumer debt (e.g. Australia, nearly double of the U.S.) can lead to economic implosion at high interest rates, which can force the govt to take on massive debt and stagflation.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=nBZxmDjWHmA&lc=UgywNalAviDjOg2xYr94AaABAg
(My Comment on 'The Black Swan' author Nassim Taleb on looming crisis: The risk is in front of us | CNBC)

Taleb has tunnel vision. There are other factors, such as capital getting off the grid and fleeing the weaker economies in Europe which will enter financial repression sooner.
Note
Reminder this agrees with my Bat harmonic pattern projection to ~3200. First stop maybe just above ~2700. Also the 0.08 ETHBTC expectation implies BTC to $40+k.

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin's bullish hash ribbons Buy signal just fired. This most always precedes a large move no less than 39%.

youtu.be/8eR61hSFs3k
(Bitcoin Historical Signal Is Ready | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
I wrote (scroll back to confirm) there would be a swing low before rockets. Daily RSI has reset hidden (aka phantom) bullish divergence now on ETH. Remember I wrote XRP would crash back to $0.51 first.

snapshot
Note
Search back to my update on Aug 5, where I stated a drop below $ 28k to perhaps $ 27.5k incoming. I was watching CryptoZombie the prior day and he was making a point that dropping back down to prior horizontal support again would not be unreasonable. I did not bother to post that thought here, for me as long as Bitcoin does not close a daily below $ 25k, then my Q4 2023 bull case is still valid.

Ditto Bitcoin per my prior post's points.

snapshot
Note
I just took a glance a DXY and SPX charts. For me this is the buying opportunity I was keeping dry powder for.
Note
Lots of bearishness out there among the various YT analysts. Maybe so. Maybe there will be continuation down. But...

Exactly as predicted for the pullback, with a massive breakout to the upside ahead in the coming months. Look at that massive hidden (aka phantom) bullish RSI divergence on the weekly.

snapshot
Note
Even the monthly has hidden bullish RSI divergence and MACD has bullish crossed.

snapshot
Note
Ethereum surges 11% after report SEC is set to approve Futures ETF (possibly by October)

cointelegraph.com/news/sec-to-approve-ethererum-eth-futures-etf
Note
I am open to the possibility of further downside maybe even in $ 21k, possibly after a bounce. But I think it is also possible that this grinds sideways then up.

Earnings reports were good thus far in the U.S.. Thus this is all a reaction to the U.S. economy being stronger than expected and thus a selloff in 10Y because people suddenly realize there will not be a recession soon to bail them out with a flight to safety. This has caused the dollar to rise, thus all risk assets have sold off.

But this rise in the 10Y puts extreme pressure on U.S. banks, pension funds and insurers for example, which hold those. This caused mortgage rates to rise further from 6.5 to 7.5%. So this realization is doing the Fed's job without the Fed needing to do anything as a stronger dollar (which also reduces purchasing power of foreigners dumping capital into the U.S. real estate) combined with less demand for houses and vehicles.

Somewhere in that mix this realignment of expectations will stabilize and bull market will resume, because of rotation out of 10Y has to go somewhere. What investment do you buy? Short the 10Y yield (i.e. long the 10Y price) when you expect it to stay higher for longer? Better to buy what sold off that is likely to move back up sooner.

If these higher rates cause some more banks to fail or head aggressively to the Fed window, that is more liquidity injected thus Bitcoin will react again to the upside as it has done in every instance this year.

The yield curve has steepened almost losing inverted, which is historically the sign that the recession is imminent. But iirc, that is normally because the Fed has started to lower short-term rates due to rising unemployment, which is not the case now. Instead we have investors realizing they were wrong to expect a recession soon.

Thus I think I think risk-off fear is overblown, as again some are misinterpreting reality. Fed is not suddenly going to raise short-term rates. They will pause again in September.
Note
I do think Bitcoin will come down to the yellow trend line eventually, but more likely after Q4 when probably there will be some event such as escalation of war. Bitcoin has dropped out of its ascending triangle, but this was very near to the apex which is a busted pattern that often in that case leads to a u-turn back up through just after the apex which will be start of October. Look every time the RSI was this low on the weekly, Bitcoin rallied significantly. Could either back up to $ 31k or a break out above that, before the decline back to the yellow line in Q1. If the decline will be to the yellow line now, then so be it, but I doubt it.

snapshot
Note
ETH appears to have a similar bullish pattern as XRP, as price has merely retested the ascending support line. I am scooping up OTM long-dated call options cheap right now.

The RSI on all major crypto have reset bullish. Has everyone forgotten that the hash ribbons just got the blue dot buy signal on Bitcoin this past week. Those always result in significant rallies even if there's a pullback first.

snapshot
Note
EDIT: …because rotation out of 10Y has to go somewhere. What investment do you buy? Short the 10Y yield (i.e. long the 10Y price) when you expect it to stay higher for longer? Better to buy what sold off that is likely to move back up sooner unless want yield plus appreciation maybe later in 2024.
Note
Even if we draw Bitcoin's failed ascending triangle this way, my prior posts still apply. Likely coming back up through the apex by October for a break out to the upside. Because the markets will eventually price in that the Fed is not going to hike in November.

snapshot
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=ouyPip8pIPg&lc=UgwvLRGhF7wJ9Bope0R4AaABAg
(The Crypto Flash Crash | What Happens NEXT | Meet Kevin)

Kevin on the log-scaled chart draw a trend line on the weekly candles BTCUSD index (not an exchange) chart from the 2018/19 lows through the bottom of the candle body for the C19 lows which precisely predicted the October low. I do think Bitcoin will come back to test that trend line (currently ~ $21+k) eventually, but I doubt before Q1 2024 when interest rates cause some contagion perhaps in banking system. As you noted, Bitcoin just dropped out its ascending triangle but notably very near to the apex (on the log chart, else apex is Oct on non-log chart) which often results in the price shooting back up through or just after the apex, which is what you are ostensibly also expecting? I entirely agree for the reasons I provided in my other comment, that the Nov Fed hike will be priced out and back up the markets go to hit the Shark (and Bat) harmonic targets I have had since October such as 4650 to 4950 for SPX (and 3200 for Ethereum). Glance at that uber bullish ascending triangle for Ethereum. I am loading up on OTM long-dated Ethereum call options! Buy when there is fear and blood in the streets.
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=OSU582BmpBU&lc=UgxApmoCFHnp_0g98oN4AaABAg
(China’s ENTIRE Economy Is About To Collapse | Double Dip CRASH | Meet Kevin)

Asian mentality is top-down control and stability at the cost of freedom.

Eventually China will involve in war to deal with this political problem, but I presume they are not quite ready to do that yet (more like 2026ish). Thus I presume they'll try another round of stimulus to bide some time. Or maybe the leaders want to foment more pain and anger they can redirect such negative energy into an international war scapegoat? Also as you alluded peak season is approaching with the Chinese New Year. So maybe they can kick the can on their need for WWIII to scapegoat their egregious mismanagement of their economy which has put the country in a Minsky Moment debt deflation? Interesting that Chinese received a 12th of the stimulus Americans did and were locked down for 12 times longer, thus 144 times worse effect. Regarding Chinese being conservative and preferring to hold dollars than Bitcoin, can they actually hold physical dollars or just digits in untrusted banks and where can they exchange those dollars if not untrusted banks? Also any cash savings can rush into Bitcoin if FOMO, so maybe this is building a huge future FOMO stash? What is so ironic is that you criticize Marxist policies in China, but turn a mostly blind eye to the transformation to the same in the U.S. (ugh Ross Gerber a leftist puppet). Good to hear that you pointed out that supply chains are at risk because of essentially the Thucydides trap, maybe you read my prior comments. Also I think you are almost (or already) realizing that the world has realistically probably only one way out of this mess which is WWIII. When you realize that China needs WWIII as much as our uniparty Neocons do (to hold on to power in the face of widespread populism turning against them), then the C19 thing makes a lot more sense doesn't it.💡You still have to come to grips with Trump actually won the 2020 election and the Capitol riots were actually Feds (Tucker is now pointing this out).
Note
youtu.be/n04AnE4oOF4?t=663
(Bitcoin is Collapsing: Nobody Will See This Coming for Stocks & Crypto | Jason Pizzino)

11:00 I think your timing is wrong because the first low of 2015 corresponds to June 2022 not November. The double-dip in 2015 corresponds to said November 2022. Please consider how your timing analysis would improve if you took that stance? Typically acceleration ensues after the halving which which means in this cycle Q2 2024, which concurs with the timing I have suggested. Thus I conclude that staircase markup above 32k should be in Q4 if the 2016 pattern is in play. Even if comparing 2019, note the rally in Q4 before the capitulation in Q1 2020 around the halving.
Note
SPY tops are typically marked by Russell 2000 divergence, which isn’t currently the case. Thus definitely markets are headed higher and this is only a pullback. Question is how deep the pullback will be.

youtu.be/C1xWlQXUhgI?t=555 ← click for chart
(2 Risks Could Burst The Biggest Market Bubble Next Week)

Also if ~25k fails, then next target is ~21k. with my reason for hoping that won’t happen is the bullish ascending patterns on both ETH and XRP would presumably fail also:

youtu.be/Vxbao12xwQc
(BITCOIN: THIS IS HOW IT ENDS!!!!!! | Crypto Anup)
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10487313

> “shelby3, ETH to $666.79”

goodblackcat, put a time window on that prediction otherwise you could claim you were correct if it happens in towards 2024 when I already acknowledge the possibility of a liquidity crunch. Let’s not forget all the nonsense predictions you made in my Telegram before I kicked you out because you would not stop babbling and changing your mind every few hours.

https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10487329

> “something will break that triggers a quick crash towards $18,000-12,000, then there will be an economic or other perturbation that brings BTC down to $12,000-9000 or lower.”

> “So I believe the bulls will make a big mistake and fall into a deep well from which they will not come out, hoping that this collapse will stop at around $20,000-21,000, and then there will be a permanent return above $25,000 that will rectify the situation.”
>
> “This will not be the case, and many traders who entered the market in 2020-2021 will get their first painful real lesson after counting on BTC rebounding to $50,000. We are still in a strong bear market. Echo bubble rally ended in July.”


If this is true, then crypto is dead. You are betting against the repeating halving cycle of Bitcoin. You are betting against no divergence on the SPY thus indicating no bear market ensuing. You are betting against bullish harmonic patterns which have been playing out precisely. Remember I used it to predict the crash of NatGas and the initial targets of the SPX and NDX which were just fulfilled at the peak— thus the possibility those are complete although they have range target that can range up to ~4950 and ~17k.

Where is your liquidity crisis, bear market originating from? The markets crashed because the Fed was draining liquidity from the system as inflation was running rampant. Inflation has been coming down and the Fed has probably reached a pause although the market is nervous right now about inflation possibly trending back up, but that is probably not the case with China suffering, high interest rates affecting housing, autos, consumer credit, etc..

I will grant you one observation which is that crypto like most growth stocks are suffering compared to top tier corporations which can issue bonds at lower rates than 10Y Treasuries. Those companies also have cash flow, issues dividends, etc.. Also we see on the recent crypto selloff that exchanges were quite illiquid as BTC wicked below 24k on some exchanges such as Bybit.

So I am open to a temporary liquidity scare now, BTC possibly down to 21k. I just not aware any fundamental basis for the return to a bear market? Is there some banking contagion, but if so wouldn’t that just cause the Fed to flood with more liquidity?

The 5/3 ratio theory of Bitcoin tops indicates that Bitcoin can only rise ~400% from its bottom for this cycle. Thus if BTC drops to 10k, the top in 2025 can be at most 50k.

https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10487530

> “goodblackcat, so true…You'll be buying the top of a B wave. SPX is headed to upper 2000s by early 2024.”

JerryManders, and if you are wrong again as you have been so many times. I have been observing you are correct about 50% of the time. Respond to this: https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10487575

Also refute the monthly bearish cross on the DXY: https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10461484

DXY is not likely to suddenly have a bullish monthly cross. What are you smoking? Yeah making a temporary liquidity crunch but not a lower low.

I am not saying you can not be correct, but provide some actual analysis. Do not just pull 50% probabilities out of your arse with some closed source claim to applied math, and then cherry pick when you gloat.

Come on this is a stern matter that affects many people deeply. Offer up some cogent scenario for why?
Note
JerryManders and goodblackcat, I have found a supporting argument for your thesis, which is the DXY is on the verge of a bullish cross on the 2W chart. This is similar to H22016, when Bitcoin dropped -40% which would ~19k.

But if true unlike near end of 2016 when DXY formed bearish RSI divergence on the weekly chart, if the DXY rises above 106 then there is no plausible weekly bearish divergence (as was the case for the Oct top) until much higher levels. The 10Y has massive bearish RSI divergence on weekly and will continue to have it if it pushes higher. Since I do not expect the 10Y to go ballistic to say 5.5% to nullify the bearish divergence, then what would drive the DXY above 106? Thus it seems the maximum selloff is in the 19 - 21k range for Bitcoin. Lower-lows are not in the cards for the risk-on markets. How do you guys respond to these facts?

If investors are selling the 10Y because higher for longer without an imminent recession (higher interest rates driving up the DXY), then what are they holding? Cash?

snapshot
Note
[ Album ]
JerryManders and goodblackcat, you guys are too bearish expecting some W-X-Y crash into Armageddon.

If as I don’t expect the DXY pushes above 106, I will reevaluate with more severely bearish stance at that juncture.

Note there’s a BTC CME gap 27 - 27.5k so expect that to possibly fill before resuming crash to the downside.

Actually the repeating patterns on XRP are warning of potential whiplash drop to ~0.30 preceding a gut wrenching, bullish rocket launch. The 4 hour repeating pattern indicates XRP will imminently launch into the ~0.54 - 56 range before it resumes the crash.

snapshot

Ditto maximum downside for ETH ~1100 - 1350 (perhaps only 1450) before bullish whiplash to 2700+.

snapshot
Note
Ahh, here is where the cash is going. Now I understand what will happen I very much doubt risk-on markets will make lower lows, but am now shifting my stance that they will crash more.

youtu.be/0NUXH7GYnvc
(This is REALLY BAD for Stocks & Housing | The True Great Reset | Meet Kevin)

The ongoing selling since July 19 of long-dated Treasuries and stocks to plow the money short-term into highly liquid, risk-free (no market risk) money markets which are paying nearly the same as a 6-month Tbill and 100 basis more than 10Y, has numerous effects including some you mentioned such as driving the 10Y up, which drives DXY (dollar) up, drives stocks down (liquidity crunch in crypto), causes more unrealized losses for the banks holding them, as well issues you did not mention such as that draining of bank deposits (and thus bank reserves) continues. IOW, this is accelerating the next banking contagion wherein Fed will inject liquidity again which can goose crypto. That cash can jump right back into stocks when they become oversold, because remember stocks rally typically when the Fed pauses, whereas by the time Fed starts cutting aggressively there's contagion and stocks are dropping (in the video you are incorrect on that point). And I concur with your point that as long-dated Treasuries rise (and peak) it will be tempting to jump back taking a higher yield than money markets by then along with the speculation of market risk being bullish (which can occur with a Fed pause does not need to wait for cut as you claim). In short, we are in a risk-off exhale, but the risk-on fervor will return and I bet not too many months from now because as you said the markets price in the future and because of the dynamic that for example 10Y looks like it already has bearish RSI divergence on the weekly (unless it tops maybe 5.25%). Note if the DXY breaks above 106 I will become much, much more bearish for longer, because there will be no possible bearish RSI divergence on the weekly until the DXY goes back up to astronomical levels.👀
Note
> “The 4 hour repeating pattern indicates XRP will imminently launch into the ~0.54 - 56 range before it resumes the crash.”

Fulfilled exactly as predicted 5 hours earlier. Cashed out my XRP.
Note
More explanation of what is causing this risk-on markets pullback.

youtu.be/ONFFLNTPRdk
(A Massive Dollar Breakout Could Lead To Serious Stock Market Pain | Mott Capital Management, LLC)
Note
> “Maybe I've been on too many rollercoaster rides with bitcoin over the years to get all that spooked when it does what it's doing now. Saying that, I'm not complacent either. Prepared for the unexpected.”

The wick low on BTC was all over the map on the different exchanges, such as $ 23.6k on Bybit. Also the wick low looks ridiculous compared to other bought up flash declines in 2023. Liquidity looks horrible and crypto looks very weak right now. I have strong inkling this is crashing to $ 21k or even $ 19k.

$ 91 billion was poured into money market funds in 4 weeks and it is accelerating. This move to liquidity is leaving a “look out below” gape on risk-on assets. The market is content to book profits since October 2022 and wait it out in high yielding money markets until there is more clarity on rates, inflation and GDP. Also to wait for more attractive prices on a stock market that was highly overbought on irrational AI fervor.

The pinprick was the 10% GDP growth figure that blew out all hope and expectation for 10Y Treasuries coming down in a recessionary flight-to-safety move anytime soon. This selloff of the 10Y prompted smart money to dump stocks and rush into money markets.

The dumb money (e.g. you and I) are behind the curve on figuring this out and if we do not sell this bounce, we are doubly dumb.

I hope I have suitably corrected your apathy.
Note
My comment:

17000s by October 2023


https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/MjYilwfb-17000s-by-October-2023/#tc10489933

As you already know I currently do not think this is a W-X-Y bear market continuation pattern, rather just the 2 wave of a 5 wave bull trend. My expectation is maximum ~19k downside. Discussion: https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10487826

I want to thank you and goodblackcat for motivating me to understand why this crashing and relinquish my dumb money stance.
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10489954

> “shelby3, fair enough.. but I believe firmly that economic and news related factors are merely an explanation for market price action and nothing more. If you're looking for cause and effect you have to look at market cycles dictated by time (astrological, based on planetary relations with respect to the beginning of a significant move) and price equilibrium.”
>
> “I don't use any data mining, rather a mix of geometry, linear algebra, and Ito Calculus based on the chart and price action alone. If my analysis aligns with Gann, Elliot, or Wyckoff then I give more credence to the predictions.”
>
> “I am more convinced in the SPX (and therefore majority of equities) crash than I am of BTC/crypto. But I have enough evidence in both sets of charts to conclude things are about to get bloody.”


JerryManders, who was first the hen or the egg? Indeed humanity seems to follow some frequencies (Armstrong has developed a model based on Pi), but that doesn’t obviate (the utility of looking for) just-in-time causality (if it can help supplement nuanced understanding of and confidence about the situation).

I highly doubt the SPY or NDX will make lower-lows. Perhaps 4200 SPX. Being a potential example wherein understanding the causality may help, because all that highly liquid billions sitting in money markets will find the pullback enticing. Capital markets are becoming more cautious. They took profits and high yield for a breather only, probably not a bear market. Why would we have a bear market? Earnings are up, economy is strong, inflation is moderating, govt is spending 2T a year...okay high interest rates, but real rates are still negative if counting the actual inflation. Note higher interest rates are very tough on investments have have no income and can not sell corporate bonds at low interest rates, ergo crypto and venture capital.

Guys pull your crypto investments. Step aside and wait for liquidity to return on the next bank contagion.
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10489876

> “shelby3, My method isn't static, i'm evolving it with time and failures are a catalyst. I can say my current method is something you don't want to bet against. All my posts have hit or are on path to hitting september/october targets since I refined it. Only been trading 3 years and already hit the big moves with precision more than most I've seen. Just giving my input though, I shared my the SPX and BTC posts for what I'm seeing.”
>
> “I think you are underestimating the current bearish environment because you are looking for something that makes sense economically or conventional factors. Astrology moves markets - planetary longitudes dictate price highs and lows, not the news or other common factors that are mainstream. Call me crazy, but all I have to say is watch and learn. As I said the crash starts this week, it will be bloody into September.”


JerryManders, per my updates, I found the economic explanation. The 10% GDP figure pin-pricked the expectation of a recession and flight-to-safety appreciation of long-dated bonds. The subsequent selloff in the 10Y set everything in motion (including DXY) and smart money was copacetic to take profits on risk-on. But now that is spiraling into a liquidity crunch which is ostensibly what your data mining is ferreting out. The telling sign for me, which forced me to study was the horrible liquidity on this BTC flash dump. Different exchanges were all over the map in terms of the spike wick low, so as low as 23.6k. This signals to me liquidity is very low and this could turn into a blood bath soon. But until that DXY gets over 106, I am not assuming this is an A-B-C (aka W-X-Y) bear market continuation portending lower-lows (highly unlikely!), because if so then crypto is dead and the halving cycle is busted for the first time in Bitcoin’s history. Note your 17k is possible on a spike wick low. But any closing at new lows means crypto is busted and I am out.

https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10488754

> “shelby3, Interesting points on DXY, I'll be honest I haven't followed it as closely. For BTC, I do see the potential for 37k as max bullish, and if it does bounce at 19-21k then it could reverse. However, I'm seeing a drop to at least 17-18k, then bounce to 27k - a rejection at 27k would open the door to lower low in 2024”

JerryManders, again I hope your bearish continuation is not the case, as it would mean crypto is dead, right at the time we need it as the govts enslave us with CBDCs. If Bitcoin declines to say 9k in Q1, then maximum upside into 2025 will be only 45k per Steve Courtney's repeating 5/3 ratio model. I will keep my eye on the DXY and 10Y. If either 1.06 or 5% are breached (i.e. plausible weekly chart, bearish RSI divergence nullified/vacated), I will liquidate any longs I accumulate on your said first projection.
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/MjYilwfb-17000s-by-October-2023/#tc10489965

> “shelby3, lol, its the end of a B-wave. Top for BTC was July 13th, top for SPX was July 27th. You know Elliot Wave so I'm just surprised you would even consider buying into a C-wave.”

JerryManders, you are the arguing for a C-wave not me. I can’t parse your comment. Coming off the Nov 2022 bottom, Bitcoin has a completed 5 wave pattern, which I think fulfills wave 1 of a bullish 5 wave pattern which was also the case in 2019 for the corresponding juncture in the mining difficulty halving cycle which controls Bitcoin. What is your point?

Note how in 2019 Bitcoin declined, then bounced before the ~4-year period halving and then spike wick low around the halving (C19 FUD) which was wave 2, followed by wave 3 into 2021, then wave 4 and 5 with the top in Nov 2021. Why are you so gung-ho for a corrective EW interpretation when that seems to violate Bitcoin’s halving cycle? However, Bitcoin is obviously weaker than it was in 2019, so a lower-low seems plausible if Bitcoin is stuck below its 200 SMA and even the long-term regression line as shown by Crypto Zombie, and it will mean crypto is very weak.

I am willing to entertain the thesis that crypto is very weak, given the horrific macroeconomic monetary reset, Thucydides trap and enslavement plan underway and accelerating into the dystopian end game. Got your iris scanned by WorldCoin yet for the upcoming central bank digital currency system?

Capital is becoming very conservative, preferring well connected corporations that can sell bonds at very low interest rates, e.g. Apple. Or now high yielding, highly liquid, no market risk money market funds. The banking system is being intentionally collapsed to centralize control over everything. The Canadian trucker debanking will look like a walk in park soon.
Note
XRP is more much bullish than BTC (and even ETH) both in terms of the percentage rise off the bottom and bottoming back in March 2022 (even already back up to top of the B deadcat rally in 2022 which BTC and ETH are not even close to, but BTC hit in 2019), ETH in June and BTC not until November. Reason is ostensibly bcz going to win its SEC case, and it underperformed both BTC and ETH the prior halving bull cycle.

XRP’s repeating fractal pattern aligned with the bullish cross of the green 21 SMA over the 50 SMA, indicates XRP will likely bottom above ~0.30 and be back up to ~0.85 by January. It is not clear what happens after that. 2024 could be a chaotic year.

snapshot

This along with ETH having a similarly more bullish stance than BTC (also 3200 Bat harmonic projection target still in play), indicates to me that extremely unlikely that risk-on markets are making lower-lows in 2023. THE ETH chart has an A-B-C correction pattern projection (c.f. the small purple lines on my chart) to exactly ~1500 where I already had the likely September bottom support annotated.

snapshot
Note
Every August of a pre-election year has been red. Every instance bottomed by October or sooner and printed a new ATH after that.

Again I do not agree with the thesis of JerryManders and goodblackcat calling for new ATLs on this pullback. I could be proved wrong, 2023 could be an outlier because of all the wacky stuff going on with the brainfart coup d'etat in the USSA, but the statistics are in my corner.

youtu.be/JpuiY2klAb4
(Will Bitcoin Make New Highs With The Stock Market In 2024? {price statistics})
Note
Essentially Krown is discovering that POTUS election years are rarely if ever down years.

It is unlikely that the markets will shit the toilet leading into an election year.

We simply have a rotation which is causing a liquidity crunch for risk-on markets.
Note
After incoming bounce Bitcoin could potentially retest 17k, although it could bottom slightly above that such as 19 - 20k. If there is a blackswan event like C19, I suppose it could wick lower than 17k but I doubt that.

youtu.be/-YzCu6NnA0E
(BITCOIN TORNADO WARNING | Crypto Crew U.)
Note
Worst case scenario is DXY eventually breaks above 106 and markets (or at least Bitcoin) makes lower lows in Q1 after rallying from ~19 - 21k into Q4? This seems to disagree with the pattern I am seeing on XRP though, unless somehow the rally on Bitcoin would be much less than for XRP. My expectation is only come down to the annotated median line. A bullish flag would not normally last that long in duration to downside as posited.

youtu.be/1kEyx_EP4NM?t=103 ← click for chart
⚠️ BITCOIN: LAST DESPERATE WARNING!!!!!! ⚠️ {prepare yourself now!!!!} | Crypto Anup)
Note
Crypto got excited too soon. Bull market will resume in 2024.

youtu.be/ToCK5NohntM
(2024 will be very bullish for crypto — Here’s why)
Note
Is Ethereum ready to rockets?

snapshot

youtu.be/hPRdIQrH6eo
(Bitcoin's History Repeating With Ethereum? | Eric Krown Crypto)

Last dip opportunity to accumulate Bitcoin cheap incoming.

youtu.be/qQuF83B2WIw?t=724 ← click for chart
(BITCOIN: FINAL WARNING!!!!!!! DON’T BE FOOLED!!!!!! IT’S ABOUT TO GET INTENSE!!!! | Crypto Zombie)
Note
Ron Walker aka The Crypto Trader was calling for a crash all the way up to 31k from the 15.4k bottom. Take him seriously now as he continues to call for a megacrash? Broken clocks are correct twice daily. Does he make any valid points?

Foulmouthed, condescending Ron “balderdash” Walker claims DOGE is in a bearish flag pattern, soon to crash to 0.005 (not 0.05).

youtu.be/Maa_Kq9u6b0
(Will the Dogecoin Millionaire Ever Become A Millionaire? Not Anytime Soon the Doge Selloff Isnt Over)

Is Ron blind? That is clearly a breakout following by a descending, bullish channel with multiple drives of hidden bullish RSI divergence on the weekly. DOGE could wick down to 0.05 in September. I just not see a crash in the cards, which thus when combined with the bullish ETH and XRP charts, leads me to be believe the maximum downside on BTC is an intra-week wick low that fills the 20.3k CME gap but closes the week above 21k at least.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10503796

> > > shelby3, Another Downward Revision: BLS Confirms US Payrolls At Least 306,000 Lower Than Previously Reported
> >
> > {my comment} goodblackcat, this will send the markets skyrocketing as the Fed will finally be forced to say they are truly paused.
>
> “shelby3, in simple reasoning, only if there was no stubborn inflation, my analysis shows that bonds yields will continue to rise, although yesterday was a temporary triumph of optimists. This pause won't stop stagflation, I don't see it that way.”

goodblackcat, and when tightening credit conditions break something forcing the Fed to print money again? Don't forget we have commercial real estate crisis brewing in the U.S., with banks deep in the red on NPLs in the sector. If I wanted to enslave the highly indebted population at this juncture, I would create a C19 that forces the Fed to turn on the money printers like there is no tomorrow while breaking globalization and supply chains, to kickstart forever price inflation, then trap the Fed in a situation where inflation is stubborn but they break things trying to contain it. So the Fed is forced to pour fuel on the fire, then come back and raise interest rates even higher. Wash, rinse, repeat.

Does appear the markets are moving into some corrective and perhaps sideways phase for a while. But there is also signs that the raging bull market will resume again in Q4 or Q1. But I am wary of a bull trap like in early 2020.

You are assuming that we can have a normal recession but the global economy can not handle a recession. The UK tried that and within a week they had to change the Prime Minister and reverse course.

Money is getting off grid into assets. Anyone buying bonds is lonely\loony and will be slaughtered. That is why money has been pouring into money markets instead for yield while waiting for the markets to correct then BTFD.
Note
Kevin furthers my rebuttal to @goodblackcat. Short periods of pain are priced quickly by the stock market and then it looks out up to 18 months at the future.

youtu.be/8dz8uwHNwf8?t=161
(Warning: The Coming Economic Stagnation CRASH | Meet Kevin)
Note
K-Dub @ Crypto Zombie makes some strong points that Bitcoin is not likely to drop below 20k.

youtu.be/_Xm0dkZYvNU?t=698
Note
Watch the following YT channel like a hawk for determining the bottom. Or maybe one of you have the time to subscribe to make sure you are privy to his indicators and calls in real-time as he sometimes disappears for days or weeks from YT.

youtu.be/t97QaDeQYWc
(WARNING: Crash Begins EXACTLY as we Warned for Days | Money Time Machine)
Note
Bitcoin in comparison to the post-DotCom Nasdaq fractal indicates bullish. This might be the bottom of the maximum downside ~21.8k. Could be 8 weeks of sideways and up before breakup to the top of recent highs again.

youtu.be/4bObRf6I7aQ?t=554 ← click for chart
(Bitcoin If History Repeats... Investors Beware | Eric Krown Crypto)
Note
[ Album ]
I redid the Fib retracement on both the NDAQ and BTC from the 2004 and 2020 lows to the top (respectively) and I get that both bottomed ~0.5 and both pulled back to ~0.382 (thus removing the discordance that Eric Krown had because he measured from the top to the recent bottom which is the wrong way to measure a retracement, duh), which is currently 23 - 26k. Also the second dip ifor NDAQ to 0.382 was shallower than the first. Markets do not repeat exactly but they can rhyme. If this fractal correlation has an relevance it seems to indicate that BTC will not go fill that 20.3k CME gap. Remember there’s also a CME gap ~9.6k. Not all CME gaps must be filled.

snapshot

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Our favorite bear Ron Walker who was calling for new lows, thinks BTC will bounce. He has been correct every time he called for a rebound all the way up from the 15.4k low.

youtu.be/XsgJy3iUxVc
(Bitcoin News: A Bitcoin Rebound is Highly Probable - Massive BTC Rally Likely Over The Next 2 Weeks | The Crypto Trader)
Note
Again I think we will get a bounce but will sell off again into October perhaps. Maybe BTC will bottom ~23k at the major uptrend line support.

youtu.be/QNrv-rq8qYg
(This Government Just Enacted QE To Save Its Market)
Note
youtube.com/watch?v=oQ6TqB1hsDo&lc=UgwgFMtn1TN1Mwx6AK94AaABAg
(SPY QQQ Update)

Hidden bullish divergence on that 15 minute S&P chart. Also backfilled the gap today on that chart. Market appears to be waiting for the significant news tomorrow. Note China just unleashed some stimulus for their stock market. Volume is supposed to decline in a bull flag (on the 1 hour chart).
Note
THIS COULD BE A REASON FOR A SELLOFF INTO OCTOBER.

Okay they are really going to attempt this C19 lockdowns and vaccines crap again. Do they really think we are servile enough to accept it the second time around? Or will this be a pretext for controlling access to grocery stores, government services, international travel, etc?

Maybe it is about time to leave Australia unless you plan on riding out there with no work if they mandate the vax again?

armstrongeconomics.com/world-news/banking-crisis/covid-ii-the-next-fake-plague-to-control-civil-unrest/
Note
MUST WATCH. My comment:

youtu.be/9PKTAfbkCF8?t=332 ← click for chart
(BITCOIN HURRICANE WARNING)

Brandon announced that vax mandates and lockdowns are coming back by Octoberish or so. This along with the Fed holding interest rates higher for longer could be what will cause the base retest. I agree there will be bull trap fakeouts along the way. But I also want to draw your attention to something else...Bitcoin in comparison to the post-DotCom Nasdaq fractal indicates bullish. This might be the bottom of the maximum downside ~21.8k. Could be 8 weeks of sideways and up before breakup to the top of recent highs again.
Note
youtu.be/0WBb0vCVIzM?t=125
(Desperate Warning | Crypto Anup Alts)

2:05 that is not a bearish, descending triangle on ETH. Redraw it correctly it is a near-term bullish to possibly 1800 descending parallel channel, possibly bearish 1400 - 1500 in October. The wicks below the horizontal base of your posited triangle invalid it. 3:10 you can reposition your red lowest support uptrend line more steeply sloped so that it properly touches the rising candle closes of Q4 2022, then you can clearly see that the expected bottom is not lower than 1400. Agreed on XRP it may bounce to 57+ cents but it will becoming back down to test 30 cents perhaps in October before it begins a massive bull run.

snapshot
Note
Stock market bottomed signal has fired off.

I’m looking for other signals whether I should reenter bullish after selling out my swing position on that thrust peak this week.

Note Thursdays (tomorrow) are usually down days for Bitcoin.

youtu.be/Mvrp5OTqfR0?t=758 ← click for chart
(Hidden Bullish Divergence Fuels Monster Rally as Warned 48 HRs Ago)
Note
Is Bitcoin about to dump to ~8k around the time of the halving event and Armstrong’s ECM major turn date as did in 2020? Would also correspond to the projected timing for summer 2024 low in CPI as recent CPI has been perfectly mirroring the 1960s & 1970s. So many confluences!

armstrongeconomics.com/armstrongeconomics101/ecm-armstrongeconomics101/imf-new-currency-on-ecm-april-10th/
(click above for chart)

Confidence Declining
(armstrongeconomics.com/world-news/govt-incompetence/confidence-declining/)

“economy is preparing to turn down with the ECM by May 2024”

youtu.be/ENqCiZPykEY?t=61 ← click for chart
(4 Bitcoin Trendlines Warn BTC Has Topped & Could CRASH To As Low As 8K | Crypto Trader)

youtu.be/dYQ7-mNqB88?t=263 ← click for chart
(Something Strange Is Happening In This Market...)

youtu.be/ukEPRQ5fnQc?t=161 ← click for chart
(Bitcoin About To TRICK EVERYONE)

S&P also repeating 2018 - 2020 fractal?

snapshot

snapshot
Note
[ Album ]
Not only ETH and XRP that are flashing potentially, looming bullish breakout patterns. Downside breakouts are also plausible, even a fakeout then back through the apex, but I’m leaning towards markets might figure out Fed has paused thus bullish until a crash in 2024.

youtu.be/n4Q-5oCwJo8?t=36 ← click for charts
(BITCOIN: NOBODY IS READY!!!!!! | Crypto Anup)

snapshot

My comment:

Bitcoin may fail at ~37 - 40k then crash back to 8k again in summer 2024. Another black swan event is coming which will repeat the C19 flash crash. Do not sell your Lambo to buy Bitcoin!!! IOW, those unfilled CME gaps 9.6k and 20.3k might be filled later in 2024.

Note Steve Courtney’s 5:3 ratio pattern that has predicted every Bitcoin bull market top, dictates/indicates that the next top will be 400% higher than the bottom. So if BTC drops to 8k then the 2025 top will be only 40k. If 15.4k was the bottom then 2025 bull market top could be ~76k.
Note
[ Album ]
Okay it is very clear to me now what is going to happen. I found this old chart I made weeks or months ago which more or less predicted what has transpired since. And I updated it to diagram what I expect going forward.

I must agree with Ron Walker now (watch the entire linked video below), except I think Bitcoin will rally off his blue uptrend line ~22k back up to ~36k to fill that 35.3k CME gap before it comes down to 8k to fill both the 9.6k and 20.3k CME gaps.

Imagine buying Bitcoin for 9k in Q2 2024. Get ready. I wonder if Steve Courtney’s 5:3 ratio model for predicting bull market tops, will be based on the 15.4k low even if Bitcoin makes a intra-week (or intra-month) spike low of ~9k in 2024? If yes, then BTC can rise to ~76 - 85k, else it can only rise to ~40 - 45k.

youtu.be/ENqCiZPykEY
(Bitcoin CRASH To 8K Coming - 4 Bitcoin Trendlines Warn BTC Has Topped & Could CRASH To As Low As 8K | The Crypto Trader)

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Bitcoin is close to resetting bullish again. I will probably reload my bullish swing positions ~26.3k or so. Maybe today or over the weekend.

Looks like there will be another leg up in September, before perhaps finally coming back down to a lower low to complete the pullback towards ~22 - 23k in October.

Note it is very difficult to get these wiggles correct every time.
Note
youtu.be/YnKhNk7WYKo
(PSA: The Economy is F*cked | Danger | Meet Kevin)

The max pain scenario is coming summer 2024. I can clearly see it in the charts and some other factors I incorporate. What will break? The banking system?
Note
Careful with that eagerness to be bullish. Bitcoin is much weaker than it was in 2019 before the C19 crash.

youtu.be/4vwN-yCDKNo
(Bitcoin Is ABOUT TO DO SOMETHING For FIRST TIME SINCE 2015)
Note
Likely QQQ H&S backtest before moving higher. Be patient on reentering crypto positions.

Short-term, I still think we are in bullish wave B of an A-B-C wave correction, so BTC to come down to lower-low pullback (~17 - 23k) after perhaps one more thrust up on this wave B.

My medium-term stance is BTC in a bearish wave B of a larger bullish A-B-C move to ~37k. The five Elliot Wave count for wave A completed with the top in July.

My long-term range thesis is BTC in a bullish wave X of a larger W-X-Y bearish wave to ~37k before crashing to ~8k by summer 2024.

youtu.be/6I4WVECAGQw?t=168 ← click for chart
(SPY QQQ Update | Henry James)
Note
My comment:

youtube.com/watch?v=9zif-8d4fZU&lc=UgwrLZbc-8I2qjch1_14AaABAg
(The Coming Great Depression & Dollar Collapse by Tucker Carlson | Meet Kevin)

The Triffin dilemma can be summarized that the current regime of globalization with the dollar as the reserve currency, requires the U.S. to continually increase its balance of payments deficits to allow for sufficient dollar reserves for the credit expansion of the world. These dollar reserves are primary stashed in U.S. Treasuries. But the global Minsky Moment is here this decade because the global credit bubble ran out of sustainability after reaching the zero-bound with ZIRP. Now as for example BRICS don’t want to be hodling Treasuries to finance their looming WWIII enemy when clearly the monetary order must shift given (and/or causing) the Thucydides trap is (to be) upon us this decade. Thus dollars are returning home in a death spiral of appreciating dollar and cash-based demand for all dollar-homed tangible assets such as trophy real estate. The destructive, scorched earth break in the dollar regime will be sudden and discontinuous (after ~2028) akin to the C19 crash. But the problem is that not even the BRICS will trust each others’ currencies nor will they have sufficient Schelling point to adopt a gold-backed alternative to the dollar as the global reserve currency. So as the world is torn to shreds over the latter half of this decade with all the corrupt nation-state’s (and their lackey) institutions discredited (including the IMF), there can only be Bitcoin that will step into the void as the next global reserve currency, albeit Bitcoin may nearly die first dropping to perhaps 8k in 2023 and maybe close to $0 (for the imposter soft fork) in next bear market. But a fixed (actually declining due to lost private keys) token supply reserve system will be high deflationary. Thus we’re faced with a scorched earth outcome during what will be exacerbated by a horrific solar-driven Maunder Minimum global cooling period from 2030 to 2050. During global cooling wars proliferate because some regions become deficient in food production. This is a repeating cycle of human civilization. The current crop of elite who control the nation-state institutions are losing control of the broken system, thus the looming CBDCs totalitarianism, Ukraine proxy war, stolen elections, looming Trump assassination, etc.. Kevin your 20 to 30 year timeline for dedollarization is delusional. The phase transition, waterfall collapse death spiral is accelerating and will attain escape velocity by ~2028ish or so.
Note
Based on these patterns, I think BTC will flash crash only to ~14k in 2024. Will only be down there for a very short period and quickly back above 21k again. Looks like the 2025 top will ~71k.

snapshot
Note
ETHBTC has been coiling up since Q4 2022. There also appear to be Wycoff Accumulation patterns on many altcoins. One more spring low then rockets? Note the potential, hidden, bullish RSI divergence on the weekly chart!

snapshot
Note
Bullish flag projecting 4800+ which is within the bullish target of the Shark harmonic pattern range I had identified since the October 2022 bottom between ~4650 to ~4930. First target was hit, now flagging preparing for bullish breakout.

snapshot
Note
Something very bad is coming in 2024. First Bitcoin to 37k, then something horrible transpires and we revisit 9k to go fill that CME gap.

snapshot

Double-top incoming on SPX?

snapshot

snapshot
Note
youtu.be/BrrjN-T2AjQ
(Ethereum Is The Signal For Bitcoin's Next Move)

My comment: ETHBTC to 0.08. Clear as can be. Why you do not see it? ETHUSD to 3200, BTC to ~37 - 40k. Then all hell breaks loose in 2024 and ETHUSD falls back down through the other side of your bullish ascending triangle. BTC to 9k.
Note
If my expectation plays out then selling this final wave 5 of wave B will be very wise, as Bitcoin could plummet to 13K in Q1 2024 before the halving.

snapshot
Note
Notice no bearish RSI divergence yet. Another push up may create it, and a drop below 15k would reset bullish RSI divergence again. Note red line on TDIGM (Trader’s Dynamic Index) curves back up in 2019 and now on the final rally before the flash crash. Red also needs to touch the orange curve before the flash crash.

Bitcoin is much weaker than it was in 2016 and 2019 as the RSI is loitering around the 50% level which demarcates the bullish/bearish zones.

Remember the 413% top from the bottom is nearly certain from Steve Courtney’s 5:3 ratio which has repeated for every bull market.

snapshot
Note
https://www.tradingview.com/chart/BTCUSD/llpVyKwv-2023-Year-From-Hell/#tc10666960

goodblackcat, did you not view his historical record which is summarized in that video? He has been correct on every major Bitcoin inflection focal point. Such small/closed/not-invented-by-me minded thinking does not allow for chaos theory where the order in chaos seems entirely irrational, because it is highly multivariate akin to the spooky action at a distance of quantum mechanics. I wanted to know your opinion on his current prediction, not your opinion on the veracity of his methodology of employing Fibonacci circles. I am curious how your prediction model compares to his for the coming months. He is bullish until a certain ring is crossed. Because frankly I do not understand the table of numbers you posted. Looks like gibberish to me.

youtu.be/COnnD6ZbEfg
(SPY QQQ Update)

Fed likely to pause Nov. 1 per the reliable Nickileaks. QQQ likely to pullback before that meeting then blast through overhead resistance. Note Bitcoin has been leading the markets.
Note
youtu.be/kB6vm6-tGV0
(Bitcoin The 2020 Fractal No One Is Looking At...)

Why do you use a chart which does not show that BTC declined to 3900 in 2020 almost down to the cycle lows? Are you trying to deceive the viewer? Bitcoin is in wave B of an A-B-C correction from the 2022 top and thus 15k is not the low! The 2020 flash crash in an election year scenario is ongoing because the coup d'etat is ongoing. If you are blind to what is actually happening in the geopolitical sphere, then you make a naive assumption that there will not be a flash crash in 2024. Also you seem to not understand statistics. You can not draw any conclusions from a distribution which is dependent on a factor you have not sampled, i.e. ongoing coup d'etat during an election year.

I wrote:

@HenryJamesUpdates I of course agree with the bullish breakout. I have had 4800+ as the Shark harmonic target since Oct 2022. I have been long since Oct 2022. I do long-term analysis. My analysis says SPX to double-top then crash below 3400 in Q1. I have BTC to complete wave 5 to ~37k of wave B of an A-B-C correction, then crash to 13k probably not 9k to complete wave C. BTC on the monthly is much weaker than it was in 2016 and 2019 as RSI is loitering around 50% which is the demarcation between bullish and bearish zones. So I am just suggesting you keep an eye for this scenario of everything being overbought perhaps late in Q4 or early Q1. 2019-2020 is repeating but not exactly. It will rhyme because election year with coup d'etat ongoing in the USA since 2020. The active coup d'etat is the reason for the flash crashes. C19 served many purposes for the warmonger, uniparty neocons. Everything in Ukraine and Israel is entirely their handiwork. ETH has a bullish ascending triangle and is probably about to do a quick double. Most of the altcoins have a Wycoff accumulation pattern with the final spring low likely this week and then rockets.
Note
youtu.be/jXLwZD9dT2g?t=81
(SEC OFFERS SETTLEMENT WITH RIPPLE CEO 🚀)

XRPBTC has bullish RSI divergence (on daily and weekly) targeting 0.000029 and appears to be repeating a move from Q1 2021. More upside leverage on BTC than ETHBTC.

snapshot

snapshot

But I do not know if that 0.000029 will be hit at 0.85 (BTC 29k) or 1.07+ (37+k). XRPUSD also has bullish RSI divergence on daily and weekly.

snapshot

snapshot
Note
Based on these patterns, I think BTC will flash crash only to ~14k in 2024. Will only be down there for a very short period and quickly back above 21k again. Looks like the 2025 top will ~71k.

snapshot
Note
snapshot
Note
That’s a bullish W pattern, not a bearish H&S. I have many other indicators telling me so.

snapshot
Note
Exactly as I diagrammed and predicted. It that line I expected to but sooner. So have bearish RSI divergence on the weekly. Will come back and retest $ 30 - 31k before heading back up to ~$ 36k in November for the final top before the big crash. Could potentially push up into ~$ 40k into Q1 2024, but I doubt. The Wycoff distribution says it will not.

snapshot
Note
Something really horrible is coming to the markets in Q1 or Q2 2024. Here are the short-term bullish Bat harmonic projection (ig.com/en/trading-strategies/top-7-harmonic-patterns-every-trader-should-know-210608 to $3200 and long-term bearish Shark harmonic (ig.com/en/trading-strategies/top-7-harmonic-patterns-every-trader-should-know-210608 to $200 - 600 I had for ETH. I do not know if that bullish will complete, as it was cherry-picked from a ridge not the top. But the stock markets might rally to ATHs in Q4 or Q1 before the looming catastrophe.

snapshot
Note
Shelby Moore ⏱🌐🧖, [11/6/23 6:57 PM]
Sell Bitcoin. We will be able to repurchase below 15k before the halving.

QAnon, [11/7/23 1:29 AM]
I was just thinking ftx shook out the weak hands and that was the bottom

Shelby Moore ⏱🌐🧖, [11/7/23 1:32 AM]
And we have +133% off that bottom. The problem now is not leverage in Bitcoin, but the macro economic situation. Late 2019 and early 2020 repeating.

QAnon, [11/7/23 1:34 AM]
Is that a Fibonacci rise

Shelby Moore ⏱🌐🧖, [11/7/23 1:37 AM]
I believe so. Could still chop between BER:33K and 40k in Q4 before the dump. Appears to be an A-B-C (aka W-X-Y) correction from the 2021 top. Wave B/X completing now. Top always comes with the maximum ETF fud.

QAnon, [11/7/23 2:20 AM]
How do you know FTX wasn’t the c

Shelby Moore ⏱🌐🧖, [11/7/23 2:22 AM]
Nobody can know with 100% certainty, but there was never the capitulation what we see at bottoms where everyone hates crypto and calling for it to drop $900 as they were at 3k in 2018.

Also we definitely have some contagion looming in H1 2024. Armstrong's computer is picking up the capital flows in advance as it done in advance of every major event.

There is too much hope too early in the cycle before the halving. BTC should have crashed to ~12K, but it was lifted by the Fed pause, banking crisis and now again Fed pause + ETF rumors.

Full capitulation was interrupted and thus still looming before the halving.

I have many data points. I may fail to hit on all of them in my response. You would need to read my history of posts to get the full flavor. But for example, volume has been declining on this entire rise. There will be no easy money from the Fed until there is a contagion event. Bitcoin is fueled by the Fed’s self-immolation because it will be the replacement for the dollar as the world's reserve.

Steve Courtney’s 5:3 ratio theory which has pinpointed the top of every bull market in Bitcoin's history, says that the top will be ~413% rise from the bottom. Thus if 15.4k was the bottom, then the top would be ~79k. If this rally is going to hit ~40k (or 58k?) so early before the halving, then there will be nothing left for the actual bull market after the halving. Thus clearly we need a lower-low first.

So if we get a decline to $12 - 14k as a I expect (lower-low as Bitcoin is slowing down every cycle until the ANYONECANSPEND legacy protocol restoration, thus will be worse than 2020), so thus the top in ~2025 will be only ~62 - 71k, i.e. a triple-top marking the end of Bitcoin before it is attacked and the non-legacy protocol tokens go to ~$0 in the coming global conflagration period 2026 - 2028. After that the legacy protocol tokens will rise as the new Phoenix reserve currency to ~1M after 2032 as the world is reset w/o the USA as the superpower after it is defeated in WWIII underway
FibonacciFractalWave Analysis

Related publications

Disclaimer